<SPAN name="startofbook"></SPAN>
<p><br/><br/></p>
<h1> THE FLYING-U'S LAST STAND </h1>
<p><br/></p>
<h2> By B. M. Bower </h2>
<p><br/></p>
<hr />
<p><br/></p>
<blockquote>
<p><big><b>CONTENTS</b></big></p>
<p><br/> <SPAN href="#link2H_4_0001"> <b>THE FLYING U'S LAST STAND</b> </SPAN><br/><br/><br/>
<SPAN href="#link2HCH0001"> CHAPTER 1. </SPAN> OLD WAYS AND NEW
<br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0002"> CHAPTER 2. </SPAN> ANDY
GREEN'S NEW ACQUAINTANCE <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0003"> CHAPTER 3.</SPAN> THE KID LEARNS SOME THINGS ABOUT HORSES <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0004"> CHAPTER 4. </SPAN> ANDY TAKES A HAND IN
THE GAME <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0005"> CHAPTER 5. </SPAN> THE
HAPPY FAMILY TURN NESTERS <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0006"> CHAPTER 6.</SPAN> THE FIRST BLOW IN THE FIGHT <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0007"> CHAPTER 7. </SPAN> THE COMING OF THE
COLONY <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0008"> CHAPTER 8. </SPAN> FLORENCE
GRACE HALLMAN SPEAKS PLAINLY <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0009"> CHAPTER
9. </SPAN> THE HAPPY FAMILY BUYS A BUNCH OF CATTLE <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0010"> CHAPTER 10. </SPAN> WHEREIN ANDY GREEN
LIES TO A LADY <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0011"> CHAPTER 11. </SPAN> A
MOVING CHAPTER IN EVENTS <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0012"> CHAPTER 12.</SPAN> SHACKS, LIVE STOCK AND PILGRIMS PROMPTLY AND PAINFULLY
REMOVED <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0013"> CHAPTER 13. </SPAN> IRISH
WORKS FOR THE CAUSE <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0014"> CHAPTER 14. </SPAN> JUST
ONE THING AFTER ANOTHER <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0015"> CHAPTER 15.</SPAN> THE KID HAS IDEAS OF HIS OWN <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0016"> CHAPTER 16. </SPAN> "A RELL OLD
COWPUNCHER” <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0017"> CHAPTER 17. </SPAN> "LOST
CHILD” <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0018"> CHAPTER 18. </SPAN> THE
LONG WAY ROUND <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0019"> CHAPTER 19. </SPAN> HER
NAME WAS ROSEMARY <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0020"> CHAPTER 20. </SPAN> THE
RELL OLE COWPUNCHER GOES HOME <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0021">
CHAPTER 21. </SPAN> THE FIGHT GOES ON <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0022"> CHAPTER 22. </SPAN> LAWFUL IMPROVEMENTS
<br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0023"> CHAPTER 23. </SPAN> THE
WATER QUESTION AND SOME GOSSIP <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0024">
CHAPTER 24. </SPAN> THE KID IS USED FOR A PAWN IN THE GAME <br/><br/>
<SPAN href="#link2HCH0025"> CHAPTER 25. </SPAN> "LITTLE BLACK
SHACK'S ALL BURNT UP” <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0026"> CHAPTER 26.</SPAN> ROSEMARY ALLEN DOES A SMALL SUM IN ADDITION <br/><br/>
<SPAN href="#link2HCH0027"> CHAPTER 27. </SPAN> "ITS AWFUL EASY TO
GET LOST” <br/><br/> <SPAN href="#link2HCH0028"> CHAPTER 28. </SPAN> AS
IT TURNED OUT <br/><br/></p>
</blockquote>
<p><br/></p>
<hr />
<p><SPAN name="link2H_4_0001" id="link2H_4_0001"></SPAN></p>
<h1> THE FLYING U'S LAST STAND </h1>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0001" id="link2HCH0001"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 1. OLD WAYS AND NEW </h2>
<p>Progress is like the insidious change from youth to old age, except that
progress does not mean decay. The change that is almost imperceptible and
yet inexorable is much the same, however. You will see a community
apparently changeless as the years pass by; and yet, when the years have
gone and you look back, there has been a change. It is not the same. It
never will be the same. It can pass through further change, but it cannot
go back. Men look back sick sometimes with longing for the things that
were and that can be no more; they live the old days in memory—but
try as they will they may not go back. With intelligent, persistent effort
they may retard further change considerably, but that is the most that
they can hope to do. Civilization and Time will continue the march in
spite of all that man may do.</p>
<p>That is the way it was with the Flying U. Old J. G. Whitmore fought
doggedly against the changing conditions—and he fought intelligently
and well. When he saw the range dwindling and the way to the watering
places barred against his cattle with long stretches of barbed wire, he
sent his herds deeper into the Badlands to seek what grazing was in the
hidden, little valleys and the deep, sequestered canyons. He cut more hay
for winter feeding, and he sowed his meadows to alfalfa that he might
increase the crops. He shipped old cows and dry cows with his fat steers
in the fall, and he bettered the blood of his herds and raised bigger
cattle. Therefore, if his cattle grew fewer in number, they improved in
quality and prices went higher, so that the result was much the same.</p>
<p>It began to look, then, as though J. G. Whitmore was cunningly besting the
situation, and was going to hold out indefinitely against the
encroachments of civilization upon the old order of things on the range.
And it had begun to look as though he was going to best Time at his own
game, and refuse also to grow old; as though he would go on being the same
pudgy, grizzled, humorously querulous Old Man beloved of his men, the
Happy Family of the Flying U.</p>
<p>Sometimes, however, Time will fill a four-flush with the joker, and then
laugh while he rakes in the chips. J. G. Whitmore had been going his way
and refusing to grow old for a long time—and then an accident, which
is Time's joker, turned the game against him. He stood for just a second
too long on a crowded crossing in Chicago, hesitating between going
forward or back. And that second gave Time a chance to play an accident. A
big seven-passenger touring car mowed him down and left him in a heap for
the ambulance from the nearest hospital to gather on its stretcher.</p>
<p>The Old Man did not die; he had lived long on the open range and he was
pretty tough and hard to kill. He went back to his beloved Flying U, with
a crutch to help him shuffle from bed to easy chair and back again.</p>
<p>The Little Doctor, who was his youngest sister, nursed him tirelessly; but
it was long before there came a day when the Old Man gave his crutch to
the Kid to use for a stick-horse, and walked through the living room and
out upon the porch with the help of a cane and the solicitous arm of the
Little Doctor, and with the Kid galloping gleefully before him on the
crutch.</p>
<p>Later he discarded the help of somebody's arm, and hobbled down to the
corral with the cane, and with the Kid still galloping before him on
“Uncle Gee Gee's” crutch. He stood for some time leaning against the
corral watching some of the boys halter-breaking a horse that was later to
be sold—when he was “broke gentle”—and then he hobbled back
again, thankful for the soft comfort of his big chair.</p>
<p>That was well enough, as far as it went. The Flying U took it for granted
that the Old Man was slowly returning to the old order of life, when
rheumatism was his only foe and he could run things with his old energy
and easy good management. But there never came a day when the Old Man gave
his cane to the kid to play with. There never came a day when he was not
thankful for the soft comfort of his chair. There never came a day when he
was the same Old Man who joshed the boys and scolded them and threatened
them. The day was always coming—of course!—when his back would
quit aching if he walked to the stable and back without a long rest
between, but it never actually arrived.</p>
<p>So, imperceptibly but surely, the Old Man began to grow old. The thin spot
on top of his head grew shiny, so that the Kid noticed it and made blunt
comments upon the subject. His rheumatism was not his worst foe, now. He
had to pet his digestive apparatus and cut out strong coffee with three
heaping teaspoons of sugar in each cup, because the Little Doctor told him
his liver was torpid. He had to stop giving the Kid jolty rides on his
knees,—but that was because the Kid was getting too big for baby
play, the Old Man declared. The Kid was big enough to ride real horses,
now, and he ought to be ashamed to ride knee-horses any more.</p>
<p>To two things the Old Man clung almost fiercely; the old regime of ranging
his cattle at large and starting out the wagons in the spring just the
same as if twenty-five men instead of twelve went with them; and the
retention of the Happy Family on his payroll, just as if they were
actually needed. If one of the boys left to try other things and other
fields, the Old Man considered him gone on a vacation and expected him
back when spring roundup approached.</p>
<p>True, he was seldom disappointed in that. For the Happy Family looked upon
the Flying U as home, and six months was about the limit for straying
afar. Cowpunchers to the bone though they were, they bent backs over
irrigating ditches and sweated in the hay fields just for the sake of
staying together on the ranch. I cannot say that they did it
uncomplainingly—for the bunk-house was saturated to the ridge-pole
with their maledictions while they compared blistered hands and pitchfork
callouses, and mourned the days that were gone; the days when they rode
far and free and scorned any work that could not be done from the saddle.
But they stayed, and they did the ranch work as well as the range work,
which is the main point.</p>
<p>They became engaged to certain girls who filled their dreams and all their
waking thoughts—but they never quite came to the point of marrying
and going their way. Except Pink, who did marry impulsively and unwisely,
and who suffered himself to be bullied and called Percy for seven months
or so, and who balked at leaving the Flying U for the city and a vicarious
existence in theaterdom, and so found himself free quite as suddenly as he
had been tied.</p>
<p>They intended to marry and settle down—sometime. But there was
always something in the way of carrying those intentions to fulfillment,
so that eventually the majority of the Happy Family found themselves not
even engaged, but drifting along toward permanent bachelorhood. Being of
the optimistic type, however, they did not worry; Pink having set before
them a fine example of the failure of marriage and having returned with
manifest relief to the freedom of the bunk-house.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0002" id="link2HCH0002"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 2. ANDY GREEN'S NEW ACQUAINTANCE </h2>
<p>Andy Green, chief prevaricator of the Happy Family of the Flying U—and
not ashamed of either title or connection—pushed his new Stetson
back off his untanned forehead, attempted to negotiate the narrow passage
into a Pullman sleeper with his suitcase swinging from his right hand, and
butted into a woman who was just emerging from the dressing-room. He
butted into her so emphatically that he was compelled to swing his left
arm out very quickly, or see her go headlong into the window opposite; for
a fullsized suitcase propelled forward by a muscular young man may prove a
very efficient instrument of disaster, especially if it catches one just
in the hollow back of the knee. The woman tottered and grasped Andy
convulsively to save herself a fall, and so they stood blocking the
passage until the porter arrived and took the suitcase from Andy with a
tip-inviting deference.</p>
<p>Andy apologized profusely, with a quaint, cowpunchery phrasing that caused
the woman to take a second look at him. And, since Andy Green would look
good to any woman capable of recognizing—and appreciating—a
real man when she saw him, she smiled and said it didn't matter in the
least.</p>
<p>That was the beginning of the acquaintance. Andy took her by her plump,
chiffon-veiled arm and piloted her to her seat, and he afterward tipped
the porter generously and had his own belongings deposited in the section
across the aisle. Then, with the guile of a foreign diplomat, he betook
himself to the smoking-room and stayed there for three quarters of an
hour. He was not taking any particular risk of losing the opportunity of
an unusually pleasant journey, for the dollar he had invested in the
goodwill of the porter had yielded the information that the lady was going
through to Great Falls. Since Andy had boarded the train at Harlem there
was plenty of time to kill between there and Dry Lake, which was his
destination.</p>
<p>The lady smiled at him rememberingly when finally he seated himself across
the aisle from her, and without any serious motive Andy smiled back. So
presently they were exchanging remarks about the journey. Later on, Andy
went over and sat beside her and conversation began in earnest. Her name,
it transpired, was Florence Grace Hallman. Andy read it engraved upon a
card which added the information that she was engaged in the real estate
business—or so the three or four words implied. “Homemakers'
Syndicate, Minneapolis and St. Paul,” said the card. Andy was visibly
impressed thereby. He looked at her with swift appraisement and decided
that she was “all to the good.”</p>
<p>Florence Grace Hallman was tall and daintily muscular as to figure. Her
hair was a light yellow—not quite the shade which peroxide gives,
and therefore probably natural. Her eyes were brown, a shade too close
together but cool and calm and calculating in their gaze, and her eyebrows
slanted upward a bit at the outer ends and were as heavy as beauty
permitted. Her lips were very red, and her chin was very firm. She looked
the successful business woman to her fingertips, and she was eminently
attractive for a woman of that self-assured type.</p>
<p>Andy was attractive also, in a purely Western way. His gray eyes were
deceivingly candid and his voice was pleasant with a little, humorous
drawl that matched well the quirk of his lips when he talked. He was
headed for home—which was the Flying U—sober and sunny and
with enough money to see him through. He told Florence Hallman his name,
and said that he lived “up the road a ways” without being too definite.
Florence Hallman lived in Minneapolis, she said; though she traveled most
of the time, in the interests of her firm.</p>
<p>Yes, she liked the real estate business. One had a chance to see the
world, and keep in touch with people and things. She liked the West
especially well. Since her firm had taken up the homeseekers' line she
spent most of her time in the West.</p>
<p>They had supper—she called it dinner, Andy observed—together,
and Andy Green paid the check, which was not so small. It was after that,
when they became more confidential, that Florence Hallman, with the
egotism of the successful person who believes herself or himself to be of
keen interest to the listener spoke in greater detail of her present
mission.</p>
<p>Her firm's policy was, she said, to locate a large tract of government
land somewhere, and then organize a homeseekers' colony, and settle the
land-hungry upon the tract—at so much per hunger. She thought it a
great scheme for both sides of the transaction. The men who wanted claims
got them. The firm got the fee for showing them the land—and certain
other perquisites at which she merely hinted.</p>
<p>She thought that Andy himself would be a success at the business. She was
quick to form her opinions of people whom she met, and she knew that Andy
was just the man for such work. Andy, listening with his candid, gray eyes
straying often to her face and dwelling there, modestly failed to agree
with her. He did not know the first thing about the real estate business,
he confessed, nor very much about ranching. Oh, yes—he lived in this
country, and he knew THAT pretty well, but—</p>
<p>“The point is right here,” said Florence Grace Hallman, laying her pink
fingertips upon his arm and glancing behind her to make sure that they
were practically alone—their immediate neighbors being still in the
diner. “I'm speaking merely upon impulse—which isn't a wise thing to
do, ordinarily. But—well, your eyes vouch for you, Mr. Green, and we
women are bound to act impulsively sometimes—or we wouldn't be
women, would we?” She laughed—rather, she gave a little, infectious
giggle, and took away her fingers, to the regret of Andy who liked the
feel of them on his forearm.</p>
<p>“The point is here. I've recognized the fact, all along, that we need a
man stationed right here, living in the country, who will meet prospective
homesteaders and talk farming; keep up their enthusiasm; whip the doubters
into line; talk climate and soil and the future of the country; look the
part, you understand.”</p>
<p>“So I look like a rube, do I?” Andy's lips quirked a half smile at her.</p>
<p>“No, of course you don't!” She laid her fingers on his sleeve again, which
was what Andy wanted—what he had intended to bait her into doing;
thereby proving that, in some respects at least, he amply justified Hiss
Hallman in her snap judgment of him.</p>
<p>“Of course you don't look like a rube! I don't want you to. But you do
look Western—because you are Western to the bone Besides, you look
perfectly dependable. Nobody could look into your eyes and even think of
doubting the truth of any statement you made to them.” Andy snickered
mentally at that though his eyes never lost their clear candor. “And,” she
concluded, “being a bona fide resident of the country, your word would
carry more weight than mine if I were to talk myself black in the face!”</p>
<p>“That's where you're dead wrong,” Andy hastened to correct her.</p>
<p>“Well, you must let me have my own opinion, Mr. Green. You would be
convincing enough, at any rate. You see, there is a certain per cent of—let
us call it waste effort—in this colonization business. We have to
reckon on a certain number of nibblers who won't bite”—Andy's
honest, gray eyes widened a hair's breadth at the frankness of her
language—“when they get out here. They swallow the folders we send
out, but when they get out here and see the country, they can't see it as
a rich farming district, and they won't invest. They go back home and
knock, if they do anything.</p>
<p>“My idea is to stop that waste; to land every homeseeker that boards our
excursion trains. And I believe the way to do that is to have the right
kind of a man out here, steer the doubtfuls against him—and let his
personality and his experience do the rest. They're hungry enough to come,
you see; the thing is to keep them here. A man that lives right here, that
has all the earmarks of the West, and is not known to be affiliated with
our Syndicate (you could have rigs to hire, and drive the doubtfuls to the
tract)—don't you see what an enormous advantage he'd have? The class
I speak of are the suspicious ones—those who are from Missouri.
They're inclined to want salt with what we say about the resources of the
country. Even our chemical analysis of the soil, and weather bureau dope,
don't go very far with those hicks. They want to talk with someone who has
tried it, you see.”</p>
<p>“I—see,” said Andy thoughtfully, and his eyes narrowed a trifle. “On
the square, Miss Hallman, what are the natural advantages out here—for
farming? What line of talk do you give those come-ons?”</p>
<p>Miss Hallman laughed and made a very pretty gesture with her two ringed
hands. “Whatever sounds the best to them,” she said. “If they write and
ask about spuds we come back with illustrated folders of potato crops and
statistics of average yields and prices and all that. If it's dairy, we
have dairy folders. And so on. It isn't any fraud—there ARE sections
of the country that produce almost anything, from alfalfa to strawberries.
You know that,” she challenged.</p>
<p>“Sure. But I didn't know there was much tillable land left lying around
loose,” he ventured to say.</p>
<p>Again Miss Hallman made the pretty gesture, which might mean much or
nothing. “There's plenty of land 'lying around loose,' as you call it. How
do you know it won't produce, till it has been tried?”</p>
<p>“That's right,” Andy assented uneasily. “If there's water to put on it—”</p>
<p>“And since there is the land, our business lies in getting people located
on it. The towns and the railroads are back of us. That is, they look with
favor upon bringing settlers into the country. It increases the business
of the country—the traffic, the freights, the merchants' business,
everything.”</p>
<p>Andy puckered his eyebrows and looked out of the window upon a great
stretch of open, rolling prairie, clothed sparely in grass that was
showing faint green in the hollows, and with no water for miles—as
he knew well—except for the rivers that hurried through narrow
bottom lands guarded by high bluffs that were for the most part barren.
The land was there, all right. But—</p>
<p>“What I can't see,” he observed after a minute during which Miss Florence
Hallman studied his averted face, “what I can't see is, where do the
settlers get off at?”</p>
<p>“At Easy street, if they're lucky enough,” she told him lightly. “My
business is to locate them on the land. Getting a living off it is THEIR
business. And,” she added defensively, “people do make a living on ranches
out here.”</p>
<p>“That's right,” he agreed again—he was finding it very pleasant to
agree with Florence Grace Hallman. “Mostly off stock, though.”</p>
<p>“Yes, and we encourage our clients to bring out all the young stock they
possibly can; young cows and horses and—all that sort of thing.
There's quantities of open country around here, that even the most
optimistic of homeseekers would never think of filing on. They can make
out, all right, I guess. We certainly urge them strongly to bring stock
with them. It's always been famous as a cattle country—that's one of
our highest cards. We tell them—”</p>
<p>“How do you do that? Do you go right to them and TALK to them?”</p>
<p>“Yes, if they show a strong enough interest—and bank account. I
follow up the best prospects and visit them in person. I've talked to
fifty horny-handed he-men in the past month.”</p>
<p>“Then I don't see what you need of anyone to bring up the drag,” Andy told
her admiringly. “If you talk to 'em, there oughtn't be any drag!”</p>
<p>“Thank you for the implied compliment. But there IS a 'drag,' as you call
it. There's going to be a big one, too, I'm afraid—when they get out
and see this tract we're going to work off this spring.” She stopped and
studied him as a chess player studies the board.</p>
<p>“I'm very much tempted to tell you something I shouldn't tell,” she said
at length, lowering her voice a little. “Remember, Andy Green was a very
good looking man, and his eyes were remarkable for their clear, candid
gaze straight into your own eyes. Even as keen a business woman as
Florence Grace Hallman must be forgiven for being deceived by them. I'm
tempted to tell you where this tract is. You may know it.”</p>
<p>“You better not, unless you're willing to take a chance,” he told her
soberly. “If it looks too good, I'm liable to jump it myself.”</p>
<p>Miss Hallman laughed and twisted her red lips at him in what might be
construed as a flirtatious manner. She was really quite taken with Andy
Green. “I'll take a chance. I don't think you'll jump it. Do you know
anything about Dry Lake, up above Havre, toward Great Falls—and the
country out east of there, towards the mountains?”</p>
<p>The fingers of Andy Green closed into his palms. His eyes, however,
continued to look into hers with his most guileless expression.</p>
<p>“Y-es—that is, I've ridden over it,” he acknowledged simply.</p>
<p>“Well—now this is a secret; at least we don't want those mossback
ranchers in there to get hold of it too soon, though they couldn't really
do anything, since it's all government land and the lease has only just
run out. There's a high tract lying between the Bear Paws and—do you
know where the Flying U ranch is?”</p>
<p>“About where it is—yes.”</p>
<p>“Well, it's right up there on that plateau—bench, you call it out
here. There are several thousand acres along in there that we're locating
settlers on this spring. We're just waiting for the grass to get nice and
green, and the prairie to get all covered with those blue, blue wind
flowers, and the meadow larks to get busy with their nests, and then we're
going to bring them out and—” She spread her hands again. It seemed
a favorite gesture grown into a habit, and it surely was more eloquent
than words. “These prairies will be a dream of beauty, in a little while,”
she said. “I'm to watch for the psychological time to bring out the
seekers. And if I could just interest you, Mr. Green, to the extent of
being somewhere around Dry Lake, with a good team that you will drive for
hire and some samples of oats and dry-land spuds and stuff that you raised
on your claim—” She eyed him sharply for one so endearingly
feminine. “Would you do it? There'd be a salary, and besides that a
commission on each doubter you landed. And I'd just love to have you for
one of my assistants.”</p>
<p>“It sure sounds good,” Andy flirted with the proposition, and let his eyes
soften appreciably to meet her last sentence and the tone in which she
spoke it. “Do you think I could get by with the right line of talk with
the doubters?”</p>
<p>“I think you could,” she said, and in her voice there was a cooing note.
“Study up a little on the right dope, and I think you could convince—even
me.”</p>
<p>“Could I?” Andy Green knew that cooing note, himself, and one a shade more
provocative. “I wonder!”</p>
<p>A man came down the aisle at that moment, gave Andy a keen glance and went
on with a cigar between his fingers. Andy scowled frankly, sighed and
straightened his shoulders.</p>
<p>“That's what I call hard luck,” he grumbled, “got to see that man before
he gets off the train—and the h—worst of it is, I don't know
just what station he'll get off at.” He sighed again. “I've got a deal
on,” he told her confidentially, “that's sure going to keep me humping if
I pull loose so as to go in with you. How long did you say?”</p>
<p>“Probably two weeks, the way spring is opening out here. I'd want you to
get perfectly familiar with our policy and the details of our scheme
before they land. I'd want you to be familiar with that tract and be able
to show up its best points when you take seekers out there. You'd be so
much better than one of our own men, who have the word 'agent' written all
over them. You'll come back and—talk it over won't you?” For Andy
was showing unmistakable symptoms of leaving her to follow the man.</p>
<p>“You KNOW it,” he declared in a tone of “I won't sleep nights till this
thing is settled—and settled right.” He gave her a smile that rather
dazzled the lady, got up with much reluctance and with a glance that had
in it a certain element of longing went swaying down the aisle after the
man who had preceded him.</p>
<p>Andy's business with the man consisted solely in mixing cigarette smoke
with cigar smoke and of helping to stare moodily out of the window. Words
there were none, save when Andy was proffered a match and muttered his
thanks. The silent session lasted for half an hour. Then the man got up
and went out, and the breath of Andy Green paused behind his nostrils
until he saw that the man went only to the first section in the car and
settled there behind a spread newspaper, invisible to Florence Grace
Hallman unless she searched the car and peered over the top of the paper
to see who was behind.</p>
<p>After that Andy Green continued to stare out of the window, seeing nothing
of the scenery but the flicker of telegraph posts before his eyes that
were visioning the future.</p>
<p>The Flying U ranch hemmed in by homesteaders from the East, he saw;
homesteaders who were being urged to bring all the stock they could, and
turn it loose upon the shrinking range. Homesteaders who would fence the
country into squares, and tear up the grass and sow grain that might never
bear a harvest. Homesteaders who would inevitably grow poorer upon the
land that would suck their strength and all their little savings and turn
them loose finally to forage a living where they might. Homesteaders who
would ruin the land that ruined them.... It was not a pleasing picture,
but it was more pleasing than the picture he saw of the Flying U after
these human grass hoppers had settled there.</p>
<p>The range that fed the Flying U stock would feed no more and hide their
ribs at shipping time. That he knew too well. Old J. G. Whitmore and Chip
would have to sell out. And that was like death; indeed, it IS death of a
sort, when one of the old outfits is wiped out of existence. It had
happened before—happened too often to make pleasant memories for
Andy Green, who could name outfit after outfit that had been forced out of
business by the settling of the range land; who could name dozens of
cattle brands once seen upon the range, and never glimpsed now from spring
roundup until fall.</p>
<p>Must the Flying U brand disappear also? The good old Flying U, for whose
existence the Old Man had fought and schemed since first was raised the
cry that the old range was passing? The Flying U that had become a part of
his life? Andy let his cigarette grow cold; he roused only to swear at the
porter who entered with dust cloth and a deprecating grin.</p>
<p>After that, Andy thought of Florence Grace Hallman—and his eyes were
not particularly sentimental. There was a hard line about his mouth also;
though Florence Grace Hallman was but a pawn in the game, after all, and
not personally guilty of half the deliberate crimes Andy laid upon her
dimpled shoulders. With her it was pure, cold-blooded business, this
luring of the land-hungry to a land whose fertility was at best
problematical; who would, for a price, turn loose the victims of her greed
to devastate what little grazing ground was left.</p>
<p>The train neared Havre. Andy roused himself, rang for the porter and sent
him after his suitcase and coat. Then he sauntered down the aisle, stopped
beside Florence Grace Hallman and smiled down at her with a gleam behind
the clear candor of his eyes.</p>
<p>“Hard luck, lady,” he murmured, leaning toward her. “I'm just simply
loaded to the guards with responsibilities, and here's where I get off.
But I'm sure glad I met yuh, and I'll certainly think day and night about
you and—all you told me about. I'd like to get in on this land deal.
Fact is, I'm going to make it my business to get in on it. Maybe my way of
working won't suit you—but I'll sure work hard for any boss and do
the best I know how.”</p>
<p>“I think that will suit me,” Miss Hallman assured him, and smiled
unsuspectingly up into his eyes, which she thought she could read so
easily. “When shall I see you again? Could you come to Great Falls in the
next ten days? I shall be stopping at the Park. Or if you will leave me
your address—”</p>
<p>“No use. I'll be on the move and a letter wouldn't get me. I'll see yuh
later, anyway. I'm bound to. And when I do, we'll get down to cases. Good
bye.”</p>
<p>He was turning away when Miss Hallman put out a soft, jewelled hand. She
thought it was diffidence that made Andy Green hesitate perceptibly before
he took it. She thought it was simply a masculine shyness and confusion
that made him clasp her fingers loosely and let them go on the instant.
She did not see him rub his palm down the leg of his dark gray trousers as
he walked down the aisle, and if she had she would not have seen any
significance in the movement.</p>
<p>Andy Green did that again before he stepped off the train. For he felt
that he had shaken hands with a traitor to himself and his outfit, and it
went against the grain. That the traitor was a woman, and a charming woman
at that, only intensified his resentment against her. A man can fight a
man and keep his self respect; but a man does mortally dread being forced
into a position where he must fight a woman.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0003" id="link2HCH0003"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 3. THE KID LEARNS SOME THINGS ABOUT HORSES </h2>
<p>The Kid—Chip's Kid and the Little Doctor's—was six years old
and big for his age. Also he was a member in good standing of the Happy
Family and he insisted upon being called Buck outside the house; within it
the Little Doctor insisted even more strongly that he answer to the many
endearing names she had invented for him, and to the more formal one of
Claude, which really belonged to Daddy Chip.</p>
<p>Being six years old and big for his age, and being called Buck by his
friends, the Happy Family, the Kid decided that he should have a
man's-sized horse of his own, to feed and water and ride and proudly call
his “string.” Having settled that important point, he began to cast about
him for a horse worthy his love and ownership, and speedily he decided
that matter also.</p>
<p>Therefore, he ran bareheaded up to the blacksmith shop where Daddy Chip
was hammering tunefully upon the anvil, and delivered his ultimatum from
the door way.</p>
<p>“Silver's going to be my string, Daddy Chip, and I'm going to feed him
myself and ride him myself and nobody else can touch him 'thout I say they
can.”</p>
<p>“Yes?” Chip squinted along a dully-glowing iron bar, laid it back upon the
anvil and gave it another whack upon the side that still bulged a little.</p>
<p>“Yes, and I'm going to saddle him myself and everything. And I want you to
get me some jingling silver spurs like Mig has got, with chains that hang
away down and rattle when you walk.” The Kid lifted one small foot and
laid a grimy finger in front of his heel by way of illustration.</p>
<p>“Yes?” Chip's eyes twinkled briefly and immediately became intent upon his
work.</p>
<p>“Yes, and Doctor Dell has got to let me sleep in the bunk-house with the
rest of the fellers. And I ain't going to wear a nightie once more! I
don't have to, do I, Daddy Chip? Not with lace on it. Happy Jack says I'm
a girl long as I wear lace nighties, and I ain't a girl. Am I, Daddy
Chip?”</p>
<p>“I should say not!” Chip testified emphatically, and carried the iron bar
to the forge for further heating.</p>
<p>“I'm going on roundup too, tomorrow afternoon.” The Kid's conception of
time was extremely sketchy and had no connection whatever with the
calendar. “I'm going to keep Silver in the little corral and let him sleep
in the box stall where his leg got well that time he broke it. I 'member
when he had a rag tied on it and teased for sugar. And the Countess has
got to quit a kickin' every time I need sugar for my string. Ain't she,
Daddy Chip? She's got to let us men alone or there'll be something doing!”</p>
<p>“I'd tell a man,” said Chip inattentively, only half hearing the war-like
declaration of his offspring—as is the way with busy fathers.</p>
<p>“I'm going to take a ride now on Silver. I guess I'll ride in to Dry Lake
and get the mail—and I'm 'pletely outa the makings, too.”</p>
<p>“Uh-hunh—a—what's that? You keep off Silver. He'll kick the
daylights out of you, Kid. Where's your hat? Didn't your mother tell you
she'd tie a sunbonnet on you if you didn't keep your hat on? You better
hike back and get it, young man, before she sees you.”</p>
<p>The Kid stared mutinously from the doorway. “You said I could have Silver.
What's the use of having a string if a feller can't ride it? And I CAN
ride him, and he don't kick at all. I rode him just now, in the little
pasture to see if I liked his gait better than the others. I rode Banjo
first and I wouldn't own a thing like him, on a bet. Silver'll do me till
I can get around to break a real one.”</p>
<p>Chip's hand dropped from the bellows while he stared hard at the Kid. “Did
you go down in the pasture and—Words failed him just then.</p>
<p>“I'd TELL a man I did!” the Kid retorted, with a perfect imitation of
Chip's manner and tone when crossed. “I've been trying out all the darned
benchest you've got—and there ain't a one I'd give a punched nickel
for but Silver. I'd a rode Shootin' Star, only he wouldn't stand still so
I could get onto him. Whoever broke him did a bum job. The horse I break
will stand, or I'll know the reason why. Silver'll stand, all right. And I
can guide him pretty well by slapping his neck. You did a pretty fair job
when you broke Silver,” the Kid informed his father patronizingly.</p>
<p>Chip said something which the Kid was not supposed to hear, and sat
suddenly down upon the stone rim of the forge. It had never before
occurred to Chip that his Kid was no longer a baby, but a most adventurous
man-child who had lived all his life among men and whose mental
development had more than kept pace with his growing body. He had laughed
with the others at the Kid's quaint precociousness of speech and at his
frank worship of range men and range life. He had gone to some trouble to
find a tractable Shetland pony the size of a burro, and had taught the Kid
to ride, decorously and fully protected from accident.</p>
<p>He and the Little Doctor had been proud of the Kid's masculine traits as
they manifested themselves in the management of that small specimen of
horse flesh. That the Kid should have outgrown so quickly his content with
Stubby seemed much more amazing than it really was. He eyed the Kid
doubtfully for a minute, and then grinned.</p>
<p>“All that don't let you out on the hat question,” he said, evading the
real issue and laying stress upon the small matter of obedience, as is the
exasperating habit of parents. “You don't see any of the bunch going
around bareheaded. Only women and babies do that.”</p>
<p>“The bunch goes bareheaded when they get their hats blowed off in the
creek,” the Kid pointed out unmoved. “I've seen you lose your hat mor'n
once, old timer. That's nothing.” He sent Chip a sudden, adorable smile
which proclaimed him the child of his mother and which never failed to
thrill Chip secretly,—it was so like the Little Doctor. “You lend me
your hat for a while, dad,” he said. “She never said what hat I had to
wear, just so it's a hat. Honest to gran'ma, my hat's in the creek and I
couldn't poke it out with a stick or anything. It sailed into the swimmin'
hole. I was goin' to go after it,” he explained further, “but—a
snake was swimmin—and I hated to 'sturb him.”</p>
<p>Chip drew a sharp breath and for one panicky moment considered imperative
the hiring of a body-guard for his Kid.</p>
<p>“You keep out of the pasture, young man!” His tone was stern to match his
perturbation. “And you leave Silver alone—”</p>
<p>The Kid did not wait for more. He lifted up his voice and wept in
bitterness of spirit. Wept so that one could hear him a mile. Wept so that
J. G. Whitmore reading the Great Falls Tribune on the porch, laid down his
paper and asked the world at large what ailed that doggoned kid now.</p>
<p>“Dell, you better go see what's wrong,” he called afterwards through the
open door to the Little Doctor, who was examining a jar of germ cultures
in her “office.” “Chances is he's fallen off the stable or something—though
he sounds more mad than hurt. If it wasn't for my doggoned back—”</p>
<p>The Little Doctor passed him hurriedly. When her man-child wept, it Needed
no suggestion from J. G. or anyone else to send her flying to the rescue.
So presently she arrived breathless at the blacksmith shop' and found Chip
within, looking in urgent Need of reinforcements, and the Kid yelling
ragefully beside the door and kicking the log wall with vicious boot-tees.</p>
<p>“Shut up now or I'll spank you!” Chip was saying desperately when his wife
appeared. “I wish you'd take that Kid and tie him up, Dell,” he added
snappishly. “Here he's been riding all the horses in the little pasture—and
taking a chance on breaking his neck! And he ain't satisfied with Stubby—he
thinks he's entitled to Silver!”</p>
<p>“Well, why not? There, there, honey—men don't cry when things go
wrong—”</p>
<p>“No—because they can take it out in cussing!” wailed the Kid. “I
wouldn't cry either, if you'd let me swear all I want to!”</p>
<p>Chip turned his back precipitately and his shoulders were seen to shake.
The Little Doctor looked shocked.</p>
<p>“I want Silver for my string!” cried the Kid, artfully transferring his
appeal to the higher court. “I can ride him—'cause I have rode him,
in the pasture; and he never bucked once or kicked or anything. Doggone
it, he likes to have me ride him! He comes a-runnin' up to me when I go
down there, and I give him sugar. And then he waits till I climb on his
back, and then we chase the other horses and play ride circle. He wants to
be my string!” Something in the feel of his mother's arm around his
shoulder whispered hope to the Kid. He looked up at her with his most
endearing smile. “You come down there and I'll show you,” he wheedled.
“We're pals. And I guess YOU wouldn't like to have the boys call you Tom
Thumb, a-ridin' Stubby. He's nothing but a five-cent sample of a horse.
Big Medicine says so. I—I'd rather walk than ride Stubby. And I'm
going on roundup. The boys said I could go when I get a real horse under
me—and I want Silver. Daddy Chip said 'yes' I could have him. And
now he's Injun-giver. Can't I have him, Doctor Dell?”</p>
<p>The gray-blue eyes clashed with the brown. “It wouldn't hurt anything to
let the poor little tad show us what he can do,” said the gray-blue eyes.</p>
<p>“Oh—all right,” yielded the brown, and their owner threw the iron
bar upon the cooling forge and began to turn down his sleeves. “Why don't
you make him wear a hat?” he asked reprovingly. “A little more and he
won't pay any attention to anything you tell him. I'd carry out that
sunbonnet bluff, anyway, if I were you.”</p>
<p>“Now, Daddy Chip! I 'splained to you how I lost my hat,” reproached the
Kid, clinging fast to the Little Doctor's hand.</p>
<p>“Yes—and you 'splained that you'd have gone into that deep hole and
drowned—with nobody there to pull you out—if you hadn't been
scared of a water snake,” Chip pointed out relentlessly.</p>
<p>“I wasn't 'zactly scared,” amended the Kid gravely. “He was havin' such a
good time, and he was swimmin' around so—comf'table—and it
wasn't polite to 'sturb him. Can't I have Silver?”</p>
<p>“We'll go down and ask Silver what he thinks about it,” said the Little
Doctor, anxious to make peace between her two idols. “And we'll see if
Daddy Chip can get the hat. You must wear a hat, honey; you know what
mother told you—and you know mother keeps her word.”</p>
<p>“I wish dad did,” the Kid commented, passing over the hat question. “He
said I could have Silver, and keep him in a box stall and feed him my own
self and water him my own self and nobody's to touch him but me.”</p>
<p>“Well, if daddy said all that—we'll have to think it over, and
consult Silver and see what he has to say about it.”</p>
<p>Silver, when consulted, professed at least a willingness to own the Kid
for his master. He did indeed come trotting up for sugar; and when he had
eaten two grimy lumps from the Kid's grimier hand, he permitted the Kid to
entice him up to a high rock, and stood there while the Kid clambered upon
the rock and from there to his sleek back. He even waited until the Kid
gathered a handful of silky mane and kicked him on the ribs; then he
started off at a lope, while the Kid risked his balance to cast a
triumphant grin—that had a gap in the middle—back at his
astonished parents.</p>
<p>“Look how the little devil guides him!” exclaimed Chip surrenderingly. “I
guess he's safe enough, old Silver seems to sabe he's got a kid to take
care of. He sure would strike a different gait with me! Lord how the time
slides by; I can't seem to get it through me that the Kid's growing up.”</p>
<p>The Little Doctor sighed a bit. And the Kid, circling grandly on the far
side of the little pasture, came galloping back to hear the verdict. It
pleased him—though he was inclined to mistake a great privilege for
a right that must not be denied. He commanded his Daddy Chip to open the
gate for him so he could ride Silver to the stable and put him in the box
stall; which was a superfluous kindness, as Chip tried to point out and
failed to make convincing.</p>
<p>The Kid wanted Silver in the box stall, where he could feed him and water
him his own self. So into the box stall Silver reluctantly went, and spent
a greater part of the day with his head stuck out through the window,
staring enviously at his mates in the pasture.</p>
<p>For several days Chip watched the Kid covertly whenever his small feet
strayed stableward; watched and was full of secret pride at the manner in
which the Kid rose to his new responsibility. Never did a “string” receive
the care which Silver got, and never did rider sit more proudly upon his
steed than did the Kid sit upon Silver. There seemed to be practically no
risk—Chip was amazed at the Kid's ability to ride. Besides, Silver
was growing old—fourteen years being considered ripe old age in a
horse. He was more given to taking life with a placid optimism that did
not startle easily. He carried the Kid's light weight easily, and he had
not lost all his springiness of muscle. The Little Doctor rode him
sometimes, and loved his smooth gallop and his even temper; now she loved
him more when she saw how careful he was of the Kid. She besought the Kid
to be careful of Silver also, and was most manfully snubbed for her
solicitude.</p>
<p>The Kid had owned Silver for a week, and considered that he was qualified
to give advice to the Happy Family, including his Daddy Chip, concerning
the proper care of horses. He stood with his hands upon his hips and his
feet far apart, and spat into the corral dust and told Big Medicine that
nobody but a pilgrim ever handled a horse the way Big Medicine was
handling Deuce. Whereat Big Medicine gave a bellowing haw-haw-haw and
choked it suddenly when he saw that the Kid desired him to take the
criticism seriously.</p>
<p>“All right, Buck,” he acceded humbly, winking openly at the Native Son.
“I'll try m'best, old-timer. Trouble with me is, I never had nobody to
learn me how to handle a hoss.”</p>
<p>“Well, you've got me, now,” Buck returned calmly. “I don't ride MY string
without brushing the hay out of his tail. There's a big long hay stuck in
your horse's tail.” He pointed an accusing finger, and Big Medicine
silently edged close to Douce's rump and very carefully removed the big,
long hay. He took a fine chance of getting himself kicked, but he did not
tell the Kid that.</p>
<p>“That all right now, Buck?” Big Medicine wanted to know, when he had
accomplished the thing without accident.</p>
<p>“Oh, it'll do,” was the frugal praise he got. “I've got to go and feed my
string, now. And after a while I'll water him. You want to feed your horse
always before you water him, 'cause eatin' makes him firsty. You 'member
that, now.”</p>
<p>“I'll sure try to, Buck,” Big Medicine promised soberly, and watched the
Kid go striding away with his hat tilted at the approved Happy-Family
angle and his small hands in his pockets. Big Medicine was thinking of his
own kid, and wondering what he was like, and if he remembered his dad. He
waved his hand in cordial farewell when the Kid looked back and wrinkled
his nose in the adorable, Little-Doctor smile he had, and turned his
attention to Deuce.</p>
<p>The Kid made straight for the box stall and told Silver hello over the
half door. Silver turned from gazing out of the window, and came forward
expectantly, and the Kid told him to wait a minute and not be so
impatience Then he climbed upon a box, got down a heavy canvas nose-bag
with leather bottom, and from a secret receptacle behind the oats box he
brought a paper bag of sugar and poured about a teacupful into the bag.
Daddy Chip had impressed upon him what would be the tragic consequences if
he fed oats to Silver five times a day. Silver would die, and it would be
the Kid that killed him. Daddy Chip had not said anything about sugar
being fatal, however, and the Countess could not always stand guard over
the sugar sack. So Silver had a sweet taste in his mouth twelve hours of
the twenty-four, and was getting a habit of licking his lips reminiscently
during the other twelve.</p>
<p>The Kid had watched the boys adjust nose bags ever since he could toddle.
He lugged it into the stall, set it artfully upon the floor and let Silver
thrust in his head to the eyes: then he pulled the strap over Silver's
neck and managed to buckle it very securely. He slapped the sleek neck
afterward as his Daddy Chip did, hugged it the way Doctor Dell did, and
stood back to watch Silver revel in the bag.</p>
<p>“'S good lickums?” he asked gravely, because he had once heard his mother
ask Silver that very question, in almost that very tone.</p>
<p>At that moment an uproar outside caught his youthful attention. He
listened a minute, heard Pink's voice and a shout of laughter, and ran to
see what was going on; for where was excitement, there the Kid was also,
as nearly in the middle of it as he could manage. His going would not have
mattered to Silver, had he remembered to close the half-door of the stall
behind him; even that would not have mattered, had he not left the outer
door of the stable open also.</p>
<p>The cause of the uproar does not greatly matter, except that the Kid
became so rapturously engaged in watching the foolery of the Happy Family
that he forgot all about Silver. And since sugar produces thirst, and
Silver had not smelled water since morning, he licked the last sweet grain
from the inside of the nose bag and then walked out of the stall and the
stable and made for the creek—and a horse cannot drink with a nose
bag fastened over his face. All he can do, if he succeeds in getting his
nose into the water, is to drown himself most expeditiously and
completely.</p>
<p>Silver reached the creek unseen, sought the deepest hole and tried to
drink. Since his nose was covered with the bag he could not do so but he
fussed and splashed and thrust his head deeper until the water ran into
the bag from the top. He backed and snorted and strangled, and in a minute
he fell. Fortunately he struggled a little, and in doing so he slid
backward down the bank so that his head was up the slope a and the water
ran out of the bag, which was all that saved him.</p>
<p>He was a dead horse, to all appearances at least, when Slim spied him and
gave a yell to bring every human being on the ranch at a run. The Kid came
with the rest, gave one scream and hid his face in the Little Doctor's
skirts, and trembled so that his mother was more frightened for him than
for the horse, and had Chip carry him to the house where he could not
watch the first-aid efforts of the Happy Family.</p>
<p>They did not say anything, much. By their united strength they pulled
Silver up the bank so that his limp head hung downward. Then they began to
work over him exactly as if he had been a drowned man, except that they
did not, of course, roll him over a barrel. They moved his legs backward
and forward, they kneaded his paunch, they blew into his nostrils, they
felt anxiously for heart-beats. They sweated and gave up the fight, saying
that it was no use. They saw a quiver of the muscles over the chest and
redoubled their efforts, telling one another hopefully that he was alive,
all right. They saw finally a quiver of the nostrils as well, and one
after another they laid palms upon his heart, felt there a steady beating
and proclaimed the fact profanely.</p>
<p>They pulled him then into a more comfortable position where the sun shone
warmly and stood around him in a crude circle and watched for more
pronounced symptoms of recovery, and sent word to the Kid that his string
was going to be all right in a little while.</p>
<p>The information was lost upon the Kid, who wept hysterically in his Daddy
Chip's arms listen to anything they told him. He had seen Silver stretched
out dead, with his back in the edge of the creek and his feet sprawled at
horrible angles, and the sight obsessed him and forbade comfort. He had
killed his string; nothing was clear in his mind save that, and he
screamed with his face hidden from his little world.</p>
<p>The Little Doctor, with anxious eyes and puckered eyebrows, poured
something into a teaspoon and helped Chip fight to get it down the Kid's
throat. And the Kid shrieked and struggled and strangled, as is the way of
kids the world over, and tried to spit out the stuff and couldn't, so he
screamed the louder and held his breath until he was purple, and his
parents were scared stiff. The Old Man hobbled to the door in the midst of
the uproar and asked them acrimoniously why they didn't make that doggoned
Kid stop his howling; and when Chip, his nerves already strained to the
snapping point, told him bluntly to get out and mind his own business, he
hobbled away again muttering anathemas against the whole outfit.</p>
<p>The Countess rushed in from out of doors and wanted to know what under the
shinin' sun was the matter with that kid, and advised his frantic parents
to throw water in his face. Chip told her exactly what he had told the Old
Man, in exactly the same tone; so the Countess retreated, declaring that
he wouldn't be let to act that way if he was her kid, and that he was
plumb everlastingly spoiled.</p>
<p>The Happy Family heard the disturbance and thought the Kid was being
spanked for the accident, which put every man of them in a fighting humor
toward Chip, the Little Doctor, the Old Man and the whole world. Pink even
meditated going up to the White House to lick Chip—or at least tell
him what he thought of him—and he had plenty of sympathizers; though
they advised him half-heartedly not to buy in to any family mixup.</p>
<p>It was into this storm centre that Andy Green rode headlong with his own
burden of threatened disaster.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0004" id="link2HCH0004"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 4. ANDY TAKES A HAND IN THE GAME </h2>
<p>Andy Green was a day late in arriving at the Flying U. First he lost time
by leaving the train thirty miles short of the destination marked on his
ticket, and when he did resume his journey on the next train, he traveled
eighty-four miles beyond Dry Lake, which landed him in Great Falls in the
early morning. There, with the caution of a criminal carefully avoiding a
meeting with Miss Hallman, he spent an hour in poring over a plat of a
certain section of Chouteau County, and in copying certain description of
unoccupied land.</p>
<p>He had not slept very well the night before and he looked it. He had
cogitated upon the subject of land speculations and the welfare of his
outfit until his head was one great, dull ache; but he stuck to his
determination to do something to block the game of the Homeseekers'
Syndicate. Just what that something would be he had not yet decided. But
on general principles it seemed wise to learn all he could concerning the
particular tract of land about which Florence Grace Hallman had talked.</p>
<p>The day was past when range rights might be defended honorably with rifles
and six-shooters and iron nerved men to use them—and I fear that
Andy Green sighed because it was so. Give him the “bunch” and free swing,
and he thought the Homeseekers would lose their enthusiasm before even the
first hot wind blew up from the southwest to wither their crops. But such
measures were not to be thought of; if they fought at all they must fight
with the law behind them—and even Andy's optimism did not see much
hope from the law; none, in fact, since both the law and the moneyed
powers were eager for the coming of homebuilders into that wide land. All
up along the Marias they had built their board shacks, and back over the
benches as far as one could see. There was nothing to stop them,
everything to make their coming easy.</p>
<p>Andy scowled at the plat he was studying, and admitted to himself that it
looked as though the Home Seekers' Syndicate were going to have things
their own way; unless—There he stuck. There must be some way out;
never in his life had he faced a situation which had been absolutely
hopeless; always there had been some chance to win, if a man only saw it
in time and took it. In this case it was the clerk in the office who
pointed the way with an idle remark.</p>
<p>“Going to take up a claim, are you?”</p>
<p>Andy looked up at him with the blank stare of preoccupation, and changed
expression as the question filtered into his brain and fitted somehow into
the puzzle. He grinned, said maybe he would, folded the sheet of paper
filled with what looked like a meaningless jumble of letters and figures,
bought a plat of that township and begged some government pamphlets, and
went out humming a little tune just above a whisper. At the door he tilted
his hat down at an angle over his right eye and took long, eager steps
toward an obscure hotel and his meagre baggage.</p>
<p>There was no train going east until midnight, and he caught that train.
This time he actually got off at Dry Lake, ate a hurried breakfast, got
his horse out of the livery stable and dug up the dust of the lane with
rapid hoof-beats so that he rode all the way to the first hill followed by
a rolling, gray cloud that never quite caught him.</p>
<p>When he rode down the Hog's Back he saw the Happy Family bunched around
some object on the creek-bank, and he heard the hysterical screaming of
the Kid up in the house, and saw the Old Man limping excitedly up and down
the porch. A man less astute than Andy Green would have known that some
thing had happened. He hurried down the last slope, galloped along the
creek-bottom, crossed the ford in a couple of leaps and pulled up beside
the group that surrounded Silver.</p>
<p>“What's been taking place here?” he demanded curiously, skipping the usual
greetings.</p>
<p>“Hell,” said the Native Son succinctly, glancing up at him.</p>
<p>“Old Silver looked over the fence into Kingdom Come,” Weary enlarged the
statement a little. “Tried to take a drink with a nose bag on. I guess
he'll come through all right.”</p>
<p>“What ails the Kid?” Andy demanded, glancing toward the house whence
issued a fresh outburst of shrieks.</p>
<p>The Happy Family looked at one another and then at the White House.</p>
<p>“Aw, some folks hain't got a lick of sense when it comes to kids,” Big
Medicine accused gruffly.</p>
<p>“The Kid,” Weary explained, “put the nose bag on Silver and then left the
stable door open.”</p>
<p>“They ain't—spanking him for it, are they?” Andy demanded
belligerently. “By gracious, how'd a kid know any better? Little bit of a
tad like that—”</p>
<p>“Aw, they don't never spank the Kid!” Slim defended the parents loyally.
“By golly, they's been times when I would-a spanked him, if it'd been me.
Countess says it's plumb ridiculous the way that Kid runs over 'em—rough
shod. If he's gittin' spanked now, it's the first time.”</p>
<p>“Well,” said Andy, looking from one to another and reverting to his own
worry as he swung down from his sweating horse, “there's something worse
than a spanked kid going to happen to this outfit if you fellows don't get
busy and do something. There's a swarm of dry-farmers coming in on us,
with their stock to eat up the grass and their darned fences shutting off
the water—”</p>
<p>“Oh, for the Lord's sake, cut it out!” snapped Pink. “We ain't in the mood
for any of your joshes. We've had about enough excitement for once.”</p>
<p>“Ah, don't be a damn' fool,” Andy snapped back. “There's no josh about it.
I've got the whole scheme, just as they framed it up in Minneapolis. I got
to talking with a she-agent on the train, and she gave the whole snap
away; wanted me to go in with her and help land the suckers. I laid low,
and made a sneak to the land office and got a plat of the land, and all
the dope—”</p>
<p>“Get any mail?” Pink interrupted him, in the tone that took no notice
whatever of Andy's ill news.</p>
<p>“Time I was hearing from them spurs I sent for.” Andy silently went
through his pockets and produced what mail he had gleaned from the
post-office, and led his horse into the shade of the stable and pulled off
the saddle. Every movement betrayed the fact that he was in the grip of
unpleasant emotions, but to the Happy Family he said not another word.</p>
<p>The Happy Family did not notice his silence at the time. But afterwards,
when the Kid had stopped crying and Silver had gotten to his feet and
wobbled back to the stable, led by Chip, who explained briefly and
satisfactorily the cause of the uproar at the house, and the boys had
started up to their belated dinner, they began to realize that for a
returned traveler Andy Green was not having much to say.</p>
<p>They asked him about his trip, and received brief answers. Had he been
anyone else they would have wanted to know immediately what was eatin' on
him; but since it was Andy Green who sat frowning at his toes and smoking
his cigarette as though it had no comfort or flavor, the boldest of them
were cautious. For Andy Green, being a young man of vivid imagination and
no conscience whatever, had fooled them too often with his lies. They
waited, and they watched him covertly and a bit puzzled.</p>
<p>Silence and gloom were not boon companions of Andy Green, at any time. So
Weary, having the most charitable nature of any among them, sighed and
yielded the point of silent contention.</p>
<p>“What was all that you started to tell us about the dry-farmers, Andy?” he
asked indulgently.</p>
<p>“All straight goods. But there's no use talking to you bone-heads. You'll
set around chewing the rag and looking wise till it's too late to do
anything but holler your heads off.” He got up from where he had been
lounging on a bench just outside the mess house and walked away, with his
hands thrust deep into his pockets and his shoulders drooped forward.</p>
<p>The Happy Family looked after him doubtfully.</p>
<p>“Aw, it's just some darned josh uh his,” Happy Jack declared. “I know
HIM.”</p>
<p>“Look at the way he slouches along—like he was loaded to the ears
with trouble!” Pink pointed out amusedly. “He'd fool anybody that didn't
know him, all right.”</p>
<p>“And he fools the fellows that do know him, oftener than anybody else,”
added the Native Son negligently. “You're fooled right now if you think
that's all acting. That HOMBRE has got something on his mind.”</p>
<p>“Well, by golly, it ain't dry-farmers,” Slim asserted boldly.</p>
<p>“If you fellows wouldn't say it was a frame-up between us two, I'd go
after him and find out. But...”</p>
<p>“But as it stands, we'd believe Andy Green a whole lot quicker'n what we
would you,” supplemented Big Medicine loudly. “You're dead right there.”</p>
<p>“What was it he said about it?” Weary wanted to know. “I wasn't paying
much attention, with the Kid yelling his head off and old Silver gaping
like a sick turkey, and all. What was it about them dryfarmers?”</p>
<p>“He said,” piped Pink, “that he'd got next to a scheme to bring a big
bunch of dry-farmers in on this bench up here, with stock that they'd turn
loose on the range. That's what he said. He claims the agent wanted him to
go in on it.”</p>
<p>“Mamma!” Weary held a match poised midway between his thigh and his
cigarette while he stared at Pink. “That would be some mixup—if it
was to happen.” His sunny blue eyes—that were getting little
crow's-feet at their corners—turned to look after the departing
Andy. “Where's the josh?” he questioned the group.</p>
<p>“The josh is, that he'd like to see us all het up over it, and makin'
war-talks and laying for the pilgrims some dark night with our six-guns,
most likely,” retorted Pink, who happened to be in a bad humor because in
ten minutes he was due at a line of post-holes that divided the big
pasture into two unequal parts. “He can't agitate me over anybody's
troubles but my own. Happy, I'll help Bud stretch wire this afternoon if
you'll tamp the rest uh them posts.”</p>
<p>“Aw, you stick to your own job! How was it when I wanted you to help pull
the old wire off that hill fence and git it ready to string down here? You
wasn't crazy about workin' with bob wire then, I noticed. You said—”</p>
<p>“What I said wasn't a commencement to what I'll say again,” Pink began
truculently, and so the subject turned effectually from Andy Green.</p>
<p>Weary smoked meditatively while they wrangled, and when the group broke up
for the afternoon's work he went unobtrusively in search of Andy. He was
not quite easy in his mind concerning the alleged joke. He had looked full
at the possibilities of the situation—granting Andy had told the
truth, as he sometimes did—and the possibilities had not pleased
him. He found Andy morosely replacing some broken strands in his cinch,
and he went straight at the mooted question.</p>
<p>Andy looked up from his work and scowled. “This ain't any joke with me,”
he stated grimly. “It's something that's going to put the Flying U out of
business if it ain't stopped before it gets started. I've been worrying my
head off ever since day before yesterday; I ain't in the humor to take
anything off those imitation joshers up there—I'll tell yuh that
much.”</p>
<p>“Well, but how do you figure it can be stopped?” Weary sat soberly down on
the oats box and absently watched Andy's expert fingers while they knotted
the heavy cotton cord through the cinch-ring. “We can't stand 'em off with
guns.”</p>
<p>Andy dropped the cinch and stood up, pushing back his hat and then pulling
it forward into place with the gesture he used when he was very much in
earnest. “No, we can't. But if the bunch is game for it there's a way to
block their play—and the law does all our fighting for us. We don't
have to yeep. It's like this, Weary counting Chip and the Little Doctor
and the Countess there's eleven of us that can use our rights up here on
the bench. I've got it all figured out. If we can get Irish and Jack Bates
to come back and help us out, there's thirteen of us. And we can take
homesteads along the creeks and deserts back on the bench, and—say,
do you know how much land we can corral, the bunch of us? Four thousand
acres and if we take our claims right, that's going to mean that we get a
dead immortal cinch on all the bench land that's worth locating, around
here, and we'll have the creeks, and also we'll have the breaks corralled
for our own stock.</p>
<p>“I've gone over the plat—I brought a copy to show you fellows what
we can do. And by taking up our claims right, we keep a deadline from the
Bear Paws to the Flying U. Now the Old Man owns Denson's ranch, all south
uh here is fairly safe—unless they come in between his south line
and the breaks; and there ain't room for more than two or three claims
there. Maybe we can get some of the boys to grab what there is, and string
ourselves out north uh here too.</p>
<p>“That's the only way on earth we can save what little feed there is left.
This way, we get the land ourselves and hold it, so there don't any
outside stock come in on us. If Florence Grace Hallman and her bunch lands
any settlers here, they'll be between us and Dry Lake; and they're dead
welcome to squat on them dry pinnacles—so long as we keep their
stock from crossing our claims to get into the breaks. Savvy the burro?”</p>
<p>“Yes-s—but how'd yuh KNOW they're going to do all this? Mamma! I
don't want to turn dry-farmer if I don't have to!”</p>
<p>Andy's face clouded. “That's just what'll block the game, I'm afraid. I
don't want to, either. None of the boys'll want to. It'll mean going up
there and baching, six or seven months of the year, by our high lonesomes.
We'll have to fulfill the requirements, if we start in—because them
pilgrims'll be standing around like dogs at a picnic, waiting for
something to drop so they can grab it and run. It ain't going to be any
snap.</p>
<p>“And there's another thing bothers me, Weary. It's going to be one peach
of a job to make the boys believe it hard enough to make their entries in
time.” Andy grinned wrily. “By gracious, this is where I could see a
gilt-edged reputation for telling the truth!”</p>
<p>“You could, all right,” Weary agreed sympathetically. “It's going to
strain our swallowers to get all that down, and that's a fact. You ought
to have some proof, if you want the boys to grab it, Andy.” His face
sobered. “Who is this Florence person? If you could get some kinda proof—a
letter, say...”</p>
<p>“Easiest thing in the world!” Andy brightened at the suggestion. “She's
stopping at the Park, in Great Falls, and she wanted me to come up or
write. Anybody going to town right away? I'll send that foxy dame a letter
that'll produce proof enough. You've helped ma a lot, Weary.”</p>
<p>Weary scrutinized him sharply and puckered his lips into a doubtful
expression. “I wish I knew for a fact whether all this is straight goods,
Andy,” he said pensively. “Chances are you're just stringing me. But if
you are, old boy, I'm going to take it outa your hide—and don't you
forget that.” He grinned at his own mental predicament. “Honest, Andy, is
this some josh, or do you mean it?”</p>
<p>“By gracious, I wish it was a josh! But it ain't, darn it. In about two
weeks or so you'll all see the point of this joke—but whether the
joke's on us or on the homeseekers' Syndicate depends on you fellows.
Lord! I wish I'd never told a lie!”</p>
<p>Weary sat knocking his heels rhythmically against the side of the box
while he thought the matter over from start to hypothetical finish and
back again. Meanwhile Andy Green went on with his work and scowled over
his well-earned reputation that hampered him now just when he needed the
confidence of his fellows in order to save their beloved Flying U from
slow annihilation. Perhaps his mental suffering could not rightly be
called remorse, but a poignant regret it most certainly was, and a sense
of complete bafflement which came out in his next sentence.</p>
<p>“Even if she wrote me a letter, the boys'd call it a frame-up just the
same. They'd say I had it fixed before I left town. Doctor Cecil's up at
the Falls. They'd lay it to her.”</p>
<p>“I was thinking of that, myself. What's the matter with getting Chip to go
up with you? Couldn't you ring him in on the agent somehow, so he can get
the straight of it?”</p>
<p>Andy stood up and looked at Weary a minute. “How'd I make Chip believe me
enough to GO?” he countered. “Darn it, everything looked all smooth
sailing till I got back here to the ranch and the boys come at me with
that same old smart-aleck brand uh talk. I kinda forgot how I've lied to
'em and fooled 'em right along till they duck every time I open my face.”
His eyes were too full of trouble to encourage levity in his listener.
“You remember that time the boys' rode off and left me laying out here on
the prairie with my leg broke?” he went on dismally. “I'd rather have that
happen to me a dozen times than see 'em set back and give me the laugh
now, just when—Oh, hell!” He dropped the finished cinch and walked
moodily to the door. “Weary, if them dry-farmers come flockin' in on us
while this bunch stands around callin' me a liar, I—” He did not
attempt to finish the sentence; but Weary, staring curiously at Andy's
profile, saw a quivering of the muscles around his lips and felt a
responsive thrill of sympathy and belief that rose above his long training
in caution.</p>
<p>Spite of past experience he believed, at that moment, every word which
Andy Green had uttered upon the subject of the proposed immigration. He
was about to tell Andy so, when Chip walked unexpectedly out of Silver's
stall and glanced from Weary to Andy standing still in the doorway. Weary
looked at him enquiringly; for Chip must have heard every word they said,
and if Chip believed it—</p>
<p>“Have you got that plat with you, Andy?” Chip asked tersely and with never
a doubt in his tone.</p>
<p>Andy swung toward him like a prisoner who has just heard a jury return a
verdict of not guilty to the judge. “I've got it, yes,” he answered
simply, with only his voice betraying the emotions he felt—and his
eye? “Want it?”</p>
<p>“I'll take a look at it, if it's handy,” said Chip.</p>
<p>Andy felt in his inside coat pocket, drew out a thin, folded map of that
particular part of the county with all the government land marked upon it,
and handed it to Chip without a word. He singled out a couple of pamphlets
from a bunch of old letters such as men are in the habit of carrying upon
their persons, and gave them to Chip also.</p>
<p>“That's a copy of the homestead and desert laws,” he said. “I guess you
heard me telling Weary what kinda deal we're up against, here. Better not
say anything to the Old Man till you have to; no use worrying him—he
can't do nothing.” It was amazing, the change that had come over Andy's
face and manner since Chip first spoke. Now he grinned a little.</p>
<p>“If you want to go in on this deal,” he said quizzically, “maybe it'll be
just as well if you talk to the bunch yourself about it, Chip. You ain't
any tin, angel, but I'm willing to admit the boys'll believe you; a whole
lot quicker than they would me.”</p>
<p>“Yes—and they'll probably hand me a bunch of pity for getting stung
by you,” Chip retorted. “I'll take a chance, anyway—but the Lord
help you, Andy if you can't produce proof when the time comes.”</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0005" id="link2HCH0005"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 5. THE HAPPY FAMILY TURN NESTERS </h2>
<p>“Say, Andy, where's them dry-farmers?” Big Medicine inquired at the top of
his voice when the Happy Family had reached the biscuit-and-syrup stage of
supper that evening.</p>
<p>“Oh, they're trying to make up their minds whether to bring the old
fannin'-mill along or sell it and buy new when they get here,” Andy
informed him imperturbably. “The women-folks are busy going through their
rag bags, cutting the buttons off all the pants that ain't worth patching
no more, and getting father's socks all darned up.”</p>
<p>The Happy Family snickered appreciatively; this was more like the Andy
Green with whom they were accustomed to deal.</p>
<p>“What's daughter doin', about now?” asked Cal Emmett, fixing his round,
baby-blue stare upon Andy.</p>
<p>“Daughter? Why, daughter's leaning over the gate telling him she wouldn't
never LOOK at one of them wild cowboys—the idea! She's heard all
about 'em, and they're too rough and rude for HER. And she's promising to
write every day, and giving him a lock of hair to keep in the back of his
dollar watch. Pass the cane Juice, somebody.”</p>
<p>“Yeah—all right for daughter. If she's a good looker we'll see if
she don't change her verdict about cowboys.”</p>
<p>“Who will? You don't call yourself one, do yuh?” Pink flung at him
quickly.</p>
<p>“Well, that depends; I know I ain't any LADY broncho—hey, cut it
out!” This last because of half a biscuit aimed accurately at the middle
of his face. If you want to know why, search out the history of a certain
War Bonnet Roundup, wherein Pink rashly impersonated a lady
broncho-fighter.</p>
<p>“Wher'e they going to live when they git here?” asked Happy Jack,
reverting to the subject of dry farmers.</p>
<p>“Close enough so you can holler from here to their back door, my boy—if
they have their say about it,” Andy assured him cheerfully. Andy felt that
he could afford to be facetious now that he had Chip and Weary on his
side.</p>
<p>“Aw, gwan! I betche there ain't a word of truth in all that scarey talk,”
Happy Jack fleered heavily.</p>
<p>“Name your bet. I'll take it.” Andy filled his mouth with hot biscuit and
stirred up the sugar in his coffee like a man who is occupied chiefly with
the joys of the table.</p>
<p>“Aw, you ain't going to git me that way agin,” Happy Jack declared.
“They's some ketch to it.”</p>
<p>“There sure is, Happy. The biggest ketch you ever seen in your life. It's
ketch the Flying U outfit and squeeze the life out of it; that's the
ketch.” Andy's tone had in it no banter, but considerable earnestness.
For, though Chip would no doubt convince the boys that the danger was very
real, there was a small matter of personal pride to urge Andy into trying
to convince, them himself, without aid from Chip or any one else.</p>
<p>“Well, by golly, I'd like to see anybody try that there scheme,” blurted
Slim. “That's all—I'd just like to see 'em TRY it once!”</p>
<p>“Oh, you'll see it, all right—and you won't have to wait long,
either. Just set around on your haunches a couple of weeks or so. That's
all you'll have to do, Slim; you'll see it tried, fast enough.”</p>
<p>Pink eyed him with a wide, purple glance. “You'd like to make us fall for
that, wouldn't you?” he challenged warily.</p>
<p>Andy gave him a level look. “No, I wouldn't. I'd like to put one over on
you smart gazabos that think you know it all; but I don't want to bad
enough to see the Flying U go outa business just so I could holler
didn't-I-tell-you. There's a limit to what I'll pay for a josh.”</p>
<p>“Well,” put in the Native Son with his easy drawl, “I'm coming to the
centre with my ante, just for the sake of seeing the cards turned. Deal
'em out, amigo; state your case once more, so we can take a good, square
look at these dry-farmers.”</p>
<p>“Yeah—go ahead and tell us what's bustin' the buttons off your
vest,” Cal Emmett invited.</p>
<p>“What's the use?” Andy argued. “You'd all just raise up on your hind legs
and holler your heads off. You wouldn't DO anything about it—not if
you knew it was the truth!” This, of course, was pure guile upon his part.</p>
<p>“Oh, wouldn't we? I guess, by golly, we'd do as much for the outfit as
what you would—and a hull lot more if it come to a show-down.” Slim
swallowed the bait.</p>
<p>“Maybe you would, if you could take it out in talking,” snorted Andy. “My
chips are in. I've got three-hundred-and-twenty acres picked out, up here,
and I'm going to file on 'em before these damned nesters get off the
train. Uh course, that won't be more'n a flea bite—but I can make it
interesting for my next door neighbors, anyway; and every flea bite helps
to keep a dog moving, yuh know.”</p>
<p>“I'll go along and use my rights,” Weary offered suddenly and seriously.
“That'll make one section they won't get, anyway.”</p>
<p>Pink gave him a startled look across the table. “You ain't going to grab
it, are yuh?” he demanded disappointedly.</p>
<p>“I sure am—if it's three-hundred-and-twenty acres of land you mean.
If I don't, somebody else will.” He sighed humorously. “Next summer you'll
see me hoeing spuds, most likely—if the law says I GOT to.”</p>
<p>“Haw-haw-haw-w!” laughed Big Medicine suddenly. “It'd sure be worth the
price, jest to ride up and watch you two marks down on all fours weedin'
onions.” He laughed again with his big, bull-like bellow.</p>
<p>“We don't have to do anything like that if we don't want to,” put in Andy
Green calmly. “I've been reading up on the law. There's one little joker
in it I've got by heart. It says that homestead land can be used for
grazing purposes if it's more valuable for pasture than for crops, and
that actual grazing will be accepted instead of cultivation—if it is
grazing land. So—”</p>
<p>“I betche you can't prove that,” Happy lack interrupted him. “I never
heard of that before—”</p>
<p>“The world's plumb full of things you never heard of, Happy,” Andy told
him witheringly. “I gave Chip my copy of the homestead laws, and a plat of
the land up here; soon as he hands 'em back I can show you in cold print
where it says that very identical thing.</p>
<p>“That's what makes it look good to me, just on general principles,” he
went on, his honest, gray eyes taking in the circle of attentive faces.
“If the bunch of us could pool our interests and use what rights we got,
we can corral about four thousand acres—and we can head off
outsiders from grazing in the Badlands, if we take our land right. We've
been overlooking a bet, and don't you forget it. We've been fooling
around, just putting in our time and drawing wages, when we could be
owning our own grazing land by now and shipping our own cattle, if we had
enough sense to last us overnight.</p>
<p>“A-course, I ain't crazy about turning nester, myself—but we've let
things slide till we've got to come through or get outa the game. It's a
fact, boys, about them dry-farmers coming in on us. That Minneapolis bunch
that the blonde lady works for is sending out a colony of farmers to take
up this land between here and the Bear Paws. The lady tipped her hand, not
knowing where I ranged and thinking I wouldn't be interested in anything
but her. She's a real nice lady, too, and goodlooking—but a grafter
to her last eye winker. And she hit too close home to suit me, when she
named the place where they're going to dump their colony.”</p>
<p>“Where does the graft come in?” inquired Pink cautiously. “The farmers get
the land, don't they?”</p>
<p>“Sure, they get the land. And they pungle up a good-sized fee to Florence
Grace Hallman and her outfit, for locating 'em. Also there's side money in
it, near as I can find out. They skin the farmers somehow on the fare out
here. That's their business, according to the lady. They prowl around
through the government plats till they spot a few thousand acres of land
in a chunk; they take a look at it, maybe, and then they boom it like
hell, and get them eastern marks hooked—them with money, the lady
said. Then they ship a bunch out here, locate 'em on the land and leave it
up to THEM, whether they scratch a living or not. She said they urge the
rubes to bring all the stock they can, because there's plenty of range
left. She says they play that up big. You can see for yourself how that'll
work out, around here!”</p>
<p>Pink eyed him attentively, and suddenly his dimples stood deep. “All
right, I'm It,” he surrendered.</p>
<p>“It'd be a sin not to fall for a yarn like that, Andy. I expect you made
it all up outa your own head, but that's all right. It's a pleasure to be
fooled by a genius like you. I'll go raising turnips and cabbages myself.”</p>
<p>“By golly, you couldn't raise nothing but hell up on that dry bench,” Slim
observed ponderously. “There ain't any water. What's the use uh talking
foolish?”</p>
<p>“They're going to tackle it, just the same,” Andy pointed out patiently.</p>
<p>“Well, by golly, if you ain't just lyin' to hear yourself, that there
graftin' bunch had oughta be strung up!”</p>
<p>“Sure, they had. Nobody's going to argue about that. But seeing we can't
do that, the next best thing is to beat them to it. If they came out here
with their herd of pilgrims and found the land all took up—” Andy
smiled hypnotically upon the goggling group.</p>
<p>“Haw-haw-haw-w!” bawled Big Medicine. “It'd be wuth it, by cripes!”</p>
<p>“Yeah—it would, all right. If that talk Andy's been giving us is
straight, about grazing the land instead uh working it—”</p>
<p>“You can mighty quick find out,” Andy retorted. “Go up and ask Chip for
them land laws, and that plat. And ask him what he thinks about the deal.
You don't have to take my word for it.” Andy grinned virtuously and pushed
back his chair. From their faces, and the remarks they had made, he felt
very confident of the ultimate decision. “What about you, Patsy?” he asked
suddenly, turning to the bulky, bald German cook who was thumping bread
dough in a far corner. “You got any homestead or desert rights you ain't
used?”</p>
<p>“Py cosh, I got all der rights dere iss,” Patsy returned querulously. “I
got more rights as you shmartys. I got soldier's rights mit fightin'. Und
py cosh, I use him too if dem fellers coom by us mit der dry farms
alreatty!”</p>
<p>“Well, you son-of-a-gun!” Andy smote him elatedly upon a fat shoulder.
“What do you know about old Patsy for a dead game sport? By gracious, that
makes another three hundred and twenty to the good. Gee, it's lucky this
bunch has gone along turning up their noses at nesters and thinkin' they
couldn't be real punchers and hold down claims too. If any of us had had
sense enough to grab a piece of land and settle down to raise families,
we'd be right up against it now. We'd have to set back and watch a bunch
of down-east rubes light down on us like flies on spilt molasses, and we
couldn't do a thing.”</p>
<p>“As it is, we'll all turn nesters for the good of the cause!” finished
Pink somewhat cynically, getting up and following Cal and Slim to the
door.</p>
<p>“Aw, I betche they's some ketch to it!” gloomed Happy Jack. “I betche Andy
jest wants to see us takin' up claims on that dry bench, and then set back
and laugh at us fer bitin' on his josh.”</p>
<p>“Well, you'll have the claims, won't you. And if you hang onto them
there'll be money in the deal some day. Why, darn your bomb-proof skull,
can't you get it into your system that all this country's bound to settle
up?” Andy's eyes snapped angrily. “Can't you see the difference between us
owning the land between here and the mountains, and a bunch of outsiders
that'll cut it all up into little fields and try to farm it. If you can't
see that, you better go hack a hole in your head with an axe, so an idea
can squeeze in now and then when you ain't looking!”</p>
<p>“Well, I betche there ain't no colony comin' to settle that there bench,”
Happy Jack persisted stubbornly.</p>
<p>“Yes there is, by cripes!” trumpeted Big Medicine behind him. “Yes there
is! And that there colony is goin' to be us, and don't you forget it. It's
time I was doin' somethin' fer that there boy uh mine, by cripes! And soon
as we git that fence strung I'm goin' to hit the trail fer the nearest
land office. Honest to grandma, if Andy's lyin' it's goin' to be the
prof't'blest lie HE ever told, er anybody else. I don't care a cuss about
whether them dry-farmers is fixin' to light here or not. That there
land-pool looks good to ME, and I'm comin' in on it with all four feet!”</p>
<p>Big Medicine was nothing less than a human land slide when once he threw
himself into anything, be it a fight or a frolic. Now he blocked the way
to the door with his broad shoulders and his big bellow and his
enthusiasm, and his pale, frog-like eyes fixed their protruding stare
accusingly upon the reluctant ones.</p>
<p>“Cal, you git up there and git that plat and bring it here,” he ordered.
“And fer criminy sakes git that table cleared off, Patsy, so's't we kin
have a place to lay it! What's eatin' on you fellers, standin' around like
girls to a party, waitin' fer somebody to come up and ast you to dance!
Ain't you got head enough to see what a cinch we got, if we only got sense
enough to play it! Honest to grandma you make me sick to look at yuh! Down
in Conconino County the boys wouldn't stand back and wait to be
purty-pleased into a thing like this. You're so scared Andy's got a josh
covered up somewheres, you wouldn't take a drink uh whisky if he ast yuh
up to the bar! You'd pass up a Chris'mas turkey, by cripes, if yuh seen
Andy washin' his face and lookin' hungry! You'd—”</p>
<p>What further reproach he would have heaped upon them was interrupted by
Chip, who opened the door just then and bumped Big Medicine in the back.
In his hand Chip carried the land plat and the pamphlets, and in his keen,
brown eyes he carried the light of battle for his outfit. The eyes of Andy
Green sent bright glances from him to Big Medicine, and on to the others.
He was too wise then to twit those others with their unbelief. His wisdom
went farther than that; for he remained very much in the background of the
conversation and contented himself with answering, briefly and truthfully,
the questions they put to him about Florence Grace Hallman and the things
she had so foolishly divulged concerning her plans.</p>
<p>Chip spread the plat upon an end of the table hastily and effectually
cleared by a sweep of Big Medicine's arm, and the Happy Family crowded
close to stare down at the checker-board picture of their own familiar
bench land. They did not doubt, now—nor did they Hang back
reluctantly. Instead they followed eagerly the trail Chip's
cigarette-yellowed finger took across the map, and they listened intently
to what he said about that trail.</p>
<p>The clause about grazing the land, he said, simplified matters a whole
lot. It was a cinch you couldn't turn loose and dry-farm that land and
have even a fair chance of reaping a harvest. But as grazing land they
could hold all the land along One Man Creek—and that was a lot. And
the land lying back of that, and higher up toward the foothills, they
could take as desert. And he maintained that Andy had been right in his
judgment: If they all went into it and pulled together they could stretch
a line of claims that would protect the Badland grazing effectually.</p>
<p>“I wouldn't ask you fellows to go into this,” said Chip, straightening
from his stooping over the map and looking from one sober face to another,
“just to help the outfit. But it'll be a good thing for you boys. It'll
give you a foothold—something better than wages, if you stay with
your claims and prove up. Of course, I can't say anything about us buying
out your claims—that's fraud, according to Hoyle; but you ain't
simple-minded—you know your land won't be begging for a buyer, in
case you should ever want to sell.</p>
<p>“There's another thing. This will not only head off the dry-farmers from
overstocking what little range is left—it'll make a dead-line for
sheep, too. We've been letting 'em graze back and forth on the bench back
here beyond our leased land, and not saying much, so long as they didn't
crowd up too close, and kept going. With all our claims under fence, do
you realize what that'll mean for the grass?”</p>
<p>“Josephine! There's feed for considerable stock, right over there on our
claims, to say nothing of what we'll cover,” exclaimed Pink.</p>
<p>“I'd tell a man! And if we get water on the desert claims—” Chip
grinned down at him. “See what we've been passing up, all this time. We've
had some of it leased, of course—but that can't be done again.
There's been some wire-pulling, and because we ain't politicians we got
turned down when the Old Man wanted to renew the lease. I can see now why
it was, maybe. This dry-farm business had something to do with it, if you
ask me.”</p>
<p>“Gee whiz! And here we've been calling Andy a liar,” sighed Cal Emmett.</p>
<p>“Aw, jest because he happened to tell the truth once, don't cut no ice,”
Happy Jack maintained with sufficient ambiguity to avert the natural
consequences.</p>
<p>“Of course, it won't be any gold-mine,” Chip added dispassionately. “But
it's worth picking up, all right; and if it'll keep out a bunch of
tight-fisted settlers that don't give a darn for anything but what's
inside their own fence, that's worth a lot, too.”</p>
<p>“Say, my dad's a farmer,” Pink declared defiantly in his soft treble. “And
while I think of it, them eastern farmers ain't so worse—not the
brand I've seen, anyway. They're narrow, maybe—but they're human.
Damn it, you fellows have got to quit talking about 'em as if they were
blackleg stock or grasshoppers or something.”</p>
<p>“We ain't saying nothing aginst farmers AS farmers, Little One” Big
Medicine explained forebearingly. “As men, and as women, and as kids,
they're mighty nice folks. My folks have got an eighty-acre farm in
Wisconsin,” he confessed unexpectedly, “and I think a pile of 'em. But if
they was to come out here, trying to horn in on our range, I'd lead 'em
gently to the railroad, by cripes, and tell 'em goodbye so's't they'd know
I meant it! Can't yuh see the difference?” he bawled, goggling at Pink
with misleading savageness in his ugly face.</p>
<p>“Oh, I see,” Pink admitted mildly. “I only just wanted to remind you
fellows that I don't mean anything personal and I don't want you to. Say,
what about One Man Coulee?” he asked suddenly. “That's marked vacant on
the map. I always thought—”</p>
<p>“Sure, you did!” Chip grinned at him wisely, “because we used it for a
line camp, you thought we owned a deed to it. Well, we don't. We had that
land leased, is all.”</p>
<p>“Say, by golly, I'll file on that, then,” Slim declared selfishly. For One
Man coulee, although a place of gruesome history, was also desirable for
one or two reasons. There was wood, for instance, and water, and a cabin
that was habitable. There was also a fence on the place, a corral and a
small stable. “If Happy's ghost don't git to playin' music too much,” he
added with his heavy-handed wit.</p>
<p>“No, sir! You ain't going to have One Man coulee unless Andy, here, says
he don't want it!” shouted Big Medicine. “I leave it to Chip if Andy
hadn't oughta have first pick. He's the feller that's put us onto this, by
cripes, and he's the feller that's going to pick his claim first.”</p>
<p>Chip did not need to sanction that assertion. The whole Happy Family
agreed unanimously that it should be so, except Slim, who yielded a bit
unwillingly.</p>
<p>Till midnight and after, they bent heads over the plat and made plans for
the future and took no thought whatever of the difficulties that might lie
before them. For the coming colony they had no pity, and for the balked
schemes of the Homeseekers' Syndicate no compunctions whatever.</p>
<p>So Andy Green, having seen his stratagem well on the way to success, and
feeling once more the well-earned confidence of his fellows, slept soundly
that night in his own bed, serenely sure of the future.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0006" id="link2HCH0006"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 6. THE FIRST BLOW IN THE FIGHT </h2>
<p>Letters went speeding to Irish and Jack Bates, absent members of the Happy
Family of the Flying U; letters that explained the situation with profane
completeness, set forth briefly the plan of the proposed pool, and which
importuned them to come home or make haste to the nearest land-office and
file upon certain quarter-sections therein minutely described. Those men
who would be easiest believed wrote and signed the letters, and certain
others added characteristic postscripts best calculated to bring results.</p>
<p>After that, the Happy Family debated upon the boldness of going in a body
to Great Falls to file upon their claims, or the caution of proceeding
instead to Glasgow where the next nearest land-office might be found. Slim
and Happy Jack favored caution and Glasgow. The others sneered at their
timidity, as they were wont to do.</p>
<p>“Yuh think Florence Grace Hallman is going to stand guard with a six-gun?”
Andy challenged at last. “She's tied up till her colony gets there. She
can't file on all that land herself, can she?” He smiled reminiscently.
“The lady asked me to come up to the Falls and see her,” he said softly.
“I'm going. The rest of you can take the same train, I reckon—she
won't stop you from it, and I won't. And who's to stop you from filing?
The land's there, open for settlement. At least it was open, day before
yesterday.”</p>
<p>“Well, by golly, the sooner we go the better,” Slim declared fussily.
“That fencin' kin wait. We gotta go and git back before Chip wants to
start out the wagons, too.”</p>
<p>“Listen here, hombres,” called the Native Son from the window, where he
had been studying the well-thumbed pamphlet containing the homestead law.
“If we want to play dead safe on this, we all better quit the outfit
before we go. Call for our time. I don't like the way some of this stuff
reads.”</p>
<p>“I don't like the way none of it reads,” grumbled Happy Jack. “I betche we
can't make it go; they's some ketch to it. We'll never git a patent. I'll
betche anything yuh like.”</p>
<p>“Well, pull out of the game, then!” snapped Andy Green, whose nerves were
beginning to feel the strain put upon them.</p>
<p>“I ain't in it yet,” said Happy Jack sourly, and banged the door shut upon
his departure.</p>
<p>Andy scowled and returned to studying the map. Finally he reached for his
hat and gloves in the manner of one who has definitely made up his mind to
some thing.</p>
<p>“Well, the rest of you can do as you darned please,” he delivered his
ultimatum from the doorway. “I'm going to catch up my horse, draw a
month's wages and hit the trail. I can catch the evening train to the
Falls, easy, and be ready to file on my chunk first thing in the morning.”</p>
<p>“Ain't in any rush, are yuh?” Pink inquired facetiously. “If I had my
dinner settled and this cigarette smoked, I might go along—provided
you don't take the trail with yuh.”</p>
<p>“Hold on, boys, and listen to this,” the Native Son called out
imperatively. “I think we better get a move on, too; but we want to get a
fair running start, and not fall over this hump. Listen here! We've got to
swear that it is not for the benefit of any other person, persons or
corporation, and so on; and farther along it says we must not act in
collusion with any person, persons or corporation, to give them the
benefit of the land. There's more of the same kind, too, but you see—”</p>
<p>“Well, who's acting in collusion? What's collusion mean anyhow?” Slim
demanded aggressively.</p>
<p>“It means what we're aiming to do—if anybody could prove it on us,”
explained the Native Son. “My oldest brother's a lawyer, and I caught some
of it from him. And my expert, legal advice is this: to get into a row
with the Old Man, maybe—anyway, quit him cold, so we get our time.
We must let that fact percolate the alleged brains of Dry Lake and
vicinity—and if we give any reason for taking claims right under the
nose of the Flying U, why, we're doing it to spite the Old Man. Sabe?
Otherwise we're going to have trouble—unless that colony scheme is
just a pipe dream of Andy's.”</p>
<p>The Happy Family had learned to respect the opinions of the Native Son,
whose mixture of Irish blood with good Castilian may have had something to
do with his astuteness. Once, as you may have heard, the Native Son even
scored in a battle of wits with Andy Green, and scored heavily. And he had
helped Andy pull the Flying U out of an extremely ticklish situation, by
his keen wit saving the outfit much trouble and money. Wherefore they
heeded now his warning to the extent of unsmilingly discussing the
obstacle he had pointed out to them. One after another they read the
paragraph which they had before passed over too hastily, and sensed the
possibilities of its construction. Afterward they went into serious
consultation as to ways and means, calling Happy Jack back so that he
might understand thoroughly what must be done. For the Happy Family was
nothing if not thorough, and their partisanship that had been growing
insensibly stronger through the years was roused as it had not been since
Dunk Whittaker drove sheep in upon the Flying U.</p>
<p>The Old Man, having eaten a slice of roast pork the size of his two hands,
in defiance of his sister's professional prohibition of the indulgence,
was sitting on the sunny side of the porch trying to ignore the first
uneasy symptoms of indigestion. The Little Doctor had taken his pipe away
from him that morning, and had badgered him into taking a certain
decoction whose taste lingered bitterly. The paper he was reading was four
days old and he disagreed with its political policy, and there was no
telling when anyone would have time to go in after the mail and his
favorite paper. Ranch work was growing heavier each year in proportion to
the lightening of range work. He was going to sow another twenty acres of
alfalfa, and to do that he must cut down the size of his pasture—something
that always went against the grain. He had not been able to renew his
lease of government land,—which also went against the grain. And the
Kid, like the last affliction which the Lord sent unto Job—I've
forgotten whether that was boils or the butchery of his offspring—came
loping down the length of the porch and kicked the Old Man's bunion with a
stubby boot-toe.</p>
<p>Thus was born the psychological moment when the treachery of the Happy
Family would cut deepest.</p>
<p>They came, bunched and talking low-voiced together with hatbrims hiding
shamed eyes, a type-true group of workers bearing a grievance. Not a man
was absent—the Happy Family saw to that! Even Patsy, big and sloppy
and bearing with him stale kitchen odors, limped stolidly in the rear
beside Slim, who looked guilty as though he had been strangling somebody's
favorite cat.</p>
<p>The Old Man, bent head-foremost over his growing paunch that he might
caress his outraged bunion, glared at them with belligerent curiosity from
under his graying eyebrows. The group came on and stopped short at the
steps—and I don't suppose the Happy Family will ever look such
sneaks again whatever crime they may commit. The Old Man straightened with
a grunt of pain because of his lame back, and waited. Which made it all
the harder for the Happy Family, especially for Andy Green who had been
chosen spokesman—for his sins perhaps.</p>
<p>“We'd like our time,” blurted Andy after an unpleasant silence, and fixed
his eyes frigidly upon the lowest rung of the Old Man's chair.</p>
<p>“Oh, you would, hunh? The whole bunch of yuh?” The Old Man eyed them
incredulously.</p>
<p>“Yes, the whole bunch of us. We're going to quit.”</p>
<p>The Old Man's jaw dropped a little, but his eyes didn't waver from their
Hangdog faces. “Well, I never coaxed a man to stay yet,” he stated grimly,
“and I'm gittin' too old in the business to start coaxin' now. Dell!” He
turned stiffly in his chair so that he faced the open door. “Bring me my
time and check books outa the desk!”</p>
<p>A gray hardness came slowly to the Old Man's face while he waited, his
seamed hands gripping the padded arms of his chair. A tightness pulled at
his lips behind the grizzled whiskers. It never occurred to him now that
the Happy Family might be perpetrating one of their jokes. He had looked
at their faces, you see. They meant to quit him—quit him cold just
as spring work was beginning. They were ashamed of themselves, of course;
they had a right to be ashamed, he thought bitterly. It hurt—hurt so
that he would have died before he would ask for excuse, reason, grievance,
explanation—for whatever motive impelled them. So he waited, and he
gripped the arms of his chair, and he clamped his mouth shut and did not
speak a word.</p>
<p>The Happy Family had expected him to swear at them stormily; to accuse
them of vile things; to call them such names as his memory could seize
upon or his ingenuity invent. They had been careful to prepare a list of
plausible reasons for leaving then. They had first invented a gold rumor
that they hoped would sound convincing, but Andy had insisted upon telling
him straightforwardly that they did not favor fence-building and
ditch-digging and such back-breaking toil; that they were range men and
they demanded range work or none; that if they must dig ditches and build
fences and perform like menial tasks, they preferred doing it for
themselves. “That,” said Andy, “makes us out such dirty, low-down
sons-of-guns we'd have to climb a tree to look a snake in the eye, but
it's got the grain of truth that'll make it go down. We DON'T love this
farming graft, and the Old Man knows it. He's heard us kicking often
enough. That's where it'll git him. He'll believe this last stretch of
fence is what made us throw him down, and he'll be so mad he'll cuss us
out till the neighbors'll think the smoke's a prairie fire. We'll get our
time, all right' and the things he'll say will likely make us so hot we
can all talk convincing when we hit town. Keep a stiff upper lip, boys. We
got to do it, and he'll make us mad, so it won't be as hard as you
imagine.”</p>
<p>The theory was good, and revealed a knowledge of human nature that made
one cease to wonder why Andy was a prince of convincing liars. The theory
was good—nothing in the world was the matter with it, except that in
this particular instance it did not work. The Old Man did not ask for
their reasons, excuses or explanations. Neither did he say anything or do
anything to make them mad. He just sat there, with his face gray and hard,
and said nothing at all.</p>
<p>The Little Doctor appeared with the required books and a fountain pen; saw
the Happy Family standing there like condemned men at the steps; saw the
Old Man's face, and trembled wide-eyed upon the verge of speech. Then she
decided that this was no time for questioning and hurried, still wide of
eye, away from sight of them. The Happy Family did not look at one another—they
looked chiefly at the wall of the house.</p>
<p>The Old Man reckoned the wages due each one, and wrote a check for the
exact amount. And he spoke no word that did not intimately concern the
matter in hand. He still had that gray, hard look in his face that froze
whatever explanation they would otherwise have volunteered. And when he
handed the last man—who was Patsy—his check, he got up stiffly
and turned his back on them, and went inside and closed the door while yet
they lingered, waiting to explain.</p>
<p>At the bunk-house, whence they walked silently, Slim turned suddenly upon
their leader. His red face had gone a sallow white, and the whites of his
eyes were veined with red.</p>
<p>“If that there land business falls down anywhere because you lied to us,
Andy Green' I'll kill you fer this” he stated flatly.</p>
<p>“If it Does, Slim, I'll stand and let yuh shoot me as full of lead as you
like,” Andy promised, in much the same tone. Then he strove to shake off
the spell of the Old Man's stricken silence. “Buck up, boys. He'll thank
us for what we aim to do—when he knows all about it.”</p>
<p>“Well, it seems to me,” sighed Weary lugubriously, “we mighta managed it
without hitting the Old Man a wallop in the back, like that.”</p>
<p>“How'n hell did I know he'd take it the way he did?” Andy questioned
sharply, and began throwing his personal belongings into his “war-bag” as
if he had a grudge against his own clothes.</p>
<p>“Aw, looks to me like he was glad to git shet of us!” grumbled Happy Jack.
“I betche he's more tickled than sorry, right now.”</p>
<p>It was an exceedingly unhappy Family that rode up the Hog's Back upon
their private mounts, and away from the Flying U; in spite of Chip's
assurance that he would tell the Old Man all about it as soon as he could,
it was an ill-humored Family that rode into Dry Lake and cashed their
several checks at the desk of the General store which also did an informal
banking business, and afterwards took the train for Great Falls.</p>
<p>The news spread through the town that old J. G. Whitmore had fired the
Happy Family in a bunch for some unforgivable crime against the peace and
dignity of the outfit, and that the boys were hatching up some scheme to
get even. From the gossip that was rolled relishfully upon the tongues of
the Dry Lake scandal lovers, the Happy Family must have been more than
sufficiently convincing.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0007" id="link2HCH0007"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 7. THE COMING OF THE COLONY </h2>
<p>If you would see northern Montana at its most beautiful best, you should
see it in mid-May when the ground-swallows are nesting and the meadow
larks are puffing their throats and singing of their sweet ecstasy with
life; when curlews go sailing low over the green, grassy billows, peering
and perking with long bills thrust rapier-wise through the sunny
stillness, and calling shrilly, “Cor-r-ECK, cor-r-eck!”—which, I
take it, is simply their opinion of world and weather given tersely in
plain English. You should see the high prairies then, when all the world
is a-shimmer with green velvet brocaded brightly in blue and pink and
yellow flower-patterns; when the heat waves go quivering up to meet the
sun, so that the far horizons wave like painted drop-scenes stirred by a
breeze; when a hypnotic spell of peace and bright promises is woven over
the rangeland—you should see it then, if you would love it with a
sweet unreason that will last you through all the years to come.</p>
<p>The homeseekers' Syndicate, as represented by Florence Grace Hallman—she
of the wheat-yellow hair and the tempting red lips and the narrow,
calculating eyes and stubborn chin—did well to wait for the spell of
the prairies when the wind flowers and the lupines blue the hillsides and
the new grass paints green the hollows.</p>
<p>There is in us all a deep-rooted instinct to create, and never is that
instinct so nearly dominant as in the spring when the grass and the
flowers and the little, new leaves and the birds all sing the song of
Creation together. Then is when case-hardened city dwellers study the
bright array of seed-packets in the stores, and meditate rashly upon the
possibilities of back-yard gardening. Then is when the seasoned
country-dwellers walk over their farms in the sunset and plan largely for
harvest time. Then is when the salaried-folk read avidly the real-estate
advertisements, and pore optimistically over folders and dream of chicken
ranches and fruit ranches and the like. Surely, then, the homeseekers'
Syndicate planned well the date of their excursion into the land of large
promise (and problematical fulfillment) which lay east of Dry Lake.</p>
<p>Rumors of the excursion seeped through the channels of gossip and set the
town talking and chuckling and speculating—after the manner of very
small towns.</p>
<p>Rumors grew to definite though erroneous statements of what was to take
place. Definite statements became certified facts that bore fruit in
detailed arrangements.</p>
<p>Came Florence Grace Hallman smilingly from Great Falls, to canvass the
town for “accommodations.” Florence Grace Hallman was a capable woman and
a persuasive one, though perhaps a shade too much inclined to take certain
things for granted—such as Andy's anchored interest in her and her
project, and the probability of the tract remaining just as it had been
when last she went carefully over the plat in the land office. Florence
Grace Hallman had been busy arranging the details of the coming of the
colony, and she had neglected to visit the land office lately. Since she
cannily represented the excursion as being merely a sight-seeing trip—or
some such innocuous project—she failed also to receive any inkling
of recent settlements.</p>
<p>On a certain sunny morning in mid-May, the Happy Family stood upon the
depot platform and waited for the westbound passenger, that had attached
to it the special car of the homeseekers' Syndicate. The Happy Family had
been very busy during the past three weeks. They had taken all the land
they could, and had sighed because they could still look from their claims
upon pinnacles as yet unclaimed save by the government. They had done
well. From the south line of Meeker's land in the very foothills of the
Bear Paws, to the north line of the Flying U, the chain of newly-filed
claims remained unbroken. It had taken some careful work upon the part of
the Happy Family to do this and still choose land not absolutely worthless
except from a scenic viewpoint. But they had managed it, with some
bickering and a good deal of maneuvering. Also they had hauled loads of
lumber from Dry Lake, wherewith to build their monotonously modest
ten-by-twelve shacks with one door and one window apiece and a round hole
in the roof big enough for a length of stove-pipe to thrust itself
aggressively into the open and say by its smoke signal whether the owner
was at home. And now, having heard of the mysterious excursion due that
day, they had come to see just what would take place.</p>
<p>“She's fifteen minutes late,” the agent volunteered, thrusting his head
through the open window. “Looking for friends, boys?”</p>
<p>“Andy is,” Pink informed him cheerfully. “The rest of us are just hanging
around through sympathy. It's his girl coming.”</p>
<p>“Well, I guess he thinks he needs a housekeeper now,” the agent grinned.
“Why don't you fellows get busy now and rustle some cooks?”</p>
<p>“Girls don't like to cook over a camp-fire,” Cal Emmett told him soberly.
“We kinda thought we ought to build our shacks first.”</p>
<p>“You can pick you out some when the train gets in,” said the agent,
accepting a match from Weary. “There's a carload of—” He pulled in
his head hurriedly and laid supple fingers on the telegraph key to answer
a call, and the Happy Family moved down to the other end of the platform
where there was more shade.</p>
<p>The agent presently appeared pushing the truck of outgoing express, a
cheap trunk and a basket “telescope” belonging to one of the hotel girls—who
had quit her job and was sitting now inside waiting for the train and
seeing what she could of the Flying U boys through the window—and
the mail sack. He placed the truck where the baggage car would come to a
halt, stood for a minute looking down the track where a smudge of smoke
might at any moment be expected to show itself over the low ridge of a
hill, glanced at the lazy group in the patch of shade and went back into
the office.</p>
<p>“There's her smoke,” Cal Emmett announced in the midst of an apathetic
silence.</p>
<p>Weary looked up from whittling a notch in the end of a platform plank and
closed his jack-knife languidly.</p>
<p>Andy pushed his hat backward and then tilted it forward over one eyebrow
and threw away his cigarette.</p>
<p>“Wonder if Florence Grace will be riding point on the bunch?” he
speculated aloud. “If she is, I'm liable to have my hands full. Florence
Grace will sure be sore when she finds out how I got into the game.”</p>
<p>“Aw, I betche there ain't no such a person,” said Happy Jack, doubter to
the last.</p>
<p>“I wish there wasn't,” sighed Andy. “Florence Grace is kinda getting on my
nerves. If I done what I feel like doing, I'd crawl under the platform and
size up the layout through a crack. Honest to gracious, Boys, I hate to
meet that lady.”</p>
<p>They grinned at him heartlessly and stared at the black smudge that was
rolling toward them. “She's sure hittin' her up,” Pink vouchsafed with a
certain tenseness of tone. That train was not as ordinary trains; dimly
they felt that it was relentlessly bringing them trouble, perhaps;
certainly a problem—unless the homeseekers hovered only so long as
it took them to see that wisdom lay in looking elsewhere for a home. Still—</p>
<p>“If this was August instead of May, I wouldn't worry none about them
pilgrims staying long,” Jack Bates voiced the thought that was uppermost
in their minds.</p>
<p>“There comes two livery rigs to haul 'em to the hotel,” Pink pointed out
as he glanced toward town. “And there's another one. Johnny told me every
room they've got is spoke for, and two in every bed.”</p>
<p>“That wouldn't take no crowd,” Happy Jack grumbled, remembering the
limitations of Dry Lake's hotel. “Here come Chip and the missus. Wonder
what they want?”</p>
<p>The Little Doctor left Chip to get their tickets and walked quickly toward
them.</p>
<p>“Hello, boys! Waiting for someone, or just going somewhere?”</p>
<p>“Waiting. Same to you, Mrs. Chip,” Weary replied.</p>
<p>“To me? Well, we're going up to make our filings. Claude won't take a
homestead, because we'll have to stay on at the Flying U, of course, and
we couldn't hold one. But we'll both file desert claims. J. G. hasn't been
a bit well, and I didn't dare leave him before—and of course Claude
wouldn't go till I did. That the passenger coming, or a freight?”</p>
<p>“It's the train—with the dry-farmers,” Andy informed her with a
glance at the nearing smoke-smudge.</p>
<p>“Is it? We aren't any too soon then, are we? I left Son at home—and
he threatened to run away and live with you boys. I almost wish I'd
brought him along. He's been perfectly awful. So have the men Claude hired
to take your places, if you want to know, boys. I believe that is what
made J. G. sick—having those strange men on the place. He's been
like a bear.”</p>
<p>“Didn't Chip tell him—”</p>
<p>“He did, yes. He told him right away, that evening. But—J. G. has
such stubborn ideas. We couldn't make him believe that anyone would be
crazy enough to take up that land and try to make a living farming it. He—”
She looked sidewise at Andy and pursed her lips to Keep from smiling.</p>
<p>“He thinks I lied about it, I suppose,” said that young man shrewdly.</p>
<p>“That's what he says. He pretends that you boys meant to quit, and just
thought that up for an excuse. He'll be all right—you mustn't pay
any attention—”</p>
<p>“Here she comes!”</p>
<p>A black nose thrust through a Deep cut that had a curve to it. At their
feet the rails began to hum. The Little Doctor turned hastily to see if
Chip were coming. The agent came out with a handful of papers and stood
waiting with the rest. Stragglers moved quickly, and the discharged
waitress appeared and made eyes covertly at Pink, whom she considered the
handsomest one of the lot.</p>
<p>The train slid up, slowed and stopped. Two coaches beyond the platform a
worried porter descended and placed the box-step for landing passengers,
and waited. From that particular coach began presently to emerge a
fluttering, exclaiming stream of humanity—at first mostly feminine.
They hovered there upon the cindery path and lifted their faces to watch
for others yet to come, and the babble of their voices could be, heard
above the engine sounds.</p>
<p>The Happy Family looked dumbly at one another and drew back closer to the
depot wall.</p>
<p>“Aw, I knowed there was some ketch to it!” blurted Happy Jack with dismal
satisfaction. “That there ain't no colony—It's nothin' but a bunch
of schoolma'ams!”</p>
<p>“That lady ridin' point is the lady herself,” Andy murmured, edging behind
Weary and Pink as the flutter came closer. “That's Florence Grace Hallman,
boys.”</p>
<p>“Well, by golly, git out and speak your little piece, then!” muttered
Slim, and gave Andy an unexpected push that sent him staggering out into
the open just as the leaders were coming up.</p>
<p>“Why, how de do, Mr. Green!” cried the blonde leader of the flock. “This
is an unexpected pleasure, I'm sure.”</p>
<p>“Yes ma'am, it is,” Andy assented mildly, with an eye cocked sidewise in
search of the guilty man.</p>
<p>The blonde leader paused, her flock coming to a fluttering, staring stand
behind her. The nostrils of the astonished Happy Family caught a mingled
odor of travel luncheons and perfume.</p>
<p>“Well, where have you been, Mr. Green? Why didn't you come and see me?”
demanded Florence, Grace Hallman in the tone of one who has a right to ask
leading questions. Her cool, brown, calculating eyes went appraisingly
over the Happy Family while she spoke.</p>
<p>“I've been right around here, all the time,” Andy gave meek account of
himself. “I've been busy.”</p>
<p>“Oh. Did you go over the tract, Mr. Green?” she lowered her voice.</p>
<p>“Yes-s—I went over it.”</p>
<p>“And what do you think of it—privately?”</p>
<p>“Privately—it's pretty big.” Andy sighed. The bigness of that tract
had worried the Happy Family a good deal.</p>
<p>“Well, the bigger the better. You see I've got 'em started.” She flicked a
glance backward at her waiting colony. “You men are perfectly
exasperating! Why didn't you tell me where you were and what you were
doing?” She looked up at him with charming disapproval. “I feel like
shaking you! I could have made good use of you, Mr. Green.”</p>
<p>“I was making pretty good use of myself,” Andy explained, and wished he
knew who gave him that surreptitious kick on the ankle. Did the chump want
an introduction? Well! In that case—</p>
<p>“Miss Hallman, if you don't mind I'd like to introduce some men I rounded
up and brought here,” he began before the Happy Family could move out of
the danger zone of his imagination. “Representative citizens, you see. You
can sic your bunch onto 'em and get a lot of information. This is Mr.
Weary Davidson, Miss Hallman: He's a hayseed that lives out that way and
he talks spuds better than anything else. And here's Slim—I don't
know his right name—he raises hogs to a fare-you-well. And this is
Percy Perkins”—meaning Pink—“and he's another successful
dryfarmer. Goats is his trade. He's got a lot of 'em. And Mr. Jack Bates,
he raises peanuts—or he's trying 'em this year—and has
contracts to supply the local market. Mr. Happy Jack is our local
undertaker. He wants to sell out if he can, because nobody ever dies in
this country and that makes business slow. He's thinking some of starting
a duck-ranch. This man”—indicating Big Medicine—“has got the
finest looking crop of volunteer wild oats in the country. He knows all
about 'em. Mr. Emmett, here, can put you wise to cabbage-heads; that's his
specialty. And Mr. Miguel Rapponi is up here from Old Mexico looking for a
favorable location for an extensive rubber plantation. The natural
advantages here are simply great for rubber.</p>
<p>“I've gone to some trouble gathering this bunch together for you, Miss
Hallman. I don't reckon you knew there was that many dry-farmers in the
country. They've all got ranches of their own, and the prettiest folders
you ever sent under a four-cent stamp can't come up to what these men can
tell you. Your bunch won't have to listen to one man, only—here's
half a dozen ready and waiting to talk.”</p>
<p>Miss Hallman was impressed. A few of the closest homeseekers she beckoned
and introduced to the perspiring Happy Family—mostly feminine
homeseekers, of whom there were a dozen or so. The men whom the hotel had
sent down with rigs waited impatiently, and the unintroduced male
colonists stared at the low rim of Lonesome Prairie and wondered if over
there lay their future prosperity.</p>
<p>When the Happy Family finally made their escape, red-faced and muttering
threats, Andy Green had disappeared, and no one knew when he went or
where. He was not in Rusty Brown's place when the Happy Family went to
that haven and washed down their wrongs in beer. Pink made a hurried trip
to the livery stable and reported that Andy's horse was gone.</p>
<p>They were wondering among themselves whether he would have the nerve to go
home and await their coming—home at this stage of the game meaning
One Man coulee, which Andy had taken as a homestead and desert claim and
where the Happy Family camped together until such time as their claim
shacks were habitable. Some thought that he was hiding in town, and
advised a thorough search before they took to their horses. The Native Son—he
of mixed Irish and Spanish blood—told them with languid certainty
that Andy was headed straight for the camp because he would figure that in
camp was where they would least expect to find him.</p>
<p>The opinions of the Native Son were usually worth adopting. In this case,
however, it brought them into the street at the very moment when Florence
Grace Hallman and two homeseekers had ventured from the hotel in search of
them. Slim and Jack Bates and Cal Emmett saw them in time and shied across
the street and into the new barber shop where they sat themselves down and
demanded unnecessary hair-cuts and a shampoo apiece, and spied upon their
unfortunate fellows through the window while they waited; but the others
met the women fairly since it was too late to turn back without making
themselves ridiculous.</p>
<p>“I was wondering,” began Miss Hallman in her brisk, business tone, “if
some of you gentlemen could not help us out in the matter of conveyances.
I have made arrangements for most of my guests, but we simply can't
squeeze another one into the rigs I have engaged—and I've engaged
every vehicle in town except a wheelbarrow I saw in the back yard of the
hotel.”</p>
<p>“How many are left out?” asked Weary, since no one else showed any
symptoms of speech.</p>
<p>“Oh, not many, thank goodness. Just us three here. You've met Miss Allen,
Mr. Davidson—and Miss Price. And so have you other gentlemen,
because I introduced you at the depot. I went blandly ahead and told
everybody just which rig they were to ride in, and put three in a seat, at
that, and in counting noses I forgot to count our own—”</p>
<p>“I really don't see how she managed to overlook mine,” sighed Miss Allen,
laying a dainty, gloved finger upon a nose that had the tiniest possible
tilt to it. “Nobody ever overlooked my nose before; it's almost worth
walking to the tract.”</p>
<p>Irish, standing close beside Weary and looking enough like him to be a
twin instead of a mere cousin, smiled down at her with traitorous
admiration. Miss Allen's nose was a nice nose, and above it twinkled a
pair of warm brown eyes with humorous little wrinkles, around them; and
still above them fluffed a kinky-curly mass of brown hair. Weary looked at
her also, but he did not smile, because she looked a little like his own
schoolma'am, Miss Ruty Satterly—and the resemblance hurt a sore
place in his heart.</p>
<p>“—So if any of you gentlemen could possibly take us out to the
tract, we'd be eternally grateful, besides keeping our independence intact
with the usual payment. Could you help us out?”</p>
<p>“We all came in on horseback,” Weary stated with a gentle firmness that
was intended to kill their hopes as painlessly as possible.</p>
<p>“Wouldn't there be room on behind?” asked Miss Allen with hope still alive
and flourishing.</p>
<p>“Lots of room,” Weary assured her. “More room than you could possibly
use.”</p>
<p>“But isn't there any kind of a rig that you could buy, beg, borrow or
steal?” Miss Hallman insisted. “These girls came from Wisconsin to take up
claims, and I've promised to see that they get the best there is to be
had. They are hustlers, if I know what the word means. I have a couple of
claims in mind, that I want them to see—and that's why we three hung
back till the rest were all arranged for. I had a rig promised that I was
depending on, and at the last minute discovered it was not to be had. Some
doctor from Havre came and got it for a trip into the hills. There's no
use talking; we just must get out to the tract as soon as the others do—a
little sooner wouldn't hurt. Couldn't you think of some way?”</p>
<p>“We'll try,” Irish promised rashly, his eyes tying to meet Miss Allen's
and succeeding admirably.</p>
<p>“What has become of Mr. Green?” Miss Hallman demanded after she had
thanked Irish with a smile for the qualified encouragement.</p>
<p>“We don't know,” Weary answered mildly. “We were trying to locate him
ourselves.”</p>
<p>“Oh, were you? He seems a rather uncertain young man. I rather counted on
his assistance; he promised—”</p>
<p>“Mr. Irish has thought of a rig he can use, Miss Hallman,” said the Allen
girl suddenly. “He's going to drive us out himself. Let's hurry and get
ready, so we can start ahead of the others. How many minutes will it take
you, Mr. Irish, to have that team here, for us?”</p>
<p>Irish turned red. He HAD thought of a rig, and he had thought of driving
them himself, but he could not imagine how Miss Allen could possibly; have
known his thoughts. Then and there he knew who would occupy the other half
of the front seat, in case he did really drive the team he had in mind.</p>
<p>“I told you she's a hustler,” laughed Miss Hallman. “She'll be raising
bigger crops than you men—give her a year to get started. Well,
girls, come on, then.”</p>
<p>They turned abruptly away, and Irish was left to his accounting with the
Happy Family. He had not denied the thoughts and intentions imputed to him
by the twinkling-eyed Miss Allen. They walked on toward the livery stable—where
was manifested an unwonted activity—waiting for Irish to clear
himself; which he did not do.</p>
<p>“You going to drive them women out there?” Pink demanded after an
impatient silence.</p>
<p>“Why not? Somebody'll have to.”</p>
<p>“What team are you going to use!” asked Jack Bates.</p>
<p>“Chip's” Irish did not glance around, but kept striding down the middle of
the road with his hands stuck deep in his pockets.</p>
<p>“Don't you think you need help, amigo?” the Native Son insinuated
craftily. “You can't talk to three girls at once; I could be hired to go
along and take one off your hands. That should help some.”</p>
<p>“Like hell you will!” Irish retorted with characteristic bluntness. Then
he added cautiously, “Which one?”</p>
<p>“That old girl with the blue eyes should not be permitted to annoy the
driver,” drawled the Native Son. “Also, Florence Grace might want some
intelligent person to talk to.”</p>
<p>“Well, I got my opinion of any man that'll throw in with that bunch,” Pink
declared hotly. “Why don't you fellows keep your own side the fence. What
if they are women farmers? They can do just as much harm—and a darn
sight more. You make me sick.”</p>
<p>“Let 'em go,” Weary advised calmly. “They'll be a lot sicker when the
ladies discover what they've helped do to that bench-land. Come on, boys—let's
pull out, away from all these lunatics. I hate to see them get stung, but
I don't see what we can do about it—only, if they come around asking
me what I think of that land, I'm going to tell 'em.”</p>
<p>“And then they'll ask you why you took claims up there, and you'll tell
'em that, too—will you?” The Native Son turned and smiled at him
ironically.</p>
<p>That was it. They could not tell the truth without harming their own
cause. They could not do anything except stand aside and see the thing
through to whatever end fate might decree. They thought that Irish and the
Native Son were foolish to take Chip's team and drive those women fifteen
miles or so that they might seize upon land much better left alone; but
that was the business of Irish and the Native Son, who did not ask for the
approval of the Happy Family before doing anything they wanted to do.</p>
<p>The Happy Family saddled and rode back to the claims, gravely discussing
the potentialities of the future. Since they rode slowly while they
talked, they were presently overtaken by a swirl of dust, behind which
came the matched browns which were the Flying U's crack driving team,
bearing Irish and Miss Allen of the twinkling eyes upon the front seat of
a two seated spring-wagon that had seen far better days than this. Native
Son helped to crowd the back seat uncomfortably, and waved a hand with
reprehensible cheerfulness as they went rattling past.</p>
<p>The Happy Family stared after them with frowning disapproval, and Weary
turned in the saddle and looked ruefully at his fellows.</p>
<p>“Things won't ever be the same around here,” he predicted soberly. “There
goes the beginning of the end of the Flying U, boys—and we ain't big
enough to stop it.”</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0008" id="link2HCH0008"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 8. FLORENCE GRACE HALLMAN SPEAKS PLAINLY </h2>
<p>Andy Green rode thoughtfully up the trail from his cabin in One Man
coulee, his hat tilted to the south to shield his face from the climbing
sun, his eyes fixed absently upon the yellow soil of the hillside. Andy
was facing a problem that concerned the whole Happy Family—and the
Flying U as well. He wanted Weary's opinion, and Miguel Rapponi's, and
Pink's—when it came to that, he wanted the opinion of them all.</p>
<p>Thus far the boys had been wholly occupied with getting their shacks built
and in rustling cooking outfits and getting themselves settled upon their
claims with an air of convincing permanency. Also they had watched with
keen interest—which was something more vital than mere curiosity—developments
where the homeseekers were concerned, and had not given very much thought
to their next step, except in a purely general way.</p>
<p>They all recognized the fact that, with all these new settlers buzzing
around hunting claims where there was some promise of making things grow,
they would have to sit very tight indeed upon their own land if they would
avoid trouble with “jumpers.” Not all the homeseekers were women. There
were men, plenty of them; a few of them were wholly lacking in experience
it is true, but perhaps the more greedy for land because of their
ignorance. The old farmers had looked askance at the high, dry prairie
land, where even drinking water must be hauled in barrels from some
deep-set creek whose shallow gurgling would probably cease altogether when
the dry season came on the heels of June. The old farmers had asked
questions that implied doubt. They had wanted to know about sub-soil, and
average rainfall, and late frosts, and markets. The profusely illustrated
folders that used blue print for emphasis here and there, seemed no longer
to satisfy them.</p>
<p>The Happy Family did not worry much about the old farmers who knew the
game, but there were town men who had come to see the fulfillment of their
dreams; who had burned their bridges, some of them, and would suffer much
before they would turn back to face the ridicule of their friends and the
disheartening task of getting; a fresh foothold in the wage-market. These
the Happy Family knew for incipient enemies once the struggle for
existence was fairly begun. And there were the women—daring rivals
of the men in their fight for independence—who had dreamed dreams
and raised up ideals for which they would fight tenaciously.
School-teachers who hated the routine of the schools, and who wanted
freedom; who were willing to work and wait and forego the little, cheap
luxuries which are so dear to women; who would cheerfully endure
loneliness and spoiled complexions and roughened hands and broken nails,
and see the prairie winds and sun wipe the sheen from their hair; who
would wear coarse, heavy-soled shoes and keep all their pretty finery
packed carefully away in their trunks with dainty sachet pads for month
after month, and take all their pleasure in dreaming of the future; these
would fight also to have and to hold—and they would fight harder
than the men, more dangerously than the men, because they would fight
differently.</p>
<p>The Happy Family, then, having recognized these things and having measured
the fighting-element, knew that they were squarely up against a slow,
grim, relentless war if they would save the Flying U. They knew that it
was going to be a pretty stiff proposition, and that they would have to
obey strictly the letter and the spirit of the land laws, or there would
be contests and quarrels and trouble without end.</p>
<p>So they hammered and sawed and fitted boards and nailed on tar-paper and
swore and jangled and joshed one another and counted nickels—where
they used to disdain counting anything but results—and badgered the
life out of Patsy because he kicked at being expected to cook for the
bunch just the same as if he were in the Flying U mess-house. Py cosh, he
wouldn't cook for the whole country just because they were too lazy to
cook for themselves, and py cosh if they wanted him to cook for them they
could pay him sixty dollars a month, as the Old Man did.</p>
<p>The Happy Family were no millionaires, and they made the fact plain to
Patsy to the full extent of their vocabularies. But still they begged
bread from him, a loaf at a time, and couldn't see why he objected to
making pie, if they furnished the stuff. Why, for gosh sake, had they
planted him in the very middle of their string of claims, then? With a
dandy spring too, that never went dry except in the driest years, and not
more than seventy-five yards, at the outside, to carry water. Up hill?
Well, what of that? Look at Pink—had to haul water half a mile from
One Man Creek, and no trail. Look at Weary—had to pack water twice
as far as Patsy. And hadn't they clubbed together and put up his darned
shack first thing, just so he COULD get busy and cook? What did the old
devil expect, anyway?</p>
<p>Well—you see that the Happy Family had been fully occupied in the
week since the arrival of the homeseekers' excursion. They could not be
expected to give very much thought to their next steps. But there was
Andy, who had only to move into the cabin in One Man coulee, with a spring
handy, and a stable for his horse, and a corral and everything. Andy had
not been harassed with the house-building and settling, except as he
assisted the others. As fast as the shacks were up, the Happy Family had
taken possession, so that now Andy was alone, stuck down there in the
coulee out of sight of everybody. Pink had once named One Man coulee as
the lonesomest hole in all that country, and he had not been far wrong.
But at any rate the lonesomeness had served one good purpose, for it had
started Andy to thinking out the details of their so called land-pool. Now
the thinking had borne fruit to the extent that he felt an urgent need of
the Happy Family in council upon the subject.</p>
<p>As he topped at last the final rise which put him on a level with the
great undulating bench-land gashed here and there with coulees and narrow
gulches that gave no evidence of their existence until one rode quite
close, he lifted his head and gazed about him half regretfully, half
proudly. He hated to see that wide upland dotted here and there with new,
raw buildings, which proclaimed themselves claim-shacks as far a one could
see them. Andy hated the sight of claim-shacks with a hatred born of long
range experience and the vital interests of the cattleman. A claim-shack
stuck out on the prairie meant a barbed wire fence somewhere in the
immediate vicinity; and that meant a hindrance to the easy handling of
herds. A claim-shack meant a nester, and a nester was a nuisance, with his
plowed fields and his few head of cattle that must be painstakingly weeded
out of a herd to prevent a howl going up to high heaven. Therefore, Andy
Green instinctively hated the sight of a shack on the prairie. On the
other hand, those shacks belonged to the Happy Family—and that
pleased him. From where he sat on his horse he could count five in sight,
and there were more hidden by ridges and tucked away in hollows.</p>
<p>But there were others going up—shacks whose owners he did not know.
He scowled when he saw, on distant hilltops, the yellow skeletons that
would presently be fattened with boards and paper and made the
dwelling-place of interlopers. To be sure, they had as much right to take
government land as had he or any of his friends—but Andy, being a
normally selfish person, did not think so.</p>
<p>From one partially built shack three quarters of a mile away on a bald
ridge which the Happy Family had passed up because of its barrenness and
the barrenness of the coulee on the other side, and because no one was
willing to waste even a desert right on that particular eighty-acres, a
team and light buggy came swiftly toward him. Andy, trained to quick
thinking, was puzzled at the direction the driver was taking. That eighty
acres joined his own west line, and unless the driver was lost or on the
way to One Man coulee, there was no reason whatever for coming this way.</p>
<p>He watched and saw that the team was comin' straight toward him over the
uneven prairie sod, and at a pace that threatened damage to the
buggy-springs. Instinctively Andy braced himself in the saddle. At a half
mile he knew the team, and it did not require much shrewdness to guess at
the errand. He twitched the reins, turned his spurred heels against his
horse and went loping over the grassland to meet the person who drove in
such haste; and the probability that he was meeting trouble halfway only
sent him the more eagerly forward.</p>
<p>Trouble met him with hard, brown eyes and corn yellow hair blown in loose
strands across cheeks roughened by the spring winds and sun-glare of
Montana. Trouble pulled up and twisted sidewise in the seat and kicked the
heads off some wild larkspurs with her whip while her tongue flayed the
soul of Andy Green with sarcasm.</p>
<p>“Well, I have found out just how you helped me colonize this tract, Mr.
Green,” she began with a hard inflection under the smoothness of her
voice. “I must compliment you upon your promptness and thoroughness in the
matter; for an amateur you have made a remarkable showing—in—in
treachery and deceit. I really did not suppose you had it in you.”</p>
<p>“Remember, I told you I might buy in if it looked good to me,” Andy
reminded her in the mildest tone of which he was capable—and he
could be as mild as new milk when he chose.</p>
<p>Florence Grace Hallman looked at him with a lift of her full upper lip at
the left side. “It does look good, then? You told Mr. Graham and that Mr.
Wirt a different story, Mr. Green. You told them this land won't raise
white beans, and you were at some pains, I believe, to explain why it
would not. You convinced them, by some means or other, that the whole
tract is practically worthless for agricultural purposes. Both Mr. Wirt
and Mr. Graham had some capital to invest here, and now they are leaving,
and they have persuaded several others to leave with them. Does it really
look good to you—this land proposition?”</p>
<p>“Not your proposition—no, it don't.” Andy faced her with a Keen
level glance as hard as her own. One could get the truth straight from the
shoulder if one pushed Andy Green into a corner. “You know and I know that
you're trying to cold-deck this bunch. The land won't raise white beans or
anything else without water, and you know it. You can plant folks on the
land and collect your money and tell 'em goodbye and go to it—and
that settles your part of it. But how about the poor devils that put in
their time and money?”</p>
<p>Florence Grace Hallman spread her hands in a limited gesture because of
the reins, and smiled unpleasantly. “And yet, you nearly broke your neck
filing on the land yourself and getting a lot of your friends to file,”
she retorted. “What was your object, Mr. Green—since the land is
worthless?”</p>
<p>“My object don't matter to anyone but myself.” Andy busied himself with
his smoking material and did not look at her.</p>
<p>“Oh, but it Does! It matters to me, Mr. Green, and to my company, and to
our clients.”</p>
<p>“I'll have to buy me a new dictionary,” Andy observed casually, reaching
behind him to scratch a match on the skirt of his saddle. “The one I've
got don't say anything about 'client' and 'victim' meaning the same thing.
It's getting all outa date.”</p>
<p>“I brought enough clients”—she emphasized the word—“to settle
every eighty acres of land in that whole tract. The policy of the company
was eminently fair. We guaranteed to furnish a claim of eighty, acres to
every person who joined our homeseekers' Club, and free pasturage to all
the stock they wanted to bring. Failing to do that, we pledged ourselves
to refund the fee and pay all return expenses. We could have located every
member of this lot, and more—only for YOU.”</p>
<p>“Say, it'd be just as easy to swear as to say 'you' in that tone uh
voice,” Andy pointed out placidly.</p>
<p>“You managed to gobble up just exactly four thousand acres of this tract—and
you were careful to get all the water and all the best land. That means
you have knocked us out of fifty settlements—”</p>
<p>“Fifty wads of coin to hand back to fifty come-ons, and fifty return
tickets for fifty fellows glad to get back—tough luck, ain't it?”
Andy smiled sympathetically. “You oughta be glad I saved your conscience
that much of a load, anyway.”</p>
<p>Florence Grace Hallman bit her lip to control her rage. “Smart talk isn't
going to help you, Mr. Green. You've simply placed yourself in a position
you can't' hold. You've put it up to us to fight—and we're going to
do it. I'm playing fair with you. I'll tell you this much: I've
investigated you and your friends pretty thoroughly, and it's easy to
guess what your object is. We rather expected the Flying U to fight this
colonization scheme, so we are neither surprised nor unprepared. Mr.
Green, for your own interest and that of your employer, let me advise you
to abandon your claims now, before we begin action in the matter. It will
be simpler, and far, far cheaper. We have our clients to look after, and
we have the law all on our side. These are bona fide settlers we are
bringing in; men and women whose sole object is to make homes for
themselves. The land laws are pretty strict, Mr. Green. If we set the
wheels in motion they will break the Flying U.”</p>
<p>Andy grinned while he inspected his cigarette. “Funny—I heard a man
brag once about how he'd break the Flying U, with sheep,” he drawled. “He
didn't connect, though; the Flying U broke him.” He smoked until he saw an
angry retort parting the red lips of the lady, and then continued calmly:</p>
<p>“The Flying U has got nothing to do with this case. As a matter of fact,
old man Whitmore is pretty sore at us fellows right now, because we quit
him and turned nesters right under his nose. Miss Hallman, you'll have one
sweet time proving that we ain't bona fide settlers. We're just crazy to
make homes for ourselves. We think it's time we settled down—and
we're settling here because we're used to this country. We're real sorry
you didn't find it necessary to pay your folks for the fun of pointing out
the land to us and steering us to the land office—but we can't help
that. We needed the money to buy plows.” He looked at her full with his
honest, gray eyes that could so deceive his fellow men—to say
nothing of women. “And that reminds me, I've got to go and borrow a garden
rake. I'm planting a patch of onions,” he explained engagingly. “Say, this
farming is a great game, isn't it? Well, good day, Miss Hallman. Glad I
happened to meet you.”</p>
<p>“You won't be when I get through with you!” predicted the lady with her
firm chin thrust a little forward. “You think you've got everything your
own way, don't you? Well, you've just simply put yourself in a position
where we can get at you. You deceived me from the very start—and now
you shall pay the penalty. I've got our clients to protect—and
besides that I shall dearly love to get even. Oh, you'll squeal for mercy,
believe me!” She touched up the horses with her whip and went bumping away
over the tough sod.</p>
<p>“Wow!” ejaculated Andy, looking after her with laughter in his eyes.
“She's sure one mad lady, all right. But shucks!” He turned and galloped
off toward the farthest claim, which was Happy Jack's and the last one to
be furnished with a lawful habitation.</p>
<p>He was lucky. The Happy Family were foregathered there, wrangling with
Happy Jack over some trifling thing. He joined zealously in the argument
and helped them thrash Happy Jack in the word-war, before he came at his
errand.</p>
<p>“Say, boys, we'll have to get busy now,” he told them seriously at last.
“Florence Grace is onto us bigger'n a wolf—and if I'm any judge,
that lady's going to be some fighter. We've either got to plow up a bunch
of ground and plant some darn thing, or else get stock on and pasture it.
They ain't going to over look any bets from now on. I met her back here on
the bench. She was so mad she talked too much and I got next to their
scheme—seems like we've knocked the Syndicate outa quite a bunch of
money, all right. They want this land, and they think they're going to get
it.</p>
<p>“Now my idea is this: We've got to have stock, or we can't graze the land.
And if we take Flying U cattle and throw 'em on here, they'll contest us
for taking fake claims, for the outfit. So what's the matter with us
buying a bunch from the Old Man?”</p>
<p>“I'm broke,” began Pink promptly, but Andy stopped him.</p>
<p>“Listen here. We buy a bunch of stock and give him mortgages for the
money, with the cattle for security. We graze 'em till the mortgage runs
out—till we prove up, that means—and then we don't spot up,
and the Old Man takes the stock back, see? We're grazing our own stock,
according to law—but the outfit—”</p>
<p>“Where do we git off at?” demanded Happy Jack suspiciously. “We got to
live—and it takes money to buy grub, these days.”</p>
<p>“Well, we'll make out all right. We can have so many head of cattle named
for the mortgage; there'll be increase, and we should get that. By the
time we all prove up we'll have a little bunch of stock of our own' d' uh
see? And we'll have the range—what there is left. These squatters
ain't going to last over winter, if you ask me. And it'll be a long, cold
day when another bunch of greenhorns bites on any colony scheme.”</p>
<p>“How do you know the Old Man'll do that, though?” Weary wanted to know.
“He's pretty mad. I rode over to the ranch last week to see Chip, and the
Old Man wouldn't have anything to say to me.”</p>
<p>“Well, what's the matter with all of us going? He can't pass up the whole
bunch. We can put it up to him just the way it is, and he'll see where
it's going to be to his interest to let us have the cattle. Why, darn it,
he can't help seeing now why we quit!” Pink looked ready to start then,
while his enthusiasm was fresh.</p>
<p>“Neither can Florence Grace help seeing why we did it,” Andy supplemented
dryly. “She can think what she darn pleases—all we got to do is
deliver the goods right up to the handle, on these claims and not let her
prove anything on us.”</p>
<p>“It'll take a lot uh fencing,” Happy Jack croaked pessimistically. “We
ain't got the money to buy wire and posts, ner the time to build the
fence.”</p>
<p>“What's the matter with rang-herding 'em?” Andy seemed to have thought it
all out, and to have an answer for every objection. “We can take turns at
that—and we must all be careful and don't let 'em graze on our
neighbors!”</p>
<p>Whereat the Happy Family grinned understandingly.</p>
<p>“Maybe the Old Man'll let us have three or four hundred head uh cows on
shares,” Cal hazarded optimistically.</p>
<p>“Can't take 'em that way,” said the Native Son languidly. “It wouldn't be
safe. Andy's right; the way to do is buy the cattle outright, and give a
mortgage on the bunch. And I think we better split the bunch, and let
every fellow buy a few head. We can graze 'em together—the law can't
stop us from doing that.”</p>
<p>“Sounds good—if the Old Man will come to the centre,” said Weary
dubiously. The chill atmosphere of Flying U coulee, with strangers in the
bunk-house and with the Old Man scowling at his paper on the porch, had
left its effect upon Weary, sunny-souled as he was.</p>
<p>“Oh, he'll come through,” cried Cal, moving toward his horse, “gee whiz,
he's got to! Come on—let's go and get it done with. As it stands
now, we ain't got a thing to do but set around and look wise—unless
we go spoiling good grass with plows. First thing we know our neighbors
will be saying we ain't improving our claims!”</p>
<p>“You improve yours every time you git off it!” stated Happy Jack
spitefully because of past wrongs. “You could improve mine a whole lot
that way, too,” he added when he heard the laugh of approval from the
others.</p>
<p>They rung all the changes possible upon that witticism while they mounted
and rode away, every man of them secretly glad of some excuse for making
overtures to the Old Man. Spite of the excitement of getting on to their
claims, and of watching strangers driving here and there in haste, and
hauling loads of lumber toilfully over the untracked grass and building
chickencoop dwellings as nearly alike as the buttons on a new shirt—spite
of all that they had felt keenly their exile from Flying U ranch. They had
stayed away, for two reasons: one was a latent stubbornness which made
them resent the Old Man's resentment; the other was a matter of policy, as
preached by Andy Green and the Native Son. It would not do, said these two
cautious ones, to be running to the Flying U outfit all the time.</p>
<p>So the Happy Family had steered clear since that afternoon when they had
simulated treachery to the outfit. And fate played them a scurvy trick in
spite of their caution, for just as they rode down the Hog's Back and
across the ford, Florence Grace Hallman rode away from the White House and
met them fairly at the stable.</p>
<p>Florence Grace smiled a peculiar smile as she went past them. A smile that
promised she would not forget; a smile that told them how sure she felt of
having caught them fairly. With the smile went a chilly, supercilious bow
that was worse than a direct cut, and which the Happy Family returned
doubtfully, not at all sure of the rules governing warfare with a woman.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0009" id="link2HCH0009"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 9. THE HAPPY FAMILY BUYS A BUNCH OF CATTLE </h2>
<p>With the Kid riding gleefully upon Weary's shoulder they trooped up the
path their own feet had helped wear deep to the bunk-house. They looked in
at the open door and snorted at the cheerlessness of the place.</p>
<p>“Why don't you come back here and stay?” the Kid demanded. “I was going to
sleep down here with you—and now Doctor Dell won't let me. These
hobees are no good. They're damn' bone-head. Daddy Chip says so. I wish
you'd come back, so I can sleep with you. One man's named Ole and he's got
a funny eye that looks at the other one all the time. I wish you'd come
back.”</p>
<p>The Happy Family wished the same thing, but they did not say so. Instead
they told the Kid to ask his mother if he couldn't come and visit them in
their new shacks, and promised indulgences that would have shocked the
Little Doctor had she heard them. So they went on to the house, where the
Old Man sat on the porch looking madder than when they had left him three
weeks before.</p>
<p>“Why don't yuh run them nesters outa the country?” he demanded peevishly
when they were close enough for speech. “Here they come and accuse me to
my face of trying to defraud the gov'ment. Doggone you boys, what you
think you're up to, anyway? What's three or four thousand acres when
they're swarming in here like flies to a butcherin'? They can't make a
living—serve 'em right. What you doggone rowdies want now?”</p>
<p>Not a cordial welcome, that—if they went no deeper than his words.
But there was the old twinkle back of the querulousness in the Old Man's
eyes, and the old pucker of the lips behind his grizzled whiskers. “You've
got that doggone Kid broke to foller yuh so we can't keep him on the ranch
no more,” he added fretfully. “Tried to run away twice, on Silver. Chip
had to go round him up. Found him last time pretty near over to Antelope
coulee, hittin' the high places for town. Might as well take yuh back, I
guess, and save time running after the Kid.”</p>
<p>“We've got to hold down our claims,” Weary minded him regretfully. In
three weeks, he could see a difference the Old Man, and the change hurt
him.</p>
<p>Lines were deeper drawn, and the kind old eyes were a shade more sunken.</p>
<p>“What's that amount to?” grumbled the Old Man, looking from one to the
other under his graying eye brows. “You can't stop them dry-farmers from
taking the country. Yuh might as well try to dip the Missouri dry with a
bucket. They'll flood the country with stock—”</p>
<p>“No, they won't,” put in Big Medicine, impatient for the real meat of
their errand. “By cripes, we got a scheme to beat that—you tell 'im,
Weary.”</p>
<p>“We want to buy a bunch of cattle from you,” Weary said obediently. “We
want to graze our claims, instead of trying to crop the land. We haven't
any fence up, so we'll have to range-herd our stock, of course. I—don't
hardly think any nester stock will get by us, J. G. And seeing our land
runs straight through from Meeker's line fence to yours, we kinda think
we've got the nesters pretty well corralled. They're welcome to the range
between Antelope coulee and Dry Lake, far as we're concerned. Soon as we
can afford it,” he added tranquilly, “we'll stretch a fence along our west
line that'll hold all the darn milkcows they've a mind to ship out here.”</p>
<p>“Huh!” The Old Man studied them quizzically, his chin on his chest.</p>
<p>“How many yuh want?” he asked abruptly.</p>
<p>“All you'll sell us. We want to give mortgages, with the stock for
security.”</p>
<p>“Oh, yuh do, ay? What if I have to foreclose on yuh?” The pucker of his
lips grew more pronounced. “Where do you git off at, then?”</p>
<p>“Well, we kinda thought we could fix it up to save part of the increase
outa the wreck, anyway.”</p>
<p>“Oh. That's it ay?” He studied them another minute. “You'll want all my
best cows, too, I reckon—all that grade stock I shipped in last
spring. Ay?”</p>
<p>“We wouldn't mind,” grinned Weary, glancing at the others roosting at ease
along the edge of the porch.</p>
<p>“Think you could handle five-hundred head—the pick uh the bunch?”</p>
<p>“Sure, we could! We'd rather split 'em up amongst us, though—let
every fellow buy so many. We can throw in together on the herding.”</p>
<p>“Think you can keep the milk-cows between you and Dry Lake, ay?” The Old
Man chuckled—the first little chuckle since the Happy Family left
him so unceremoniously three weeks before. “How about that, Pink?”</p>
<p>“Why, I think we can,” chirped Pink cheerfully.</p>
<p>“Huh! Well, you're the toughest bunch, take yuh up one side and down the
other, I ever seen keep onta jail—I guess maybe you can do it. But
lemme tell you boys something—and I want you to remember it: You
don't want to git the idea in your heads you're going to have any snap;
you ain't. If I know B from a bull's foot, you've got your work cut out
for yuh. I've been keeping cases pretty close on this dry-farm craze, and
this stampede for claims. Folks are land crazy. They've got the idea that
a few acres of land is going to make 'em free and independent—and it
don't matter much what the land is, or where it is. So long as it's land,
and they can git it from the government for next to nothing, they're
satisfied. And yuh want to remember that. Yuh don't want to take it for
granted they're going to take a look at your deadline and back up. If they
ship in stock, they're going to see to it that stock don't starve. You'll
have to hold off men and women that's making their last stand, some of
'em, for a home of their own. They ain't going to give up if they can help
it. You get a man with his back agin the wall, and he'll fight till he
drops. I don't need to tell yuh that.”</p>
<p>The Happy Family listened to him soberly, their eyes staring broodily at
the picture he conjured.</p>
<p>“Well, by golly, we're makin' our last stand, too,” Slim blurted with his
customary unexpectedness. “Our back's agin the wall right now. If we can't
hold 'em back from takin' what little range is left, this outfit's going
under. We got to hold 'em, by golly, er there won't be no more Flying U.”</p>
<p>“Well,” said Andy Green quietly, “that's all right. We're going to hold
'em.”</p>
<p>The Old Man lifted his bent head and looked from one to another. Pride
shone in his eyes, that had lately stared resentment. “Yuh know, don't
yuh, the biggest club they can use?” He leaned forward a little, his lips
working under his beard.</p>
<p>“Sure, we know. We'll look out for that.” Weary smiled hearteningly.</p>
<p>“We want a good lawyer to draw up those mortgages,” put in the Native Son
lazily. “And we'll pay eight per cent. interest.”</p>
<p>“Doggonedest crazy bunch ever I struck,” grumbled the Old Man with
grateful insincerity. “What you fellers don't think of, there ain't any
use in mentioning. Oh, Dell! Bring out that jug Blake sent me! Doggoned
thirsty bunch out here—won't stir a foot till they sample that wine!
Got to get rid of 'em somehow—they claim to be full uh business as a
jack rabbit is of fleas! When yuh want to git out and round up them cows?
Wagon's over on Dry creek som'ers—or ought to be. Yuh might take
your soogans and ride ove' there tomorrow or next day and ketch 'em. I'll
write a note to Chip and tell 'im what's to be done. And while you're
pickin' your bunch you can draw wages just the same as ever, and help them
double-dutch blisterin' milk-fed pilgrims with the calf crop.”</p>
<p>“We'll sure do that,” promised Weary for the bunch. “We can start in the
morning, all right.”</p>
<p>“Take a taste uh this wine. None of your tobacco-juice stuff; this comes
straight from Fresno. Senator Blake sent it the other day. Fill up that
glass, Dell! What yuh want to be so doggone stingy fer? Think this bunch
uh freaks are going to stand for that? They can't git the taste outa
less'n a pint. This ain't any doggone liver-tonic like you dope out.”</p>
<p>The Little Doctor smiled understandingly and filled their glasses with the
precious wine from sunland. She did not know what had happened, but she
did know that the Old Man had seized another hand-hold on life in the last
hour, and she was grateful. She even permitted the Kid to take a tiny sip,
just because the Happy Family hated to see him refused anything he wanted.</p>
<p>So Flying U coulee was for the time being filled with the same old
laughter and the same atmosphere of care-free contentment with life. The
Countess stewed uncomplainingly in the kitchen, cooking dinner for the
boys. The Old Man grumbled hypocritically at them from his big chair, and
named their faults in the tone that transmuted them into virtues. The
Little Doctor heard about Miss Allen and her three partners, who were
building a four-room shack on the four corners of four claims, and how
Irish had been caught more than once in the act of staring fixedly in the
direction of that shack. She heard a good many things, and she guessed a
good many more.</p>
<p>By mid afternoon the Old Man was fifty per cent brighter and better than
he had been in the morning, and he laughed and bullied them as of old.
When they left he told them to clear out and stay out, and that if he
caught them hanging around his ranch, and making it look as if he were
backing them and trying to defraud the government, he'd sic the dog onto
them. Which tickled the Kid immensely, because there wasn't any dog to
sic.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0010" id="link2HCH0010"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 10. WHEREIN ANDY GREEN LIES TO A LADY </h2>
<p>In the soft-creeping dusk came Andy Green, slouched in the saddle with the
weariness of riding since dawn; slouched to one side and singing, with his
hat far back on his head and the last of a red sunset tinting darkly the
hills above him. Tip-toe on a pinnacle a great, yellow star poised and
winked at him knowingly. Andy's eyes twinkled answer as he glanced up that
way. “We've got her going, old-timer,” he announced lazily to the star.</p>
<p>Six miles back toward the edge of the “breaks” which are really the
beginning of the Badlands that border the Missouri River all through that
part of Montana, an even five hundred head of the Flying U's best grade
cows and their calves were settling down for the night upon a knoll that
had been the bed-ground of many a herd. At the Flying U ranch, in the care
of the Old Man, were the mortgages that would make the Happy Family
nominal owners of those five hundred cows and their calves. In the morning
Andy would ride back and help bring the herd upon its spring grazing
ground, which was the claims; in the meantime he was leisurely obeying an
impulse to ride into One Man coulee and spend the night under his own
roof. And, say what you will, there is a satisfaction not to be denied in
sleeping sometimes under one's own roof; and it doesn't matter in the
least that the roof is made of prairie dirt thrown upon cottonwood poles.
So he sang while he rode, and his voice boomed loud in the coulee and
scared long stilled echoes into repeating the song:</p>
<p>“We're here because we're here, because we're here,<br/>
because we're here,<br/>
<br/>
“We're here because we're here, because we're here,<br/>
because we're here—”<br/></p>
<p>That, if you please, is a song; there are a lot more verses exactly like
this one, which may be sung to the tune of Auld Lang Syne with much
effectiveness when one is in a certain mood. So Andy sang, while his tired
horse picked its way circumspectly among the scattered rocks of the trail
up the coulee.</p>
<p>“It's time you're here, it's time you're here,<br/>
It's time that you were here—”<br/></p>
<p>mocked an echo not of the hills.</p>
<p>Andy swore in his astonishment and gave his horse a kick as a mild hint
for haste. He thought he knew every woman-voice in the neighborhood—or
had until the colony came—but this voice, high and sweet and with a
compelling note that stirred him vaguely, was absolutely strange. While he
loped forward, silenced for the moment, he was conscious of a swift, keen
thankfulness that Pink had at the last minute decided to stay in camp that
night instead of accompanying Andy to One Man. He was in that mood when a
sentimental encounter appealed to him strongly; and a woman's voice,
singing to him from One Man cabin, promised undetermined adventure.</p>
<p>He did not sing again. There had been something in the voice that held him
quiet, listening, expectant. But she also was silent after that last, high
note—like a meadow lark startled in the middle of his song, thought
Andy whimsically.</p>
<p>He came within sight of the cabin, squatting in the shadow of the grove at
its back. He half expected to see a light, but the window was dark, the
door closed as he had left it. He felt a faint, unreasoning disappointment
that it was so. But he had heard her. That high note that lingered upon
the word “here” still tingled his senses. His eyes sent seeking glances
here and there as he rode up.</p>
<p>Then a horse nickered welcomingly, and someone rode out from the deeper
shadow at the corner of the cabin, hesitated as though tempted to flight,
and came on uncertainly. They met full before the cabin, and the woman
leaned and peered through the dusk at Andy.</p>
<p>“Is this—Mr. Mallory—Irish?” she asked nervously. “Oh dear!
Have I gone and made a fool of myself again?”</p>
<p>“Not at all! Good evening, Miss Allen.” Andy folded his hands upon the
saddle horn and regarded her with a little smile, Keen for what might come
next.</p>
<p>“But you're not Irish Mallory. I thought I recognized the voice, or I
wouldn't have—” She urged her horse a step closer, and Andy observed
from her manner that she was not accustomed to horses. She reined as if
she were driving, so that the horse, bewildered, came sidling up to him.
“Who are you?” she asked him sharply.</p>
<p>“Me? Why, I'm a nice young man—a lot better singer than Irish. I
guess you never heard him, did you?” He kept his hands folded on the horn,
his whole attitude passive—a restful, reassuring passivity that
lulled her uneasiness more than words could have done.</p>
<p>“Oh, are you Andy Green? I seem to connect that name with your voice—and
what little I can see of you.”</p>
<p>“That's something, anyway.” Andy's tone was one of gratitude. “It's two
per cent. better than having to tell you right out who I am. I met you
three different times, Miss Allen,” he reproached.</p>
<p>“But always in a crowd,” she defended, “and I never talked with you,
particularly.”</p>
<p>“Oh, well, that's easily fixed,” he said. “It's a nice night,” he added,
looking up appreciatively at the brightening star-sprinkle. “Are you
living on your claim now? We can talk particularly on the way over.”</p>
<p>Miss Allen laughed and groped for a few loose hairs, found them and tucked
them carefully under her hatcrown. Andy remembered that gesture; it helped
him to visualize her clearly in spite of the deepening night.</p>
<p>“How far have you ridden today, Mr. Green?” she asked irrelevantly.</p>
<p>“Since daylight, you mean? Not so very far counting miles—We were
trailing a herd, you see. But I've been in the saddle since sunrise,
except when I was eating.”</p>
<p>“Then you want a cup of coffee, before you ride any farther. If I get
down, will you let me make it or you? I'd love to. I'm crazy to see inside
your cabin, but I only rode up and tried to peek in the window before you
came. I have two brothers and a cousin, so I understand men pretty well
and I know you can talk better when you aren't hungry.”</p>
<p>“Are you living on your claim?” he asked again, without moving.</p>
<p>“Why, yes. We moved in last week.”</p>
<p>“Well, we'll ride over, then, and you can make coffee there. I'm not
hungry right now.”</p>
<p>“Oh.” She leaned again and peered at him, trying to read his face. “You
don't WANT me to go in!”</p>
<p>“Yes, I do—but I don't. If you stayed and made coffee, tomorrow
you'd be kicking yourself for it, and you'd be blaming me.” Which,
considering the life he had lived, almost wholly among men, was rather
astute of Andy Green.</p>
<p>“Oh.” Then she laughed. “You must have some sisters, Mr. Green.” She was
silent for a minute, looking at him. “You're right,” she said quietly
then. “I'm always making a fool of myself, just on the impulse of the
moment. The girls will be worried about me, as it is. But I don't want you
to ride any farther, Mr. Green. What I came to say need not take very
long, and I think I can find my way home alone, all right.”</p>
<p>“I'll take you home when you're ready to go,” said Andy quietly. All at
once he had wanted to shield her, to protect her from even so slight an
unconventionality as making his coffee for him. He had felt averse to
putting her at odds with her conventional self, of inviting unfavorable
criticism of himself; dimly, because instinct rather than cold analysis
impelled him. What he had told her was the sum total of his formulated
ideas.</p>
<p>“Well, I'm ready to go now, since you insist on my being conventional. I
did not come West with the expectation of being tied to a book of
etiquette, Mr. Green. But I find one can't get away from it after all.
Still, living on one's own claim twelve miles from a town is something!”</p>
<p>“That's a whole lot, I should say,” Andy assured her politely, and
refrained from asking her what she expected to do with that eighty acres
of arid land. He turned his tired horse and rode alongside her, prudently
waiting for her to give the key.</p>
<p>“I'm not supposed to be away over here, you know,” she began when they
were near the foot of the bluff up which the trail wound seeking the
easiest slopes and avoiding boulders and deep cuts. “I'm supposed to be
just out riding, and the girls expected me back by sundown. But I've been
trying and trying to find some of you Flying U boys—as they call you
men who have taken so much land—on your claims. I don't know that
what I could tell you would do you a particle of good—or anyone
else. But I wanted to tell you, anyway, just to clear my own mind.”</p>
<p>“It does lots of good just to meet you,” said Andy with straightforward
gallantry. “Pleasures are few and far between, out here.”</p>
<p>“You said that very nicely, I'm sure,” she snubbed. “Well, I'm going to
tell you, anyway—just on the chance of doing some good.” Then she
stopped.</p>
<p>Andy rode a rod or two, glancing at her inquiringly, waiting for her to go
on. She was guiding her horse awkwardly where it needed only to be let
alone, and he wanted to give her a lesson in riding. But it seemed too
early in their acquaintance for that, so he waited another minute.</p>
<p>“Miss Hallman is going to make you a lot of trouble,” she began abruptly.
“I thought perhaps it might be better for you—all of you—if
you knew it in advance, so there would be no sudden anger and excitement.
All the settlers are antagonistic, Mr. Green—all but me, and one or
two of the girls. They are going to do everything they can to prevent your
land-scheme from going through. You are going to be watched and—and
your land contested—”</p>
<p>“Well, we'll be right there, I guess, when the dust settles,” he filled in
her thought unmoved.</p>
<p>“I—almost hope so,” she ventured. “For my part, I can see the side—your
side. I can see where it is very hard for the cattle men to give up their
range. It is like the big plantations down south, when the slaves were
freed. It had to be done, and yet it was hard upon those planters who
depended on free labor. They resented it deeply; deeply enough to shed
blood—and that is one thing I dread here. I hope, Mr. Green, that
you will not resort to violence. I want to urge you all to—to—”</p>
<p>“I understand,” said Andy softly. “A-course, we're pretty bad when we get
started, all right. We're liable to ride up on dark nights and shoot our
enemies through the window—I can't deny it, Miss Allen. And if it
comes right to a show-down, I may as well admit that some of us would
think nothing at all of taking a man out and hanging him to the first
three we come to, that was big enough to hold him. But now that ladies
have come into the country, a-course we'll try and hold our tempers down
all we can. Miss Hallman, now—I don't suppose there's a man in the
bunch that would shoot her, no matter what she done to us. We take pride
in being polite to women. You've read that about us, haven't you, Miss
Allen? And you've seen us on the stage—well, it's a fact, all right.
Bad as we are, and wild and tough, and savage when we're crossed, a lady
can just do anything with us, if she goes at it the right way.”</p>
<p>“Thank you. I felt sure that you would not harm any of us. Will you
promise not to be violent—not to—to—”</p>
<p>Andy sat sidewise in the saddle, so that he faced her. Miss Allen could
just make out his form distinctly; his face was quite hidden, except that
she could see the shine of his eyes.</p>
<p>“Now, Miss Allen,” he protested with soft apology “You musta known what to
expect when you moved out amongst us rough characters. You know I can make
any promises about being mild with the men that try to get the best of us.
If you've got friends—brothers—anybody here that you think a
lot of Miss Allen, I advise you to send 'em outa the country, before
trouble breaks loose; because when she starts she'll start a-popping. I
know I can't answer for my self, what I'm liable to do if they bother me;
and I'm about the mildest one in the bunch. What the rest of the boys
would do—Irish Mallory for instance—I hate to think, Miss
Allen. I—hate—to—think!”</p>
<p>Afterwards, when he thought it all over dispassionately, Andy wondered why
he had talked to Miss Allen like that. He had not done it deliberately,
just to frighten her—yet he had frightened her to a certain extent.
He had roused her apprehension for the safety of her neighbors and the
ultimate well-being of himself and his fellows. She had been so anxious
over winning him to more peaceful ways that she had forgotten to give him
any details of the coming struggle. Andy was sorry for that. He wished, on
the way home, that he knew just what Florence Grace Hallman intended to
do.</p>
<p>Not that it mattered greatly. Whatever she did, Andy felt that it would be
futile. The Happy Family were obeying the land laws implicitly, except as
their real incentive had been an unselfish one. He could not feel that it
was wrong to try and save the Flying U; was not loyalty a virtue? And was
not the taking of land for the preservation of a fine, fair dealing outfit
that had made itself a power for prosperity and happiness in that country,
a perfectly laudable enterprise? Andy believed so.</p>
<p>Even though they did, down in their deepest thoughts, think of the Flying
U's interest, Andy did not believe that Florence Grace Hallman or anyone
else could produce any evidence that would justify a contest for their
land. Though they planned among themselves for the good of the Flying U,
they were obeying the law and the dictates of their range-conscience and
their personal ideas of right and justice and loyalty to their friends and
to themselves. They were not conspiring against the general prosperity of
the country in the hope of great personal gain. When you came to that,
they were saving fifty men from bitter disappointment—counting one
settler to every eighty acres, as the Syndicate apparently did.</p>
<p>Still, Andy wondered why he had represented himself and his friends to be
such bloodthirsty devils. He grinned wickedly over some of the things he
had said, and over her womanly perturbation and pleading that they would
spare the lives of their enemies. Oh, well—if she repeated half to
Florence Grace Hallman, that lady would maybe think twice before she
tackled the contract of boosting the Happy Family off their claims. So at
the last he managed to justify his lying to her. He liked Miss Allen. He
was pleased to think that at least she would not forget him the minute he
was out of her sight.</p>
<p>He went to sleep worrying, not over the trouble which Florence Grace
Hallman might be plotting to bring upon him, but about Miss Allen's given
name and her previous condition of servitude. He hoped that she was not a
stenographer, and he hoped her first name was not Mary; and if you know
the history of Andy Green you will remember that he had a reason for
disliking both the name and the vocation.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0011" id="link2HCH0011"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 11. A MOVING CHAPTER IN EVENTS </h2>
<p>Having nothing more than a general warning of trouble ahead to disturb
him, Andy rode blithely back down the coulee and met the herd just after
sunrise. Dreams of Miss Allen had left a pleasant mood behind them, though
the dreams themselves withdrew behind the veil of forgetfulness when he
awoke. He wondered what her first name was. He wondered how far Irish's
acquaintance with her had progressed, but he did not worry much about
Irish. Having represented himself to be an exceedingly dangerous man, and
having permitted himself to be persuaded into promising reform and a calm
demeanor—for her sake—he felt tolerably sure of her interest
in him. He had heard that a woman loves best the taming of a dangerous
man, and he whistled and sang and smiled until the dust of the coming herd
met him full. Since he felt perfectly sure of the result, he hoped that
Florence Grace Hallman would start something, just so that he might show
Miss Allen how potent was her influence over a bad, bad man who still has
virtues worth nurturing carefully.</p>
<p>Weary, riding point on the loitering herd, grinned a wordless greeting.
Andy passed with a casual wave of his hand and took his place on the left
flank. From his face Weary guessed that all was well with the claims, and
the assurance served to lighten his spirits. Soon he heard Andy singing at
the top of his voice, and his own thoughts fell into accord with the words
of the ditty. He began to sing also, whenever he knew the words. Farther
back, Pink took it up, and then the others joined in, until all
unconsciously they had turned the monotonous drive into a triumphal march.</p>
<p>“They're a little bit rough I must confess, the most of them at least,”
prompted Andy, starting on the second verse alone because the others
didn't know the song as well as he. He waited a second for them to join
him, and went on extolling the valor of all true cowboys:</p>
<p>“But long's you do not cross their trail you can live with<br/>
them at peace.<br/>
<br/>
“But if you do they're sure to rule, the day you come to<br/>
their land,<br/>
<br/>
“For they'll follow you up and shoot it out, and do it man to<br/>
man.”<br/></p>
<p>“Say, Weary! They tell me Florence Grace is sure hittin' the warpost!
Ain't yuh scared?”</p>
<p>Weary shook his head and rode forward to ease the leaders into a narrow
gulch that would cut off a mile or so of the journey.</p>
<p>“Taking 'em up One Man?” called Pink, and got a nod for answer. There was
a lull in the singing while they shouted and swore at these stubborn cows
who would have tried to break back on the way to a clover patch, until the
gulch broadened into an arm of One Man Coulee itself. It was all peaceful
and easy and just as they had planned. The morning was cool and the cattle
contented. They were nearing their claims, and all that would remain for
them to do was the holding of their herd upon the appointed grazing
ground. So would the requirements of the law be fulfilled and the
machinations of the Syndicate be thwarted and the land saved to the Flying
U, all in one.</p>
<p>And then the leaders, climbing the hill at a point half a mile below
Andy's cabin, balked, snorted and swung back. Weary spurred up to push
them forward, and so did Andy and Pink. They rode up over the ridge
shouting and urging the reluctant cattle ahead, and came plump into the
very dooryard of a brand new shack. A man was standing in the doorway
watching the disturbance his presence had created; when he saw the three
riders come bulging up over the crest of the bluff, his eyes widened.</p>
<p>The three came to a stop before him, too astonished to do more than stare.
Once past the fancied menace of the new building and the man, the cattle
went trotting awkwardly across the level, their calves galloping
alongside.</p>
<p>“Hello,” said Weary at last, “what do you think you're doing here?”</p>
<p>“Me? I'm holding down a claim. What are you doing?” The man did not seem
antagonistic or friendly or even neutral toward them. He seemed to be
waiting. He eyed the cattle that kept coming, urged on by those who
shouted at them in the coulee below. He watched them spread out and go
trotting away after the leaders.</p>
<p>“Say, when did yuh take this claim?” Andy leaned negligently forward and
looked at him curiously.</p>
<p>“Oh, a week or so ago. Why?”</p>
<p>“I just wondered. I took it up myself, four weeks ago. Four forties I've
got, strung out in a line that runs from here to yonder. You've got over
on my land—by mistake, of course. I just thought I'd tell yuh,” he
added casually, straightening up, “because I didn't think you knew it
before.”</p>
<p>“Thanks.” The man smiled one-sidedly and began filling a pipe while he
watched them.</p>
<p>“A-course it won't be much trouble to move your shack,” Andy continued
with neighborly interest. “A wheelbarrow will take it, easy. Back here on
the bench a mile or so, yuh may find a patch of ground that nobody
claims.”</p>
<p>“Thanks.” The man picked a match from his pocket and striking it on the
new yellow door-casing lighted his pipe.</p>
<p>Andy moved uneasily. He did not like that man, for all he appeared so
thankful for information. The fellow had a narrow forehead and broad, high
cheek bones and a predatory nose. His eyes were the wrong shade of blue
and the lids drooped too much at the outer corners. Andy studied him
curiously. Did the man know what he was up against, or did he not? Was he
sincere in his ready thanks, or was he sarcastic? The man looked up at him
then. His eyes were clean of any hidden meaning, but they were the wrong
shade of blue—the shade that is opaque and that you feel hides much
that should be revealed to you.</p>
<p>“Seems like there's been quite a crop of shacks grown up since I rode over
this way,” Weary announced suddenly, returning from a brief scurry after
the leaders, that inclined too much toward the south in their travel.</p>
<p>“Yes, the country's settling up pretty fast,” conceded the man in the
doorway.</p>
<p>“Well, by golly!” bellowed Slim, popping up from below on a heaving horse.
Slim was getting fatter every year, and his horses always puffed when they
climbed a hill under his weight. His round eyes glared resentfully at the
man and the shack and at the three who were sitting there so quietly on
their horses—just as if they had ridden up for a friendly call.
“Ain't this shack on your land?” he spluttered to Andy.</p>
<p>“Why, yes. It is, just right at present.” Andy admitted, following the
man's example in the matter of a smoke, except that Andy rolled and
lighted a cigarette. “He's going to move it, though.”</p>
<p>“Oh. Thanks.” With the one-sided smile.</p>
<p>“Say, you needn't thank ME,” Andy protested in his polite tone. “YOU'RE
going to move it, you know.”</p>
<p>“You may know, but I don't,” corrected the other.</p>
<p>“Oh, that's all right. You may not know right now, but don't let that
worry yuh. This is sure a great country for pilgrims to wise up in.”</p>
<p>Big Medicine came up over the hill a hundred feet or so from them; goggled
a minute at the bold trespass and came loping across the intervening
space. “Say, by cripes, what's this mean?” he bawled. “Claim-jumper, hey?
Say, young feller, do you realize what you're doing—squattin' down
on another man's land. Don't yuh know claim-jumpers git shot, out here? Or
lynched?”</p>
<p>“Oh, cut out all that rough stuff!” advised the man wearily. “I know who
you are, and what your bluff is worth. I know you can't held a foot of
land if anybody is a mind to contest your claims. I've filed a contest on
this eighty, here, and I'm going to hold it. Let that soak into your
minds. I don't want any trouble—I'm even willing to take a good deal
in the way of bluster, rather than have trouble. But I'm going to stay.
See?” He waved his pipe in a gesture of finality and continued to smoke
and to watch them impersonally, leaning against the door in that lounging
negligence which is so irritating to a disputant.</p>
<p>“Oh, all right—if that's the way you feel about it,” Andy replied
indifferently, and turned away. “Come on, boys—no use trying to
bluff that gazabo. He's wise.”</p>
<p>He rode away with his face turned over his shoulder to see if the others
were going to follow. When he was past the corner and therefore out of the
man's sight, he raised his arm and beckoned to them imperatively, with a
jerk of his head to add insistence. The four of them looked after him
uncertainly. Weary kicked his horse and started, then Pink did the same.
Andy beckoned again, more emphatically than before, and Big Medicine, who
loved a fight as he loved to win a jackpot, turned and glared at the man
in the doorway as he passed. Slim was rumbling by-golly ultimatums in his
fat chest when he came up.</p>
<p>“Pink, you go on back and put the boys next, when they come up with the
drag they won't do anything much but hand out a few remarks and ride on.”
Andy said, in the tone of one who knows exactly what he means to do. “This
is my claim-jumper. Chances are I've got three more to handle—or
will have. Nothing like starting off right. Tell the boys just rag the
fellow a little and ride on, like we did. Get the cattle up here and set
Happy and Slim day-herding and the rest of us'll get busy.”</p>
<p>“You wouldn't tell for a dollar, would yuh?” Pi asked him with his dimples
showing.</p>
<p>“I've got to think it out first,” Andy evaded, “feel all the symptoms of
an idea. You let me alone a while.”</p>
<p>“Say, yuh going to tell him he's been found out and yuh know his past,”
began Slim, “like yuh done Dunk? I'll bet, by golly—”</p>
<p>“Go on off and lay down!” Andy retorted pettishly. “I never worked the
same one off on you twice, did I? Think I'm getting feeble-minded? It
ain't hard to put his nibs on the run—that's dead easy. Trouble is I
went and hobbled myself. I promised a lady I'd be mild.”</p>
<p>“Mamma!” muttered Weary, his sunny eyes taking in the shack-dotted
horizon. “Mild!—and all these jumpers on our hands!”</p>
<p>“Oh, well—there's more'n one way to kill a cat,” Andy reminded them
cheerfully. “You go on back and post the boys, Pink, not to get too
riled.”</p>
<p>He galloped off and left them to say and think what they pleased. He was
not uneasy over their following his advice or waiting for his plan. For
Andy Green had risen rapidly to a tacit leadership, since first he told
them of the coming colony. From being the official Ananias of the outfit,
king of all joke-makers, chief irritator of the bunch, whose lightest word
was suspected of hiding some deep meaning and whose most innocent action
was analysed, he had come to the point where they listened to him and
depended upon him to see a way out of every difficulty. They would depend
upon him now; of that he was sure—therefore they would wait for his
plan.</p>
<p>Strange as it may seem, the Happy Family had not seriously considered the
possibility of having their claims “jumped” so long as they kept valid
their legal residence. They had thought that they would be watched and
accused of collusion with the Flying U, and they intended to be extremely
careful. They meant to stay upon their claims at least seven months in the
year, which the law required. They meant to have every blade of grass
eaten by their own cattle, which would be counted as improving their
claims. They meant to give a homelike air of permanency to their
dwellings. They had already talked over a tentative plan of bringing water
to their desert claims, and had ridden over the bench-land for two days,
with the plat at hand for reference, that they might be sure of choosing
their claims wisely. They had prepared for every contingency save the one
that had arisen—which is a common experience with us all. They had
not expected that their claims would be jumped and contests filed so early
in the game, as long as they maintained their residence.</p>
<p>However, Andy was not dismayed at the turn of events. It was stimulating
to the imagination to be brought face to face with an emergency such as
this, and to feel that one must handle it with strength and diplomacy and
a mildness of procedure that would find favor in the eyes of a girl.</p>
<p>He looked across the waving grass to where the four roomed shack was built
upon the four corners of four “eighties” so that four women might live
together and yet be said to live upon their own claims. That was drawing
the line pretty fine, of course; finer than the Happy Family would have
dared to draw it. But no one would raise any objection, on account of
their being women and timid about living alone. Andy smiled
sympathetically because the four conjunctive corners of the four claims
happened to lie upon a bald pinnacle bare of grass or shelter or water,
even. The shack stood bleakly revealed to the four winds—but also it
over looked the benchland and the rolling, half-barren land to the west,
which comprised Antelope Coulee and Dry Coulee and several other
good-for-nothing coulees capable of supporting nothing but coyotes and
prairie dogs and gophers.</p>
<p>A mile that way Andy rode, and stopped upon the steep side of a gulch
which was an arm of Antelope Coulee. He looked down into the gulch,
searched with his eyes for the stake that marked the southeast corner of
the eighty lying off in this direction from the shack, and finally saw it
fifty yards away on a bald patch of adobe.</p>
<p>He resisted the temptation to ride over and call upon Miss Allen—the
resistance made easier by the hour, which was eight o'clock or thereabouts—and
rode back to the others very well satisfied with himself and his plan.</p>
<p>He found the whole Happy Family gathered upon the level land just over his
west line, extolling resentment while they waited his coming. Grinning, he
told them his plan, and set them grinning also. He gave them certain work
to be done, and watched them scatter to do his bidding. Then he turned and
rode away upon business of his own.</p>
<p>The claim-jumper, watching the bench land through a pair of field glasses,
saw a herd of cows and calves scattered and feeding contentedly upon the
young grass a mile or so away. Two men on horseback loitered upon the
outer fringe of the herd. From a distance hilltop came the staccato sound
of hammers where an other shack was going up. Cloud shadows slid silently
over the land, with bright sunlight chasing after. Of the other horsemen
who had come up the bluff with the cattle, he saw not a sign. So the man
yawned and went in to his breakfast.</p>
<p>Many times that day he stood at the corner of his shack with the glasses
sweeping the bench-land. Toward noon the cattle drifted into a coulee
where there was water. In a couple of hours they drifted leisurely back
upon high ground and scattered to their feeding, still watched and tended
by the two horsemen who looked the most harmless of individuals. One was
fat and red-faced and spent at least half of his time lying prone upon
some slope in the shade of his horse. The other was thin and awkward, and
slouched in the saddle or sat upon the ground with his knees drawn up and
his arms clasped loosely around them, a cigarette dangling upon his lower
lip, himself the picture of boredom.</p>
<p>There was nothing whatever to indicate that events were breeding in that
peaceful scene, and that adventure was creeping close upon the watcher. He
went in from his fourth or fifth inspection, and took a nap.</p>
<p>That night he was awakened by a pounding on the side of the shack where
was his window. By the time he had reached the middle of the floor—and
you could count the time in seconds—a similar pounding was at the
door. He tried to open the door and couldn't. He went to the window and
could see nothing, although the night had not been dark when he went to
bed. He shouted, and there was no reply; nor could he hear any talking
without. His name, by the way, was H. J. Owens, though his name does not
matter except for convenience in mentioning him. Owens, then, lighted a
lamp, and almost instantly was forced to reach out quickly and save it
from toppling, because one corner of the shack was lifting, lifting...</p>
<p>Outside, the Happy Family worked in silence. Before they had left One Man
Coulee they had known exactly what they were to do, and how to do it. They
knew who was to nail the hastily constructed shutter over the window. They
knew who was to fasten the door so that it could not be opened from
within. They knew also who were to use the crow-bars, who were to roll the
skids under the shack.</p>
<p>There were twelve of them—because Bert Rogers had insisted upon
helping. In not many more minutes than there were men, they were in their
saddles, ready to start. The shack lurched forward after the straining
horses. Once it was fairly started it moved more easily than you might
think it could do, upon crude runners made of cottonwood logs eight inches
or so in diameter and long enough for cross pieces bolted in front and
rear. The horses pulled it easily with the ropes tied to the saddle-horns,
just as they had many times pulled the roundup wagons across mirey creeks
or up steep slopes; just as they had many times pulled stubborn cattle or
dead cattle—just as they had been trained to pull anything and
everything their masters chose to attach to their ropes.</p>
<p>Within, Owens called to them and cursed them. When they had just gained an
even pace, he emptied his revolver through the four sides of the shack.
But he did not know where they were, exactly, so that he was compelled to
shoot at random. And since the five shots seemed to have no effect
whatever upon the steady progress of the shack, he decided to wait until
he could see where to aim. There was no use, he reflected, in wasting good
ammunition when there was a strong probability that he would need it
later.</p>
<p>After a half hour or more of continuous travel, the shack tilted on a
steep descent. H. J. Owens blew out his lamp and swore when a box came
sliding against his shins in the dark. The descent continued until it was
stopped with a jolt that made him bite his tongue painfully, so that tears
came into the eyes that were the wrong shade of blue to please Andy Green.
He heard a laugh cut short and a muttered command, and that was all. The
shack heaved, toppled, righted itself and went on down, and down, and
down; jerked sidewise to the left, went forward and then swung joltingly
the other way. When finally it came to a permanent stand it was sitting
with an almost level floor.</p>
<p>Then the four corners heaved upward, two at a time, and settled with a
final squeal of twisted boards and nails. There was a sound of confused
trampling, and after that the lessening sounds of departure. Mr. Owens
tried the door again, and found it still fast. He relighted the lamp,
carried it to the window and looked upon rough boards outside the glass.
He meditated anxiously and decided to remain quiet until daylight.</p>
<p>The Happy Family worked hard, that night. Before daylight they were in
their beds and snoring except the two who guarded the cattle. Each was in
his own cabin. His horse was in his corral, smooth-coated and dry. There
was nothing to tell of the night's happenings,—nothing except the
satisfied grins on their faces when they woke and remembered.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0012" id="link2HCH0012"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 12. SHACKS, LIVE STOCK AND PILGRIMS PROMPTLY AND PAINFULLY REMOVED </h2>
<p>“I'm looking rather seedy now, while holding down my<br/>
claim,<br/>
And my grub it isn't always served the best,<br/>
And the mice play shyly round me as I lay me down to rest In<br/>
my little old sod shanty on my claim.<br/>
Oh, the hinges are of leather and the windows have no glass,<br/>
And the roof it lets the howling blizzards in,<br/>
And I hear the hungry kiote as he sneaks up through<br/>
grass—<br/></p>
<p>“Say! have they got down the hill yet, Pink;” Pink took his cigarette from
his fingers, leaned and peered cautiously through the grimy window.
“Unh-huh. They're coming up the flat.”</p>
<p>Whereupon Andy Green, ostentatiously washing his breakfast dishes, skipped
two or three verses and lifted his voice in song to fit the occasion.</p>
<p>“How I wish that some kind-hearted girl would pity on me<br/>
take,<br/>
And relieve me of the mess that I am in!<br/>
Oh, the angel, how I'd bless her if her home with me she'd<br/>
make,<br/>
In my little old sod shanty—<br/></p>
<p>“Got her yet?” And he craned his neck to look. “Aw, they've pulled up, out
there, listening!”</p>
<p>“My clothes are plastered o'er with dough, I'm looking like a<br/>
fright,<br/>
And everything is scattered round the room—”<br/></p>
<p>“Why don't yuh stop that caterwauling?” Pink demanded fretfully. “You'll
queer the whole play if you keep it up. They'll swear you're drunk!”</p>
<p>There was sense in that. Andy finished the line about remaining two happy
lovers in his little old sod shanty, and went to the door with the
dishpan. He threw out the water, squeezed the dishrag in one hand and gave
the inside of the pan a swipe before he appeared to discover that Miss
Allen and Florence Grace Hallman were riding up to his door. As a matter
of fact, he had seen them come over the top of the bluff and had long ago
guessed who they were.</p>
<p>He met them with a smile of surprised innocence, and invited them inside.
They refused to come, and even Miss Allen showed a certain reproachful
coolness toward him. Andy felt hurt at that, but he did not manifest the
fact. Instead he informed them that it was a fine morning. And were they
out taking a look around?</p>
<p>They were. They were looking up the men who had perpetrated the outrage
last night upon four settlers.</p>
<p>“Outrage?” Andy tilted the dishpan against the cabin wall, draped the
dishrag over the handle and went forward, pulling down his sleeves. “What
outrage is that, Miss Hallman? Anybody killed?”</p>
<p>Miss Hallman watched him with her narrowed glance. She saw the quick
glance he gave Miss Allen, and her lids narrowed still more. So that was
it! But she did not swerve from her purpose, for all this unexpected
thrust straight to the heart of her self-love.</p>
<p>“You know that no one was killed. But you damaged enough property to place
you on the wrong side of the law, Mr. Green. Not one of those shacks can
be gotten out of the gulch except in pieces!”</p>
<p>Andy smiled inside his soul, but his face was bewildered; his eyes fixed
themselves blankly upon her face. “Me? Damaging property? Miss Hallman,
you don't know me yet!” Which was perfectly true. “What shacks are you
talking about? In what gulch? All the shacks I've seen so far have been
stuck up on bald pinnacles where the blizzards will hit 'em coming and
going next winter.” He glanced again at Miss Allen with a certain
sympathetic foretaste of what she would suffer next winter if she stayed
in her shack.</p>
<p>“Don't try to play innocent, Mr. Green.” Florence Grace Hallman drew her
brows together. “We all know perfectly well who dragged those shacks off
the claims last night.”</p>
<p>“Don't you mean that you think you know? I'm afraid you've kinda taken it
for granted I'd be mixed up in any deviltry you happened to hear about.
I've got in bad with you—I know that—but just the same, I hate
to be accused of everything that takes place in the country. All this is
sure interesting news to me. Whereabouts was they taken from? And when,
and where to? Miss Allen, you'll tell me the straight of this, won't you?
And I'll get my hoss and you'll show me what gulch she's talking about,
won't you?”</p>
<p>Miss Allen puckered her lips into a pout which meant indecision, and
glanced at Florence Grace Hallman. And Miss Hallman frowned at being
shunted into the background and referred to as she, and set her teeth into
her lower lip.</p>
<p>“Miss Allen prefers to choose her own company,” she said with distinct
rudeness. “Don't try to wheedle her—you can't do it. And you needn't
get your horse to ride anywhere with us, Mr. Green. It's useless. I just
wanted to warn you that nothing like what happened last night will be
tolerated. We know all about you Flying U men—you Happy Family.” She
said it as if she were calling them something perfectly disgraceful. “You
may be just as tough and bad a you please—you can't frighten anyone
into leaving the country or into giving up one iota of their rights. I
came to you because you are undoubtedly the ring-leader of the gang.” She
accented gang. “You ought to be shot for what you did last night. And if
you keep on—” She left the contingency to his imagination.</p>
<p>“Well, if settling up the country means that men are going to be shot for
going to bed at dark and asleeping till sun-up, all I've got to say is
that things ain't like they used to be. We were all plumb peaceful here
till your colony came, Miss Hallman. Why, the sheriff never got out this
way often enough to know the trails! He always had to ask his way around.
If your bunch of town mutts can't behave themselves and leave each other
alone, I don't know what's to be done about it. We ain't hired to keep the
peace.”</p>
<p>“No, you've been hired to steal all the land you can and make all the
trouble you can. We understand that perfectly.”</p>
<p>Andy shook his head in meek denial, and with a sudden impulse turned
toward the cabin. “Oh, Pink!” he called, and brought that boyish-faced
young man to the door, his eyes as wide and as pure as the eyes of a
child.</p>
<p>Pink lifted his hat with just the proper degree of confusion to impress
the girls with his bashfulness and his awe of their presence. His eyes
were the same pansy-purple as when the Flying U first made tumultuous
acquaintance with him. His apparent innocence had completely fooled the
Happy Family, you will remember. They had called him Mamma's Little Lamb
and had composed poetry and horrific personal history for his benefit. The
few years had not changed him. His hair was still yellow and curly. The
dimples still dodged into his cheeks unexpectedly; he was still much like
a stick of dynamite wrapped in white tissue and tied with a ribbon. He
looked an angel of innocence, and in reality he was a little devil.</p>
<p>Andy introduced him, and Pink bowed and had all the appearance of blushing—though
you will have to ask Pink how he managed to create that optical illusion.
“What did you want?” he asked in his soft, girlish voice, turning to Andy
bashfully. But from the corner of his eye Pink saw that a little smile of
remembrance had come to soften Miss Hallman's angry features, and that the
other girl was smiling also. Pink hated that attitude of pleasant
patronage which women were so apt to take toward him, but for the present
it suited his purpose to encourage it.</p>
<p>“Pink, what time was it when we went to bed last night?” Andy asked him in
the tone of one who wished to eliminate all doubt of his virtue.</p>
<p>“Why—it was pretty early. We didn't light the lamp at all, you
remember. You went to bed before I did—we couldn't see the cards—”
He stopped confusedly, and again he gave the two women the impression that
he blushed. “We weren't playing for money,” he hurriedly explained. “Just
for pastime. It's—pretty lonesome—sometimes.”</p>
<p>“Somebody did something to somebody last night,” Andy informed Pink with a
resentful impatience. “Miss Hallman thinks we're the guilty parties—me
in particular, because she don't like me. It's something about some shacks—damaging
property, she called it. Just what was it you said was done, Miss
Hallman?” He turned his honest, gray eyes toward her and met her
suspicious look steadily.</p>
<p>Miss Hallman bit her lip. She had been perfectly sure of the guilt of Andy
Green, and of the others who were his friends. Now, in spite of all reason
she was not so sure. And there had been nothing more tangible than two
pairs of innocent-looking eyes and the irreproachable manners of two men
to change her conviction.</p>
<p>“Well, I naturally took it for granted that you did it,” she weakened.
“The shacks were moved off eighties that you have filed upon, Mr. Green.
Mr. Owens told me this morning that you men came by his place and
threatened him yesterday, and ordered him to move. No one else would have
any object in molesting him or the others.” Her voice hardened again as
her mind dwelt upon the circumstances. “It must have been you!” she
finished sharply.</p>
<p>Whereupon Pink gave her a distressed look that made Miss Hallman flush
unmistakably. “I'm just about distracted, this morning,” she apologized.
“I took it upon myself to see these settlers through—and everybody
makes it just as hard as possible for me. Why should all you fellows treat
us the way you do? We—”</p>
<p>“Why, we aren't doing a thing!” Pink protested diffidently. “We thought
we'd take up some claims and go to ranching for ourselves, when we got
discharged from the Flying U. We didn't mean any harm—everybody's
taking up claims. We've bought some cattle and we're going to try and get
ahead, like other folks. We—I wanted to cut out all this wildness—”</p>
<p>“Are those your cattle up on the hill? Some men shipped in four carloads
of young stock, yesterday, to Dry Lake. They drove them out here intending
to turn them on the range, and a couple of men—”</p>
<p>“Four men,” Miss Allen corrected with a furtive twinkle in her eyes.</p>
<p>“Some men refused to let them cross that big coulee back there. They drove
the cattle back toward Dry Lake, and told Mr. Simmons and Mr. Chase and
some others that they shouldn't come on this bench back here at all. That
was another thing I wanted to see you men about.”</p>
<p>“Maybe they were going to mix their stock up with ours,” Pink ventured
mildly.</p>
<p>“Your men shot, and shot, and shot—the atmosphere up there is shot
so full of holes that the wind just whistles through!” Miss Allen informed
then gravely, with her eyebrows all puckered together and the furtive
little twinkle in her eyes. “And they yelled so that we could hear them
from the house! They made those poor cows and those poor, weenty calves
just go trotting back across the coulee. My new book on farming says you
positively must not hurry cattle. It—oh, it does something to the
butter-fat—joggles it all up or something—I'll lend you the
book. I found the chapter on Proper Treatment of Dairy Stock, and I
watched those men with the book in my hands. Why, it was terribly
unscientific, the way they drove those cow-critters!”</p>
<p>“I'll come over and get the book,” Andy promised her, with a look in his
eyes that displeased Miss Hallman very much. “We're ashamed of our
ignorance. We'd like to have you learn us what's in the book.”</p>
<p>“I will. And every week—just think of that! I'm to get a real farm
paper.”</p>
<p>“I'd like to borrow the paper too,” Andy declared instantly.</p>
<p>“Oh, and—what's going to be done about all those bullet-holes? They—they
might create a draught—”</p>
<p>“We'll ride around that way and plug 'em up,” Andy assured her solemnly.
“Whenever you've got time to show me about where they're at.”</p>
<p>“It will be a pleasure. I can tell where they are, but they're too high
for me to reach. Wherever the wind whistles there's a hole in the
atmosphere. And there are places where the air just quivers, so you can
see it. That is the shock those bold, bad men gave it with the words they
used. They—used—words, Mr. Green! If we could scheme some way
to pull out all those wrinkles—I do love a nice, clean, smooth
atmosphere where I live. It's so wrinkly—”</p>
<p>“I'll attend to all that, right away.”</p>
<p>Miss Hallman decided that she had nothing further to say to Mr. Green. She
wheeled her horse rather abruptly and rode off with a curt goodbye. Miss
Allen, being new at the business of handling a horse, took more time in
pulling her mount around. While her back was turned to Florence Grace and
her face was turned toward Pink and Andy, she gave them a twinkling glance
that had one lowered eyelid to it, twisted her lips, and spoke sharply to
her horse. They might make of it what they would. Florence Grace looked
back impatiently—perhaps suspiciously also—and saw Miss Allen
coming on with docile haste.</p>
<p>So that ended the interview which Miss Hallman had meant to be so
impressive. A lot of nonsense that left a laugh behind and the idea that
Miss Allen at least did not disapprove of harassing claim-jumpers. Andy
Green was two hundred per cent. more cheerful after that, and his brain
was more active and his determination more fixed. For all that he stared
after them thoughtfully.</p>
<p>“She winked at us—if I've got eyes in my head. What do you reckon
she meant, Pink?” he asked when the two riders had climbed over the ridge.
“And what she said about the bold, bad men shooting holes that have to be
plugged up—and about liking a nice, smooth atmosphere? Do you
suppose she meant that it's liable to take bold, bad men to clean the
atmosphere, or—”</p>
<p>“What difference does it make what she meant? There's jumpers left—two
on Bud's place—and he's oary-eyed over it, and was going to read 'em
the riot act proper, when I left to come over here. And a couple of men
drove onto that south eighty of Mig's with a load of lumber, just as I
come by. Looks to me like we've got our hands full, Andy. There'll be
holes to plug up somewhere besides in the atmosphere, if you ask me.”</p>
<p>“Long as they don't get anything on us I ain't in the state of mind where
I give a darn. That little brown-eyed Susan'll keep us posted if they
start anything new—what did she mean by that wink, do you reckon?”</p>
<p>“Ah, don't get softening of the emotions,” Pink advised impatiently.
“That's the worst thing we've got to steer clear of, Andy! All them women
in the game is going to make it four times as hard to stand 'em off. Irish
is foolish over this one you're gettin' stuck on—you'll be fighting
each other, if you don't look out. That Florence Grace lady ain't so slow—she's
going to use the women to keep us fellows guessing.”</p>
<p>Andy sighed. “We can block that play, of course,” he said. “Come on, Pink,
let's go round up the boys and see what's been taking place with them
cattle. Shipped in four carloads already, have they?” He began pulling on
his chaps rather hurriedly. “Worst of it is, you can't stampede a bunch of
darned tame cows, either,” he complained.</p>
<p>They found Irish and the Native Son on day-herd, with the cattle scattered
well along the western line of the claims. Big Medicine, Weary, Cal Emmett
and Jack Bates were just returning from driving the settlers' stock well
across Antelope Coulee which had been decided upon as a hypothetical
boundary line until such time as a fence could be built.</p>
<p>They talked with the day-herders, and they talked with the other four.
Chip came up from the ranch with the Kid riding proudly beside him on
Silver, and told them that the Honorable Mr. Blake was at the Flying U and
had sent word that he would be pleased to take the legal end of the fight,
if the Happy Family so desired. Which was in itself a vast encouragement.
The Honorable Blake had said that they were well within their rights thus
far, and advised them to permit service of the contest notices, and to go
calmly on fulfilling the law. Which was all very well as far as it went,
providing they were permitted to go on calmly.</p>
<p>“What about them cattle they're trying to git across our land?” Slim
wanted to know. “We got a right to keep 'em off, ain't we?”</p>
<p>Chip said that he thought they had, but to make sure, he would ask the
Honorable Blake. Trespassing, he said, might be avoided—</p>
<p>Right there Andy was seized with an idea. He took Chip—because of
his artistic talents which, he said, had been plumb wasted lately—to
one side. After wards they departed in haste, with Pink and Weary
galloping close at their heels. In a couple of hours they returned to the
boundary where the cattle still fed all scattered out in a long line, and
behind them drove Pink and Weary in the one wagon which the Family
possessed.</p>
<p>“It oughta help some,” grinned Andy, when the Native Son came curiously
over to see what it was they were erecting there on the prairie. “It's a
fair warning, and shows 'em where to head in at.”</p>
<p>The Native Son read the sign, which was three feet long and stood nailed
to two posts ready for planting solidly in the earth. He showed his even,
white teeth in a smile of approval. “Back it up, and it ought to do some
good,” he said.</p>
<p>They dug holes and set the posts, and drove on to where they meant to
plant another sign exactly like the first. That day they planted twelve
sign-boards along their west line. They might not do any good, but they
were a fair warning and as such were worth the trouble.</p>
<p>That afternoon Andy was riding back along the line when he saw a rider
pull up at the first sign and read it carefully. He galloped in haste to
the spot and found that his suspicions were correct; it was Miss Allen.</p>
<p>“Well,” she said when he came near, “I suppose that means me. Does it?”
She pointed to the sign, which read like this:</p>
<p>WARNING!! NO TRESPASSING EAST OF HERE All Shacks, Live-Stock and Pilgrims
Promptly AND Painfully Removed From These Premises</p>
<p>“I'm over the line,” she notified him, pulling her horse backward a few
feet. “You're getting awfully particular, seems to me. Oh, did you know
that a lot of men are going to play it's New Year's Eve and hold watch
meetings tonight?”</p>
<p>“Never heard a word about it,” he declared truthfully, and waited for
more.</p>
<p>“That's not strange—seeing it's a surprise party. Still—I'm
sure you are expected to—attend.”</p>
<p>“And where is all this to take place?” Andy looked at her intently,
smiling a little.</p>
<p>“Oh, over there—and there—and there.” She pointed to three new
shacks—the official dwellings of certain contestants. “Stag parties,
they are, I believe. But I doubt if they'll have any very exciting time;
most of these new settlers are too busy getting the ground ready for
crops, to go to parties. Some people are pretty disgusted, I can tell you,
Mr. Green. Some people talk about ingratitude and wonder why the colony
doesn't hang together better. Some people even wonder why it is that folks
are interested mainly in their own affairs, and decline to attend watch
meetings and—receptions. So I'm afraid very few, except your nearest
neighbors, will be present, after all might I ask when you expect to—to
MOVE again, Mr. Green?”</p>
<p>Smiling still, Andy shook his head. “I expect to be pretty busy this
spring,” he told her evasively. “Aren't any of you ladies invited to those
parties, Miss Allen?”</p>
<p>“Not a one. But let me tell you something, Mr. Green. Some folks think
that perhaps we lady-settlers ought to organize a club for the well being
of our intellects. Some folks are trying to get up parties just for women—see
the point? They think it would be better for the—atmosphere.”</p>
<p>“Oh.” Andy studied the possibilities of such a move. If Florence Grace
should set the women after them, he could see how the Happy Family would
be hampered at every turn. “Well, I must be going. Say, did you know this
country is full of wild animals, Miss Allen? They prowl around nights. And
there's a gang of wild men that hang out up there in those mountains—they
prowl around nights, too. They're outlaws. They kill off every sheriff's
party that tries to round them up, and they kidnap children and ladies. If
you should hear any disturbance, any time, don't be scared. Just stay
inside after dark and keep your door locked. And if you should organize
that ladies' club, you better hold your meetings in the afternoon, don't
you think?”</p>
<p>When he had ridden on and left her, Andy was somewhat ashamed of such
puerile falsehoods. But then, she had started the allegorical method of
imparting advice, he remembered. So presently went whistling to round up
the boys and tell them what he had learned.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0013" id="link2HCH0013"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 13. IRISH WORKS FOR THE CAUSE </h2>
<p>Big Medicine with Weary and Chip to bear him company, rode up to the shack
nearest his own, which had been hastily built by a raw-boned Dane who
might be called truly Americanized. Big Medicine did not waste time in
superfluities or in making threats of what he meant to do. He called the
Dane to the door—claim-jumpers were keeping close to their cabins,
these days—and told him that he was on another man's land, and asked
him if he meant to move.</p>
<p>“Sure I don't intend to move!” retorted the Dane with praiseworthy
promptness. “I'm going to hold 'er down solid.”</p>
<p>“Yuh hear what says, boys.” Big Medicine turned to his companions “He
ain't going to git off'n my land, he says. Weary, yuh better go tell the
bunch I need'em.”</p>
<p>Weary immediately departed. He was not gone so very long, and when he
returned the Happy Family was with him, even to Patsy who drove the wagon
with all the ease of a veteran of many roundups. The Dane tried bluster,
but that did not seem to work. Nothing seemed to work, except the Happy
Family.</p>
<p>There in broad daylight, with no more words than were needful, they moved
the Dane, and his shack. When they began to raise the building he was so
unwise as to flourish a gun, and thereby made it perfectly right and
lawful that Big Medicine should take the gun away from him and march him
ahead of his own forty-five.</p>
<p>They took the shack directly past one of the trespassing signs, and Big
Medicine stopped accommodatingly while the Dane was permitted to read the
sign three times aloud. That the Dane did not seem truly appreciative of
the privilege was no fault of Big Medicine's, surely. They went on,
skidding the little building sledlike over the uneven prairie. They took
it down into Antelope Coulee and left it there, right side up and with not
even a pane of glass broken in the window.</p>
<p>“There, darn yuh, live there awhile!” Andy gritted to when the timbers
were withdrawn from beneath the cabin and they were ready to leave. “You
can't say we damaged your property—this time. Come back, and there's
no telling what we're liable to do.”</p>
<p>Since Big Medicine kept his gun, the Dane could do nothing but swear while
he watched them ride up the hill and out of sight.</p>
<p>They made straight for the next interloper, remarking frequently that it
was much simpler and easier to do their moving in daylight. There they had
an audience, for Florence Grace rode furiously up just as they were
getting under way. The Happy Family spoke very nicely to Florence Grace,
and when she spoke very sharply to them they were discreetly hard of
hearing and became absorbed in their work.</p>
<p>Several settlers came before that shack was moved, but they only stood
around and talked among themselves, and were careful not to get in the way
or to hinder, and to lower their voices so that the Happy Family need not
hear unless they chose to listen.</p>
<p>So they slid that shack into the coulee, righted it carefully and left it
there—where it would be exceedingly difficult to get it out, by the
way; since it is much easier to drag a building down hill than up, and the
steeper the hill and the higher, the greater the difference.</p>
<p>They loaded the timbers into the wagon and methodically on to the next
shack, their audience increased to a couple of dozen perturbed settlers.
The owner of this particular shack, feeling the strength of numbers behind
him, was disposed to argue the point.</p>
<p>“Oh, you'll sweat for this!” he shouted impotently when the Happy Family
was placing the timbers.</p>
<p>“Ah, git outa the way!” said Andy, coming toward him with a crowbar.
“We're sweating now, if that makes yuh feel any better.”</p>
<p>The man got out of the way, and went and stood with the group of
onlookers, and talked vaguely of having the law on them—whatever he
meant by that.</p>
<p>By the time they had placed the third shack in the bottom of the coulee,
the sun was setting. They dragged the timbers up the steep bluff with
their ropes and their saddle-horses, loaded them on to the wagon and threw
the crowbars and rolling timbers in, and turned to look curiously and
unashamed at their audience. Andy, still tacitly their leader, rode a few
steps forward.</p>
<p>“That'll be all today,” he announced politely. “Except that load of lumber
back here on the bench where it don't belong—we aim to haul that
over the line. Seeing your considerable interest in our affairs, I'll just
say that we filed on our claims according to law, and we're living on 'em
according to law. Till somebody proves in court that we're not, there
don't any shack, or any stock, stay on our side the line any longer than
it takes to get them off. There's the signs, folks—read 'em and take
'em to heart. You can go home now. The show's over.”</p>
<p>He lifted his hat to the women—and there were several now—and
went away to join his fellows, who had ridden on slowly till he might
overtake them. He found Happy Jack grumbling and predicting evil, as it
was his nature to do, but he merely straightened his aching back and
laughed at the prophecies.</p>
<p>“As I told you before, there's more than one way to kill a cat,” he
asserted tritely but never the less impressively. “Nobody can say we
wasn't mild; and nobody can say we hadn't a right to get those
chickencoops off our land. If you ask me, Florence Grace will have to go
some now if she gets the best of the deal. She overlooked a bet. We
haven't been served with any contest notices yet, and so we ain't obliged
to take their say-so. Who's going to stand guard tonight? We've got to
stand our regular shifts, if we want to keep ahead of the game. I'm
willing to be It. I'd like to make sure they don't slip any stock across
before daylight.”</p>
<p>“Say, it's lucky we've got a bunch of boneheads like them to handle,” Pink
observed thankfully. “Would a bunch of natives have stood around like that
with their hands in their pockets and let us get away with the moving job?
Not so you could notice!”</p>
<p>“What we'd better do,” cut in the Native Son without any misleading drawl,
“is try and rustle enough money to build that fence.”</p>
<p>“That's right,” assented Cal. “Maybe the Old Man—”</p>
<p>“We don't go to the Old Man for so much as a bacon rind!” cried the Native
Son impatiently. “Get it into your systems, boys, that we've got to ride
away around the Flying U. We ought to be able to build that fence, all
right, without help from anybody. Till we do we've got to hang and rattle,
and keep that nester stock from getting past us. I'll stand guard till
midnight.”</p>
<p>A little more talk, and some bickering with Slim and Happy Jack, the two
chronic kickers, served to knock together a fair working organization.
Weary and Andy Green were informally chosen joint leaders, because Weary
could be depended upon to furnish the mental ballast for Andy's
imagination. Patsy was told that he would have to cook for the outfit,
since he was too fat to ride. They suggested that he begin at, once, by
knocking together some sort of supper. Moving houses, they declared, was
work. They frankly hoped that they would not have to move many more—and
they were very positive that they would not be compelled to move the same
shack twice, at any rate.</p>
<p>“Say, we'll have quite a collection of shacks down in Antelope Coulee if
we keep on,” Jack Bates reminded them. “Wonder where they'll get water?”</p>
<p>“Where's the rest of them going to get water?” Cal Emmett challenged the
crowd. “There's that spring the four women up here pack water from—but
that goes dry in August. And there's the creek—that goes dry too. On
the dead, I feel sorry for the women—and so does Irish,” he added
dryly.</p>
<p>Irish made an uncivil retort and swung suddenly away from the group. “I'm
going to ride into town, boys,” he announced curtly. “I'll be back in the
morning and go on day-herd.”</p>
<p>“Maybe you will and maybe you won't,” Weary amended somewhat impatiently.
“This is certainly a poor time for Irish to break out,” he added, watching
his double go galloping toward the town road.</p>
<p>“I betche he comes back full and tries to clean out all them nesters,”
Happy Jack predicted. For once no one tried to combat his pessimism—for
that was exactly what every one of them believed would happen.</p>
<p>“He's stayed sober a long while—for him,” sighed Weary, who never
could quite shake off a sense of responsibility for the moral defections
of his kinsman. “Maybe I better go along and ride herd on him.” Still, he
did not go, and Irish presently merged into the dusky distance.</p>
<p>As is often the case with a family's black sheep, his intentions were the
best, even though they might have been considered unorthodox. While the
Happy Family took it for granted that he was gone because an old thirst
awoke within him, Irish was thinking only of the welfare of the outfit. He
did not tell them, because he was the sort who does not prattle of his
intentions, one way or the other. If he did what he meant to do there
would be time enough to explain; if he failed there was nothing to be
said.</p>
<p>Irish had thought a good deal about the building of that fence, and about
the problem of paying for enough wire and posts to run the fence straight
through from Meeker's south line to the north line of the Flying U. He had
figured the price of posts and the price of wire and had come somewhere
near the approximate cost of the undertaking. He was not at all sure that
the Happy Family had faced the actual figures on that proposition. They
had remarked vaguely that it was going to cost some money. They had made
casual remarks about being broke personally and, so far as they knew,
permanently.</p>
<p>Irish was hot-headed and impulsive to a degree. He was given to occasional
tumultuous sprees, during which he was to be handled with extreme care—or,
better still, left entirely alone until the spell was over. He looked
almost exactly like Weary, and yet he was almost his opposite in
disposition. Weary was optimistic, peace-loving, steady as the sun above
him except for a little surface-bubbling of fun that kept him sunny
through storm and calm. You could walk all over Weary—figuratively
speaking—before he would show resentment. You could not step very
close to Irish without running the risk of consequences. That he should,
under all that, have a streak of calculating, hard-headed business sense,
did not occur to them.</p>
<p>They rode on, discussing the present situation and how best to meet it;
the contingencies of the future, and how best to circumvent the active
antagonism of Florence Grace Hallman and the colony for which she stood
sponsor. They did not dream that Irish was giving his whole mind to
solving the problem of raising money to build that fence, but that is
exactly what he was doing.</p>
<p>Some of you at least are going to object to his method. Some of you—those
of you who live west of the big river—are going to understand his
point of view, and you will recognize his method as being perfectly
logical, simple, and altogether natural to a man of his temperament and
manner of life. It is for you that I am going to relate his experiences.
Sheltered readers, readers who have never faced life in the raw, readers
who sit down on Sunday mornings with a mind purged of worldly thoughts and
commit to memory a “golden text” which they forget before another Sunday
morning, should skip the rest of this chapter for the good of their
morals. The rest is for you men who have kicked up alkali dust and
afterwards washed out the memory in town; who have gone broke between
starlight and sun; who know the ways of punchers the West over, and can at
least sympathize with Irish in what he meant to do that night.</p>
<p>Irish had been easing down a corner of the last shack, with his back
turned toward three men who stood looking on with the detached interest
which proved they did not own this particular shack. One was H. J. Owens—I
don't think you have met the others. Irish had not. He had overheard this
scrap of conversation while he worked:</p>
<p>“Going to town tonight?”</p>
<p>“Guess so—I sure ain't going to hang out on this prairie any more
than I have to. You going?”</p>
<p>“Ye-es—I think I will. I hear there's been some pretty swift games
going, the last night or two. A fellow in that last bunch Florence rounded
up made quite a clean up last night.”</p>
<p>“That so, let's go on in. This claim-holding gets my goat anyway. I don't
see where—”</p>
<p>That was all Irish heard, but that was enough.</p>
<p>Had he turned in time to catch the wink that one speaker gave to the
other, and the sardonic grin that answered the lowered eyelid, he would
have had the scrap of conversation properly focused in his mind, and would
not have swallowed the bait as greedily as he did. But we all make
mistakes. Irish made the mistake of underestimating the cunning of his
enemies.</p>
<p>So here he was, kicking up the dust on the town trail just as those three
intended that he should do. But that he rode alone instead of in the midst
of his fellows was not what the three had intended; and that he rode with
the interest of his friends foremost in his mind was also an unforeseen
element in the scheme.</p>
<p>Irish did not see H. J. Owens anywhere in town—nor did he see either
of the two men who had stood behind him. But there was a poker game
running in Rusty Brown's back room, and Irish immediately sat in without
further investigation. Bert Rogers was standing behind one of the players,
and gave Irish a nod and a wink which may have had many meanings. Irish
interpreted it as encouragement to sail in and clean up the bunch.</p>
<p>There was money enough in sight to build that fence when he sat down.
Irish pulled his hat farther over his eyebrows, rolled and lighted a
cigarette while he waited for that particular jackpot to be taken, and
covertly sized up the players.</p>
<p>Every one of them was strange to him. But then, the town was full of
strangers since Florence Grace and her Syndicate began to reap a harvest
off the open country, so Irish merely studied the faces casually, as a
matter of habit They were nesters, of course—real or prospective.
They seemed to have plenty of money—and it was eminently fitting
that the Happy Family's fence should be built with nester money.</p>
<p>Irish had in his pockets exactly eighteen dollars and fifty-cents. He
bought eighteen dollars' worth of chips and began to play. Privately he
preferred stud poker to draw, but he was not going to propose a change; he
felt perfectly qualified to beat any three pilgrims that ever came West.</p>
<p>Four hands he played and lost four dollars. He drank a glass of beer then,
made himself another cigarette and settled down to business, feeling that
he had but just begun. After the fifth hand he looked up and caught again
the eye of Bert Rogers. Bert pulled his eyebrows together in a warning
look, and Irish thought better of staying that hand. He did not look at
Bert after that, but he did watch the other players more closely.</p>
<p>After awhile Bert wandered away, his interest dulling when he saw that
Irish was holding his own and a little better. Irish played on,
conservative to such a degree that in two hours he had not won more than
fifteen dollars. The Happy Family would have been surprised to see him lay
down kings and refuse to draw to them which he did once, with a gesture of
disgust that flipped them face up so that all could see. He turned them
over immediately, but the three had seen that this tall stranger, who had
all the earmarks of a cowpuncher, would not draw to kings but must have
something better before he would stay.</p>
<p>So they played until the crowd thinned; until Irish, by betting safely and
sticking to a caution that must have cost him a good deal in the way of
self-restraint, had sixty dollars' worth of chips piled in front of him.</p>
<p>Some men, playing for a definite purpose, would have quit at that. Irish
did not quit, however. He wanted a certain sum from these nesters. He had
come to town expecting to win a certain sum from them. He intended to play
until he got it or went broke. He was not using any trickery—and he
had stopped one man in the middle of a deal, with a certain look in his
eye remarking that he'd rather have the top card than the bottom one, so
that he was satisfied they were not trying to cheat.</p>
<p>There came a deal when Irish looked at his cards, sent a slanting look at
the others and laid down his five cards with a long breath. He raised the
ante four blue ones and rolled and lit a cigarette while the three had
drawn what cards they thought they needed. The man at Irish's left had
drawn only one card. Now he hesitated and then bet with some assurance.
Irish smoked imperturbably while the other two came in, and then he raised
the bet three stacks of blues. His neighbor raised him one stack, and the
next man hesitated and then laid down his cards. The third man meditated
for a minute and raised the bet ten dollars. Irish blew forth a leisurely
smoke wreath and with a sweep of his hand sent in all his chips.</p>
<p>There was a silent minute, wherein Irish smoked and drummed absently upon
the table with his fingers that were free. His neighbor frowned, grunted
and threw down his hand. The third man did the same. Irish made another
sweep of his hand and raked the table clean of chips.</p>
<p>“That'll do for tonight,” he remarked dryly. “I don't like to be a hog.”</p>
<p>Had that ended the incident, sensitive readers might still read and think
well of Irish. But one of the players was not quite sober, and he was a
poor loser and a pugnacious individual anyway, with a square face and a
thick neck that went straight up to the top of his head. His underlip
pushed out, and when Irish turned away, to cash in his chips, this
pugnacious one reached over and took a look at the cards Irish had held.</p>
<p>It certainly was as rotten a hand as a man could hold. Suits all mixed,
and not a face card or a pair in the lot. The pugnacious player had held a
king high straight, and he had stayed until Irish sent in all his chips.
He gave a bellow and jumped up and hit Irish a glancing blow back of the
ear. Let us not go into details. You know Irish—or you should know
him by this time. A man who will get away with a bluff like that should be
left alone or brained in the beginning of the fight—especially when
he can look down on the hair of a six-foot man, and has muscles hardened
by outdoor living. When the dust settled, two chairs were broken and some
glasses swept off the bar by heaving bodies, and two of the three players
had forgotten their troubles. The third was trying to find the knob on the
back door, and could not because of the buzzing in his head and the blood
in his eyes. Irish had welts and two broken knuckles and a clear
conscience, and he was so mad he almost wound up by thrashing Rusty, who
had stayed behind the bar and taken no hand in the fight. Rusty complained
because of the damage to his property, and Irish, being the only one
present in a condition to listen, took the complaint as a personal insult.</p>
<p>He counted his money to make sure he had it all, evened the edges of the
package of bank notes and thrust the package into his pocket. If Rusty had
kept his face closed about those few glasses and those chairs, he would
have left a “bill” on the bar to pay for them, even though he did need
every cent of that money. He told Rusty this, and he accused him of
standing in with the nesters and turning down the men who had helped him
make money' all these years.</p>
<p>“Why, darn your soul, I've spent money enough over this bar to buy out the
whole damn joint, and you know it!” he cried indignantly. “If you think
you've got to collect damages, take it outa these blinkety-blink pilgrims
you think so much of. Speak to 'em pleasant, though, or you're liable to
lose the price of a beer, maybe! They'll never bring you the money we've
brought you, you—”</p>
<p>“They won't because you've likely killed 'em both,” Rusty retorted
angrily. “You want to remember you can't come into town and rip things up
the back the way you used to, and nobody say a word. You better drift,
before that feller that went out comes back with an officer. You can't—”</p>
<p>“Officer be damned!” retorted Irish, unawed.</p>
<p>He went out while Rusty was deciding to order him out, and started for the
stable. Halfway there he ducked into the shadow of the blacksmith shop and
watched two men go up the street to Rusty's place, walking quickly. He
went on then, got his horse hurriedly without waiting to cinch the saddle,
led him behind the blacksmith shop where he would not be likely to be
found, and tied him there to the wreck of a freight wagon.</p>
<p>Then he went across lots to where Fred Wilson, manager of the general
store, slept in a two-room shack belonging to the hotel. The door was
locked—Fred being a small man with little trust in Providence or in
his overt physical prowess—and so he rapped cautiously upon the
window until Fred awoke and wanted to know who in thunder was there.</p>
<p>Irish told his name, and presently went inside. “I'm pulling outa town,
Fred,” he explained, “and I don't know when I'll be in again. So I want
you to take an order for some posts and bob wire and steeples. I—”</p>
<p>“Why didn't you come to the store?” Fred very naturally demanded, peevish
at being wakened at three o'clock in the morning. “I saw you in town when
I closed up.”</p>
<p>“I was busy. Crawl back into bed and cover up, while I give you the order.
I'll want a receipt for the money, too—I'm paying in advance, so you
won't have any excuse for holding up the order. Got any thing to write
on?”</p>
<p>Fred found part of an order pad and a pencil, and crept shivering into his
bed. The offer to pay in advance had silenced his grumbling, as Irish
expected it would. So Irish gave the order—thirteen hundred cedar
posts, I remember—I don't know just how much wire, but all he would
need.</p>
<p>“Holy Macintosh! Is this for YOU?” Fred wanted to know as he wrote it
down.</p>
<p>“Some of it. We're fencing our claims. If I don't come after the stuff
myself, let any of the boys have it that shows up. And get it here as
quick as you can—what you ain't got on hand—”</p>
<p>Fred was scratching his jaw meditatively with the pencil, and staring at
the order. “I can just about fill that order outa stock on hand,” he told
Irish. “When all this land rush started I laid in a big supply of posts
and wire. First thing they'd want, after they got their shacks up. How you
making it, out there?”</p>
<p>“Fine,” said Irish cheerfully, feeling his broken knuckles. “How much is
all that going to cost? You oughta make us a rate on it, seeing it's a
cash sale, and big.”</p>
<p>“I will.” Fred tore out a sheet and did some mysterious figuring,
afterwards crumpling the paper into a little wad and hipping it behind the
bed. “This has got to be on the quiet, Irish. I can't sell wire and posts
to those eastern marks at this rate, you know. This is just for you boys—and
the profit for us is trimmed right down to a whisper.” He named the sum
total with the air of one who confers a great favor.</p>
<p>Irish grinned and reached into his pocket. “You musta knocked your profit
down to fifty percent.,” he fleered. “But it's a go with me.” He peeled
off the whole roll, just about. He had two twenties left in his hand when
he stopped. He was very methodical that night. He took a receipt for the
money before he left and he looked at it with glistening eyes before he
folded it with the money. “Don't sell any posts and wire till our order's
filled, Fred,” he warned. “We'll begin hauling right away, and we'll want
it all.”</p>
<p>He let himself out into the cool starlight, walked in the shadows to where
he had left his horse, mounted and rode whistling away down the lane which
ended where the hills began.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0014" id="link2HCH0014"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 14. JUST ONE THING AFTER ANOTHER </h2>
<p>A gray clarity of the air told that daylight was near. The skyline
retreated, the hills came out of the duskiness like a photograph in the
developer tray. Irish dipped down the steep slope into Antelope Coulee,
cursing the sprinkle of new shacks that stood stark in the dawn on every
ridge and every hilltop, look where one might. He loped along the winding
trail through the coulee's bottom and climbed the hill beyond. At the top
he glanced across the more level upland to the east and his eyes
lightened. Far away stood a shack—Patsy's, that was. Beyond that
another, and yet another. Most of the boys had built in the coulees where
was water. They did not care so much about the view—over which Miss
Allen had grown enthusiastic.</p>
<p>He pulled up in a certain place near the brow of the hill, and looked down
into the narrower gulch where huddled the shacks they had moved. He
grinned at the sight. His hand went involuntarily to his pocket and the
grin widened. He hurried on that he might the sooner tell the boys of
their good luck; all the material for that line fence bought and paid for—there
would certainly laugh when they heard where the money had come from!</p>
<p>First he thought that he would locate the cattle and tell his news to the
boys on guard. He therefore left the trail and rode up on a ridge from
which he could overlook the whole benchland, with the exception of certain
gulches that cut through. The sky was reddening now, save where banked
clouds turned purple. A breeze crept over the grass and carried the fresh
odor of rain. Close beside him a little brown bird chittered briskly and
flew away into the dawn.</p>
<p>He looked away to where the Bear Paws humped, blue-black against the sky,
the top of Old Baldy blushing faintly under the first sun rays. He looked
past Wolf Butte, where the land was blackened with outcroppings of rock.
His eyes came back leisurely to the claim country. A faint surprise
widened his lids, and he turned and sent a glance sweeping to the right,
toward Flying U Coulee. He frowned, and studied the bench land carefully.</p>
<p>This was daybreak, when the cattle should be getting out for their
breakfast-feed. They should be scattered along the level just before him.
And there were no cattle anywhere in sight. Neither were there any riders
in sight. Irish gave a puzzled grunt and turned in his saddle, looking
back toward Dry Lake. That way, the land was more broken, and he could not
see so far. But as far as he could see there were no cattle that way
either. Last night when he rode to town the cattle of the colonists had
been feeding on the long slope three or four miles from where he stood,
across Antelope Coulee where he had helped the boys drive them.</p>
<p>He did not waste many minutes studying the empty prairie from the vantage
point of that ridge, however. The keynote of Irish's nature was action. He
sent his horse down the southern slope to the level, and began looking for
tracks, which is the range man's guide-book. He was not long in finding a
broad trail, in the grass where cattle had lately crossed the coulee from
the west. He knew what that meant, and he swore when he saw how the trail
pointed straight to the east—to the broken, open country beyond One
Man Coulee. What had the boys been thinking of, to let that nester stock
get past them in the night? What had the line-riders been doing? They were
supposed to guard against just such a move as this.</p>
<p>Irish was sore from his fight in town, and he had not had much sleep
during the past forty-eight hours, and he was ravenously hungry. He
followed the trail of the cattle until he saw that they certainly had
gotten across the Happy Family claims and into the rough country beyond;
then he turned and rode over to Patsy's shack, where a blue smoke column
wobbled up to the fitful air-current that seized it and sent it flying
toward the mountains.</p>
<p>There he learned that Dry Lake had not hugged to itself all the events of
the night. Patsy, smoking a pipefull of Durham while he waited for the
teakettle to boil, was wild with resentment. In the night, while he slept,
something had heaved his cabin up at one corner. In a minute another
corner heaved upward a foot or more. Patsy had yelled while he felt around
in the darkness for his clothes, and had got no answer, save other
heavings from below.</p>
<p>Patsy was not the man to submit tamely to such indignities. He had groped
and found his old 45-70 riffle, that made a noise like a young cannon and
kicked like a broncho cow. While the shack lurched this way and that,
Patsy pointed the gun toward the greatest disturbance and fired. He did
not think: he hit anybody, but he apologized to Irish for missing and
blamed the darkness for the misfortune. Py cosh, he sure tried—witness
the bullet holes which he had bored through the four sides of the shack;
he besought Irish to count them; which Irish did gravely. And what
happened then?</p>
<p>Then? Why, then the Happy Family had come; or at least all those who had
been awake and riding the prairie had come pounding up out of the dark,
their horses running like rabbits, their blood singing the song of battle.
They had grappled with certain of the enemy—Patsy broke open the
door and saw tangles of struggling forms in the faint starlight. The Happy
Family were not the type of men who must settle every argument with a gun,
remember. Not while their hands might be used to fight with. Patsy thought
that they licked the nesters without much trouble. He knew that the
settlers ran, and that the Happy Family chased them clear across the line
and then came back and let the shack down where it belonged upon the rock
underpining.</p>
<p>“Und py cosh! Dey vould move my shack off'n my land!” he grunted ragefully
as he lived over the memory.</p>
<p>Irish went to the door and looked out. The wind had risen in the last half
hour, so that his hat went sailing against the rear wall, but he did not
notice that. He was wondering why the settlers had made this night move
against Patsy. Was it an attempt to irritate the boys to some real act of
violence—something that would put them in fear of the law? Or was it
simply a stratagem to call off the night-guard so that they might slip
their cattle across into the breaks? They must have counted on some
disturbance which would reach the ears of the boys on guard. If Patsy had
not begun the bombardment with his old rifle, they would very likely have
fired a few shots themselves—enough to attract attention. With that
end in view, he could see why Patsy's shack had been chosen for the
attack. Patsy's shack was the closest to where they had been holding the
cattle. It was absurdly simple, and evidently the ruse had worked to
perfection.</p>
<p>“Where are the boys at now?” he asked abruptly, turning to Patsy who had
risen and knocked the ashes from his pipe and was slicing bacon.</p>
<p>“Gone after the cattle. Dey stampede alreatty mit all der noise,” Patsy
growled, with his back to Irish.</p>
<p>So it was just as Irish had suspected. He faced the west and the gathering
bank of “thunder heads” that rode swift on the wind and muttered sullenly
as they rode, and he hesitated. Should he go after the boys and help them
round up the stock and drive it back, or should he stay where he was and
watch the claims? There was that fence—he must see to that, too.</p>
<p>He turned and asked Patsy if all the boys were gone. But Patsy did not
know.</p>
<p>Irish stood in the doorway until breakfast was ready whereupon he sat down
and ate hurriedly—as much from habit as from any present need of
haste. A gust of wind made the flimsy cabin shake, and Patsy went to close
the door against its sudden fury.</p>
<p>“Some riders iss coming now,” he said, and held the door half closed
against the wind. “It ain't none off der boys,” he added, with the
certainty which came of his having watched, times without number, while
the various members of the Happy Family rode in from the far horizons to
camp. “Pilgrims, I guess—from der ridin'.”</p>
<p>Irish grunted and reached for the coffee pot, giving scarce a thought to
Patsy's announcement. While he poured his third cup of coffee he made a
sudden decision. He would get that fence off his mind, anyway.</p>
<p>“Say, Patsy, I've rustled wire and posts—all we'll need. I guess
I'll just turn this receipt over to you and let you get busy. You take the
team and drive in today and get the stuff headed out here pronto. The
nesters are shipping in more stock—I heard in town that they're
bringing in all they can rustle, thinkin' the stock will pay big money
while the claims are getting ready to produce. I heard a couple of marks
telling each other just how it was going to work out so as to put 'em all
on Easy Street—the darned chumps! Free grass—that's what they
harped on; feed don't cost anything. All yuh do is turn 'em loose and wait
till shippin' season, and then collect. That's what they were talking.</p>
<p>“The sooner that fence is up the better. We can't put in the whole summer
hazing their cattle around. I've bought the stuff and paid for it. And
here's forty dollars you can use to hire it hauled out here. Us fellows
have got to keep cases on the cattle, so you 'tend to this fence.” He laid
the money and Fred's receipt upon the table and set Patsy's plate over
them to hold them safe against the wind that rattled the shack. He had
forgotten all about the three approaching riders, until Patsy turned upon
him sharply.</p>
<p>“Vot schrapes you been into now?” he demanded querulously. “Py cosh you
done somet'ings. It's der conshtable comin' alreatty. I bet you be
pinched.”</p>
<p>“I bet I don't,” Irish retorted, and made for the one window, which looked
toward the hills. “Feed 'em some breakfast, Patsy. And you drive in and
tend to that fencing right away, like I told you.”</p>
<p>He threw one long leg over the window sill, bent his lean body to pass
through the square opening, and drew the other leg outside. He startled
his horse, which had walked around there out of the wind, but he caught
the bridle-reins and led him a few steps farther where he would be out of
the direct view from the window. Then he stopped and listened.</p>
<p>He heard the three ride up to the other side of the shack and shout to
Patsy. He heard Patsy moving about inside, and after a brief delay open
the door. He heard the constable ask Patsy if he knew anything about
Irish, and where he could be found; and he heard Patsy declare that he had
enough to do without keeping track of that boneheaded cowpuncher who was
good for nothing but to fight and get into schrapes.</p>
<p>After that he heard Patsy ask the constable if they had had any breakfast
before leaving town. He heard certain saddle-sounds which told of their
dismounting in response to the tacit invitation. And then, pulling his hat
firmly down upon his head, Irish led his horse quietly down into a hollow
behind the shack, and so out of sight and hearing of those three who
sought him.</p>
<p>He did not believe that he was wanted for anything very serious; they
meant to arrest him, probably, for laying out those two gamblers with a
chair and a bottle of whisky respectively. A trumped-up charge, very
likely, chiefly calculated to make him some trouble and to eliminate him
from the struggle for a time. Irish did not worry at all over their reason
for wanting him, but he did not intend to let them come close enough to
state their errand, because he did not want to become guilty of resisting
an officer—which would be much worse than fighting nesters with
fists and chairs and bottles and things.</p>
<p>In the hollow he mounted and rode down the depression and debouched upon
the wide, grassy coulee where lay a part of his own claim. He was not sure
of the intentions of that constable, but he took it for granted that he
would presently ride on to Irish's cabin in search of him; also that he
would look for him further, and possibly with a good deal of persistence;
which would be a nuisance and would in a measure hamper the movements and
therefore the usefulness of Irish. For that reason he was resolved to take
no chance that could be avoided.</p>
<p>The sun slid behind the scurrying forerunners of the storm and struggled
unavailingly to shine through upon the prairie land. From where he was
Irish could not see the full extent of the storm-clouds, and while he had
been on high land he had been too absorbed in other matters to pay much
attention. Even now he did no more than glance up casually at the inky
mass above him, and decided that he would do well to ride on to his cabin
and get his slicker.</p>
<p>By the time he reached his shack the storm was beating up against the wind
which had turned unexpectedly to the northeast. Mutterings of thunder grew
to sharper booming. It was the first real thunderstorm of the season, but
it was going to be a hard one, if looks meant anything. Irish went in and
got his slicker and put it on, and then hesitated over riding on in search
of the cattle and the men in pursuit of them.</p>
<p>Still, the constable might take a notion to ride over this way in spite of
the storm. And if he came there would be delay, even if there were nothing
worse. So Irish, being one to fight but never to stand idle, mounted again
and turned his long-suffering horse down the coulee as the storm swept up.</p>
<p>First a few large drops of rain pattered upon the earth and left blobs of
wet where they fell. His horse shook its head impatiently and went sidling
forward until an admonitory kick from Irish sent him straight down the dim
trail. Then the clouds opened recklessly the headgates and let the rain
down in one solid rush of water that sluiced the hillsides and drove muddy
torrents down channels that had been dry since the snow left.</p>
<p>Irish bent his head so that his hat shielded somewhat his face, and rode
doggedly on. It was not the first time that he had been out in a smashing,
driving thunderstorm, and it would not be his last if his life went on
logically as he had planned it. But it was not the more comfortable
because it was an oft-repeated experience. And when the first fury had
passed and still it rained steadily and with no promise of a let-up, his
optimism suffered appreciably.</p>
<p>His luck in town no longer cheered him. He began to feel the loss of sleep
and the bone-weariness of his fight and the long ride afterwards. His
breakfast was the one bright spot, and saved him from the gnawing
discomfort of an empty stomach—at first.</p>
<p>He went into One Man Coulee and followed it to the arm that would lead to
the rolling, ridgy open land beyond, where the “breaks” of the Badlands
reached out to meet the prairie. He came across the track of the herd, and
followed it to the plain. Once out in the open, however, the herd had
seemed to split into several small bunches, each going in a different
direction. Which puzzled Irish a little at first. Later, he thought he
understood.</p>
<p>The cattle, it would seem, had been driven purposefully into the edge of
the breaks and there made to scatter out through the winding gulches and
canyons that led deeper into the Badlands. It was the trick of range-men—he
could not believe that the strange settlers, ignorant of the country and
the conditions, would know enough to do this. He hesitated before several
possible routes, the rain pouring down upon him, a chill breeze driving it
into his face. If there had been hoofprints to show which way the boys had
gone, the rain had washed them so that they looked dim and old and gave
him little help.</p>
<p>He chose what seemed to him the gorge which the boys would be most likely
to follow—especially at night and if they were in open pursuit of
those who had driven the cattle off the benchland; and that the cattle had
been driven beyond this point was plain enough, for otherwise he would
have overtaken stragglers long before this.</p>
<p>It was nearing noon when he came out finally upon a little, open flat and
found there Big Medicine and Pink holding a bunch of perhaps a hundred
cattle which they had gleaned from the surrounding gulches and little
“draws” which led into the hills. The two were wet to the skin, and they
were chilled and hungry and as miserable as a she-bear sent up a tree by
yelping, yapping dogs.</p>
<p>Big Medicine it was who spied him first through the haze of falling water,
and galloped heavily toward him, his horse flinging off great pads of mud
from his feet as he came.</p>
<p>“Say!” he bellowed when he was yet a hundred yards away. “Got any grub
with yuh?”</p>
<p>“No!” Irish called back.</p>
<p>“Y'AIN'T” Big Medicine's voice was charged with incredulous reproach.
“What'n hell yuh doin' here without GRUB? Is Patsy comin' with the wagon?”</p>
<p>“No. I sent Patsy on in to town after—”</p>
<p>“Town? And us out here—” Big Medicine choked over his wrongs.</p>
<p>Irish waited until he could get in a word and then started to explain. But
Pink rode up with his hatbrim flapping soggily against one dripping cheek
when the wind caught it, and his coat buttoned wherever there were
buttons, and his collar turned up, and looking pinched and draggled and
wholly miserable.</p>
<p>“Say! Got anything to eat?” he shouted when he came near, his voice eager
and hopeful.</p>
<p>“No!” snapped Irish with the sting of Big Medicine's vituperations
rankling fresh in his soul.</p>
<p>“Well why ain't yuh? Where's Patsy?” Pink came closer and eyed the
newcomer truculently.</p>
<p>“How'n hell do I know?” Irish was getting a temper to match their own.</p>
<p>“Well, why don't yuh know? What do yuh think you're out here for? To tell
us you think it's going to rain? If we was all of us like you, there'd be
nothing to it for the nester-bunch. It's a wonder you come alive enough to
ride out this way at all! I don't reckon you've even got anything to
drink!” Pink paused a second, saw no move toward producing anything wet
and cheering, and swore disgustedly. “Of course not! You needed it all
yourself! So help me Josephine, if I was as low-down ornery as some I
could name I'd tie myself to a mule's tail and let him kick me to death!
Ain't got any grub! Ain't got—”</p>
<p>Irish interrupted him then with a sentence that stung. Irish, remember,
distinctly approved of himself and his actions. True, he had forgotten to
bring anything to eat with him, but there was excuse for that in the haste
with which he had left his own breakfast. Besides how could he be expected
to know that the cattle had been driven away down here, and scattered, and
that the Happy Family would not have overtaken them long before? Did they
think he was a mind-reader?</p>
<p>Pink, with biting sarcasm, retorted that they did not. That it took a mind
to read a mind. He added that, from the looks of Irish, he must have
started home drunk, anyway, and his horse had wandered this far of his own
accord. Then three or four cows started up a gulch to the right of them
and Pink, hurling insults over his shoulder, rode off to turn them back.
So they did not actually come to blows, those two, though they were near
it.</p>
<p>Big Medicine lingered to bawl unforgivable things at; Irish, and Irish
shouted back recklessly that they had all acted like a bunch of
sheepherders, or the cattle would never have been driven off the bench at
all. He declared that anybody with the brains of a sick sage hen would
have stopped the thing right in the start. He said other things also.</p>
<p>Big Medicine said things in reply, and Pink, returning to the scene with
his anger grown considerably hotter from feeding upon his discomfort, made
a few comments pertinent to the subject of Irish's shortcomings.</p>
<p>You may scarcely believe it, unless you have really lived, and have
learned how easily small irritations grow to the proportions of real
trouble, and how swiftly—but this is a fact: Irish and Big Medicine
became so enraged that they dismounted simultaneously and Irish jerked off
his slicker while Big Medicine was running up to smash him for some
needless insult.</p>
<p>They fought, there in the rain and the mud and the chill wind that whipped
their wet cheeks. They fought just as relentlessly as though they had long
been enemies, and just as senselessly as though they were not grown men
but schoolboys. They clinched and pounded and smashed until Pink sickened
at the sight and tore them apart and swore at them for crazy men and
implored them to have some sense. They let the cattle that had been
gathered with so much trouble drift away into the gulches and draws where
they must be routed out of the brush again, or perhaps lost for days in
that rough country.</p>
<p>When the first violence of their rage had like the storm settled to a cold
steadiness of animosity, the two remounted painfully and turned back upon
each other.</p>
<p>Big Medicine and Pink drew close together as against a common foe, and
Irish cursed them both and rode away—whither he did not know nor
care.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0015" id="link2HCH0015"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 15. THE KID HAS IDEAS OF HIS OWN </h2>
<p>The Old Man sat out in his big chair on the porch, smoking and staring
dully at the trail which led up the bluff by way of the Hog's Back to the
benchland beyond. Facing him in an old, cane rocking chair, the Honorable
Blake smoked with that air of leisurely enjoyment which belongs to the man
who knows and can afford to burn good tobacco and who has the sense to,
burn it consciously, realizing in every whiff its rich fragrance. The
Honorable Blake flicked a generous half-inch of ash from his cigar upon a
porch support and glanced shrewdly at the Old Man's abstracted face.</p>
<p>“No, it wouldn't do,” he observed with the accent of a second
consideration of a subject that coincides exactly with the first. “It
wouldn't do at all. You could save the boys time, I've no doubt—time
and trouble so far as getting the cattle back where they belong is
concerned. I can see how they must be hampered for lack of saddle-horses,
for instance. But—it wouldn't do, Whitmore. If they come to you and
ask for horses don't let them have them. They'll manage somehow—trust
them for that. They'll manage—” “But doggone it, Blake, it's for—”</p>
<p>“Sh-sh—” Blake held up a warning hand. “None of that, my dear
Whitmore! These young fellows have taken claims in—er—good
faith.” His bright blue eyes sparkled with a sudden feeling. “In the best
of good faith, if you ask me. I—admire them intensely for what they
have started out to do. But—they have certain things which they must
do, and do alone. If you would not thwart them in accomplishing what they
have set out to do, you must go carefully; which means that you must not
run to their aid with your camp-wagons and your saddle-horses, so they can
gather the cattle again and drive them back where they belong. You would
not be helping them. They would get the cattle a little easier and a
little quicker—and lose their claims.”</p>
<p>“But doggone it, Blake, them boys have lived right here at the Flying U—why,
this has been their home, yuh might say. They ain't like the general run
of punchers that roam around, workin' for this outfit and for that;
they've stuck. Why, doggone it, what they done here when I got hurt in
Chicago and they was left to run themselves, why, that alone puts me under
obligations to help 'em out in this scrape. Anybody could see that. Ain't
I a neighbor? Ain't neighbors got a right to jump in and help each other?
There ain't no law agin—”</p>
<p>“Not against neighbors—no.” Blake uncrossed his perfectly trousered
legs and crossed them the other way, after carefully avoiding any bagging
tendency. “But this syndicate—or these contestants—will try to
prove that you are not a neighbor only, but a—backer of the boys in
a land-grabbing scheme. To avoid—”</p>
<p>“Well, doggone your measly hide, Blake, I've told you fifty times I
ain't!” The Old Man sat forward in his chair and shook his fist unabashed
at his guest. “Them boys cooked that all up amongst themselves, and went
and filed on that land before ever I knowed a thing about it. How can yuh
set there and say I backed 'em? And that blonde Jezebel—riding down
here bold as brass and turnin' up her nose at Dell, and callin' me a
conspirator to my face!”</p>
<p>“I sticked a pin in her saddle blanket, Uncle Gee-gee. I'll bet she wished
she'd stayed away from here when her horse bucked her off.” The Kid looked
up from trying to tie a piece of paper to the end of a brindle kitten's
switching tail, and smiled his adorable smile—that had a gap in the
middle.</p>
<p>“Hey? You leave that cat alone or he'll scratch yuh. Blake, if you can't
see—”</p>
<p>“He! He's a her and her name's Adeline. Where's the boys, Uncle Gee-gee?”</p>
<p>“Hey? Oh, away down in the breaks after their cattle that got away. You
keep still and never mind where they've gone.” His mind swung back to the
Happy Family, combing the breaks for their stock and the stock of the
nesters, with an average of one saddle-horse apiece and a camp outfit of
the most primitive sort—if they had any at all, which he doubted.
The Old Man had eased too many roundups through that rough country not to
realize keenly the difficulties of the Happy Family.</p>
<p>“They need horses,” he groaned to Blake, “and they need help. If you
knowed the country and the work as well as I do you'd know they've got to
have horses and help. And there's their claims—fellers squatting
down on every eighty—four different nesters fer every doggoned one
of the bunch to handle! And you tell me I got to set here and not lift a
hand. You tell me I can't put men to work on that fence they want built.
You tell me I can't lend 'em so much as a horse!”</p>
<p>Blake nodded. “I tell you that, and I emphasize it,” he assured the other,
brushing off another half inch of ash from his cigar. “If you want to help
those boys hold their land, you must not move a finger.”</p>
<p>“He's wiggling all of 'em!” accused the Kid sternly, and pointed to the
Old Man drumming irritatedly upon his chair arms. “He don't want to help
the boys, but I do. I'll help 'em get their cattle, Mr. Blake. I'm one of
the bunch anyway. I'll lend 'em my string.”</p>
<p>“You've been told before not to butt in to grownup talk,” his uncle
reproved him irascibly. “Now you cut it out. And take that string off'n
that cat!” he added harshly. “Dell! Come and look after this kid! Doggone
it, a man can't talk five minutes—”</p>
<p>The Kid giggled irrepressibly. “That's one on you, old man. You saw Doctor
Dell go away a long time ago. Think she can hear yuh when she's away up on
the bench?”</p>
<p>“You go on off and play!” commanded the Old Man. “I dunno what yuh want to
pester a feller to death for—and say! Take that string off'n that
cat!”</p>
<p>“Aw gwan! It ain't hurting the cat. She likes it.” He lifted the kitten
and squeezed her till she yowled. “See? She said yes, she likes it.”</p>
<p>The Old Man returned to the trials of the Happy Family, and the Kid sat
and listened, with the brindle kitten snuggled uncomfortably, head
downward in his arms.</p>
<p>The Kid had heard a good deal, lately, about the trials of his beloved
“bunch.” About the “nesters” who brought cattle in to eat up the grass
that belonged to the cattle of the bunch. The Kid understood that
perfectly—since he had been raised in the atmosphere of range talk.
He had heard about the men building shacks on the claims of the Happy
Family—he understood that also; for he had seen the shacks himself,
and he had seen where there had been slid down hill into the bottom of
Antelope Coulee. He knew all about the attack on Patsy's cabin and how the
Happy Family had been fooled, and the cattle driven off and scattered. The
breaks—he was a bit hazy upon the subject of breaks. He had heard
about them all his life. The stock got amongst them and had to be hunted
out. He thought—as nearly as could be put in words—that it
must be a place where all the brakes grow that are used on wagons and
buggies. These were of wood, therefore they must grow somewhere. They grew
where the Happy Family went sometimes, when they were gone for days and
days after stock. They were down there now—it was down in the
breaks, always—and they couldn't round up their cattle because they
hadn't horses enough. They needed help, so they could hurry back and slide
those other shacks off their claims and into Antelope Coulee where they
had slid the others. On the whole, the Kid had a very fair conception of
the state of affairs. Claimants and contestants—those words went
over his head. But he knew perfectly well that the nesters were the men
that didn't like the Happy Family, and lived in shacks on the way to town,
and plowed big patches of prairie and had children that went barefooted in
the furrows and couldn't ride horses to save their lives. Pilgrim kids,
that didn't know what “chaps” were—he had talked with a few when he
went with Doctor Dell and Daddy Chip to see the sick lady.</p>
<p>After a while, when the Honorable Blake became the chief speaker and
leaned forward and tapped the Old Man frequently on a knee with his
finger, and used long words that carried no meaning, and said contestant
and claimant and evidence so often that he became tiresome, the Kid slid
off the porch and went away, his small face sober with deep meditations.</p>
<p>He would need some grub—maybe the bunch was hungry without any
camp-wagons. The Kid had stood around in the way, many's the time, and
watched certain members of the Happy Family stuff emergency rations into
flour sacks, and afterwards tie the sack to their saddles and ride off. He
knew all about that, too.</p>
<p>He hunted up a flour sack that had not had all the string pulled out of it
so it was no longer a sack but a dish-towel, and held it behind his back
while he went cautiously to the kitchen door. The Countess was nowhere in
sight—but it was just as well to make sure. The Kid went in, took a
basin off the table, held it high and deliberately dropped it on the
floor. It, made a loud bang, but it did not elicit any shrill protest from
the Countess; therefore the Countess was nowhere around. The Kid went in
boldly and filled his four-sack so full it dragged on the floor when he
started off.</p>
<p>At the door he went down the steps ahead of the sack, and bent his small
back from the third step and pulled the sack upon his shoulders. It
wobbled a good deal, and the Kid came near falling sidewise off the last
step before he could balance his burden. But he managed it, being the
child of his parents and having a good deal of persistence in his makeup;
and he went, by a roundabout way, to the stable with the grub-sack bending
him double. Still it was not so very heavy; it was made bulky by about two
dozen fresh-made doughnuts and a loaf of bread and a jar of honey and a
glass of wild-currant jelly and a pound or so of raw, dried prunes which
the Kid called nibblin's because he liked to nibble at them, like a
prairie dog at a grass root.</p>
<p>Getting that sack tied fast to the saddle after the saddle was on Silver's
back was no easy task for a boy who is six, even though he is large for
his age. Still, being Chip's Kid and the Little Doctor's he did it—with
the help of the oats box and Silver's patient disposition.</p>
<p>There were other things which the bunch always tied on their saddles; a
blanket, for instance, and a rope. The Kid made a trip to the bunk-house
and pulled a gray blanket off Ole's bed, and spent a quarter of an hour
rolling it as he had seen the boys roll blankets The oats box, with Silver
standing beside it, came in handy again. He found a discarded rope and
after much labor coiled it crudely and tied it beside the saddle-fork.</p>
<p>The Kid went to the door, stood beside it and leaned away over so that he
could peek out and not be seen Voices came from the house—the voice
of the Old Man; to be exact, high-pitched and combative. The Kid looked up
the bluff, and the trail lay empty in the afternoon sun. Still, he did not
like to take that trail. Doctor Dell might come riding down there almost
any minute. The Kid did not want to meet Doctor Dell just right then.</p>
<p>He went back, took Silver by the bridle reins and led him out of the barn
and around the corner where he could not be seen from the White House. He
thought he had better go down the creek, and out through the wire gate and
on down the creek that way. He was sure that the “breaks” were somewhere
beyond the end of the coulee, though he could not have explained why he
was sure of it. Perhaps the boys, in speaking of the breaks, had
unconsciously tilted heads in that direction.</p>
<p>The Kid went quickly down along the creek through the little pasture,
leading Silver by the reins. He was terribly afraid that his mother might
ride over the top of the hill and see him and call him back. If she did
that, he would have to go, of course. Deliberate, open disobedience had
never yet occurred to the Kid as a moral possibility. If your mother or
your Daddy Chip told you to come back, you had to come; therefore he did
not want to be told to come. Doctor Dell had told him that he could go on
roundup some day—the Kid had decided that this was the day, but that
it would be foolish to mention the decision to anyone. People had a way of
disagreeing with one's decisions—especially Doctor Dell, she always
said one was too little. The Kid thought he was getting pretty big, since
he could stand on something and put the saddle on Silver his own self, and
cinch it and everything; plenty big enough to get out and help the bunch
when they needed help.</p>
<p>He did not look so very big as he went trudging down alongside the creek,
stumbling now and then in the coarse grass that hid the scattered rocks.
He could not keep his head twisted around to look under Silver's neck and
watch the hill trail, and at the same time see where he was putting his
feet. And if he got on Silver now he would be seen and recognized at the
first glance which Doctor Dell would give to the coulee when she rode over
the brow of the hill. Walking beside Silver's shoulder, on the side
farthest from the bluff, he might not be seen at all; Doctor Dell might
look and think it was just a horse walking along the creek his own self.</p>
<p>The Kid was extremely anxious that he should not be seen. The bunch needed
him. Uncle Gee-gee said they needed help. The Kid thought they would
expect him to come and help with his “string”, He helped Daddy Chip drive
the horses up from the little pasture, these days; just yesterday he had
brought the whole bunch up, all by his own self, and had driven them into
the big corral alone, and Daddy Chip had stood by the gate and watched him
do it. Daddy Chip had lifted him down from Silver's back, and had squeezed
him hard, and had called him a real, old cowpuncher. The Kid got warm all
inside him when he, thought of it.</p>
<p>When a turn in the narrow creek-bottom hid him completely from the ranch
buildings and the hill trail, the Kid led Silver alongside a low bank,
climbed into the saddle. Then he made Silver lope all the way to the gate.</p>
<p>He had some trouble with that gate. It was a barbed wire gate, such as
bigger men than the Kid sometimes swear over. It went down all right, but
when he came to put it up again, that was another matter. He simply had to
put it up before he could go on. You always had to shut gates if you found
them shut—that was a law of the range which the Kid had learned so
long ago he could not remember when he had learned And there was another
reason—he did not want em to know he had passed that way, if they
took a notion to call him back. So he worked and he tugged and he grew so
red in the face it looked as if he were choking. But he got the gate up
and the wire loop over the stake—though he had to hunt up an old
piece of a post to stand on, and even then had to stand on his toes to
reach the loop—since he was Chip's Kid and the Little Doctor's.</p>
<p>He even remembered to scrape out the tell-tale prints of his small feet in
the bare earth there, and the prints of Silver's feet where he went
through. Yarns he had heard the Happy Family tell, in the bunk-house on
rainy days, had taught him these tricks. He was extremely thorough in all
that he did—being a good deal like his dad—and when he went
the grass, no one would have suspected that he had passed that way.</p>
<p>After a while he left that winding creek-bottom and climbed a long ridge.
Then he went down hill and pretty soon he climbed another hill that made
old Silver stop and rest before he went on to the top. The Kid stood on
the top for a few minutes and stared wistfully out over the tumbled mass
of hills, and deep hollows, and hills, and hill and hills—till he
could not see where they left off. He could not see any of the bunch; but
then, he could not see any brakes growing anywhere, either. The bunch was
down in the brakes—he had heard that often enough to get it fixed
firmly in his mind. Well, when he came to where the brakes grew—and
he would know them, all right, when he saw them!—he would find the
bunch. He thought they'd be s'prised to see him ride up! The bunch didn't
know that he could drive stock all his own self, and that he was a real,
old cowpuncher now. He was a lot bigger. He didn't have to hunt such a big
rock, or such a high bank, to get on Silver now. He thought he must be
pretty near as big as Pink, any way. They would certainly be s'prised!</p>
<p>The brakes must be farther over. Maybe he would have to go over on the
other side of that biggest hill before he came to the place where they
grew. He rode unafraid down a steep, rocky slope where Silver picked his
way very, very carefully, and sometimes stopped and smelt of a ledge or a
pile of rocks, and then turned and found some other way down.</p>
<p>The Kid let him choose his path—Daddy Chip had taught him to leave
the reins loose and let Silver cross ditches and rough places where he
wanted to cross. So Silver brought him safely down that hill where even
the Happy Family would have hesitated to ride unless the need was urgent.</p>
<p>He could not go right up over the next hill—there was a rock ledge
that was higher than his head when he sat on Silver. He went down a narrow
gulch—ah, an awfully narrow gulch! Sometimes he was afraid Silver
was too fat to squeeze through; but Silver always did squeeze through
somehow. And still there were no brakes growing anywhere. Just
choke-cherry trees, and service-berries, and now and then a little flat
filled with cottonwoods and willows—familiar trees and bushes that
he had known all his six years of life.</p>
<p>So the Kid went on and on, over hills or around hills or down along the
side of hill. But he did not find the Happy Family, and he did not find
the brakes. He found cattle that had the Flying U brand—they had a
comfortable, homey look. One bunch he drove down a wide coulee, hazing
them out of the brush and yelling “HY-AH!” at them, just the way the Happy
Family yelled. He thought maybe these were the cattle the Happy Family
were looking for; so he drove them ahead of him and didn't let one break
back on him and he was the happiest Kid in all Montana with these range
cattle, that had the Flying U brand, galloping awkwardly ahead of him down
that big coulee.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0016" id="link2HCH0016"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 16. “A RELL OLD COWPUNCHER” </h2>
<p>The hills began to look bigger, and kind of chilly and blue in the deep
places. The Kid wished that he could find some of the boys. He was
beginning to get hungry, and he had long ago begun to get tired. But he
was undismayed, even when he heard a coyote yap-yap-yapping up a brushy
canyon. It might be that he would have to camp out all night. The Kid had
loved those cowboy yarns where the teller—who was always the hero—had
been caught out somewhere and had been compelled to make a “dry camp.” His
favorite story of that type was the story of how Happy Jack had lost his
clothes and had to go naked through the breaks. It was not often that he
could make Happy Jack tell him that story—never when the other boys
were around. And there were other times; when Pink had got lost, down in
the breaks, and had found a cabin just—in—TIME, with Irish
sick inside and a blizzard just blowing outside, and they were mad at each
other and wouldn't talk, and all they had to eat was one weenty, teenty
snow-bird, till the yearling heifer came and Pink killed it and they had
beefsteak and got good friends again. And there were other times, that
others of the boys could tell about, and that the Kid thought about now
with pounding pulse. It was not all childish fear of the deepening shadows
that made his eyes big and round while he rode slowly on, farther and
farther into the breaks.</p>
<p>He still drove the cattle before him; rather, he followed where the cattle
led. He felt very big and very proud—but he did wish he could find
the Happy Family! Somebody ought to stand guard, and he was getting sleepy
already.</p>
<p>Silver stopped to drink at a little creek of clear, cold water. There was
grass, and over there was a little hollow under a rock ledge. The sky was
all purple and red, like Doctor Dell painted in pictures, and up the
coulee, where he had been a little while ago, it was looking kind of dark.
The Kid thought maybe he had better camp here till morning. He reined
Silver against a bank and slid off, and stood looking around him at the
strange hills with the huge, black boulders that looked like houses unless
you knew, and the white cliffs that looked—queer—unless you
knew they were just cliffs.</p>
<p>For the first time since he started, the Kid wished guiltily that his dad
was here or—he did wish the bunch would happen along! He wondered if
they weren't camped, maybe, around that point. Maybe they would hear him
if he hollered as loud as he could, which he did, two or three times; and
quit because the hills hollered back at him and they wouldn't stop for the
longest time—it was just like people yelling at him from behind
these rocks.</p>
<p>The Kid knew, of course, who they were; they were Echo-boys, and they
wouldn't hurt, and they wouldn't let you see them. They just ran away and
hollered from some other place. There was an Echo-boy lived up on the
bluff somewhere above the house. You could go down in the little pasture
and holler, and the Echo-boy would holler back The Kid was not afraid—but
there seemed to be an awful lot of Echo-boys down in these hills. They
were quiet after a minute or so, and he did not call again.</p>
<p>The Kid was six, and he was big for his age; but he looked very little,
there alone in that deep coulee that was really more like a canyon—very
little and lonesome and as if he needed his Doctor Dell to take him on her
lap and rock him. It was just about the time of day when Doctor Dell
always rocked him and told him stories—about the Happy Family,
maybe. The Kid hated to be suspected of baby ways, but he loved these
tunes, when his legs were tired and his eyes wanted to go shut, and Doctor
Dell laid her cheek on his hair and called him her baby man. Nobody knew
about these times—that was most always in the bed room and the boys
couldn't hear.</p>
<p>The Kid's lips quivered a little. Doctor Dell would be surprised when he
didn't show up for supper, he guessed. He turned to Silver and to his man
ways, because he did not like to think about Doctor Dell just right now.</p>
<p>“Well, old feller, I guess you want your saddle off, huh?” he quavered,
and slapped the horse upon the shoulder. He lifted the stirrup—it
was a little stock saddle, with everything just like a big saddle except
the size; Daddy Chip had had it made for the Kid in Cheyenne, last
Christmas—and began to undo the latigo, whistling self-consciously
and finding that his lips kept trying to come unpuckered all the time, and
trying to tremble just the way they did when he cried. He had no intention
of crying.</p>
<p>“Gee! I always wanted to camp out and watch the stars,” he told Silver
stoutly. “Honest to gran'ma, I think this is just—simply—GREAT!
I bet them nester kids would be scared. Hunh!”</p>
<p>That helped a lot. The Kid could whistle better after that. He pulled of
the saddle, laid it down on its side so that the skirts would not bend out
of shape—oh, he had been well-taught, with the whole Happy Family
for his worshipful tutors!—and untied the rope from beside the fork.
“I'll have to anchor you to a tree, old-timer,” he told the horse briskly.
“I'd sure hate to be set afoot in this man's country!” And a minute later—“Oh,
funder! I never brought you any sugar!”</p>
<p>Would you believe it, that small child of the Flying U picketed his horse
where the grass was best, and the knots he tied were the knots his dad
would have tied in his place. He unrolled his blanket and carried it to
the sheltered little nook under the ledge, and dragged the bag of
doughnuts and the jelly and honey and bread after it. He had heard about
thievish animals that will carry off bacon and flour and such. He knew
that he ought to hang his grub in a tree, but he could not reach up as far
as the fox who might try to help himself, so that was out of the question.</p>
<p>The Kid ate a doughnut while he studied the matter out for himself. “If a
coyote or a skink came pestering around ME, I'd frow rocks at him,” he
said. So when he had finished the doughnut he collected a pile of rocks.
He ate another doughnut, went over and laid himself down on his stomach
the way the boys did, and drank from the little creek. It was just a
chance that he had not come upon water tainted with alkali—but fate
is kind sometimes.</p>
<p>So the Kid, trying very, very hard to act just like his Daddy Chip and the
boys, flopped the blanket vigorously this way and that in an effort to get
it straightened, flopped himself on his knees and folded the blanket round
and round him until he looked like a large, gray cocoon, and cuddled
himself under the ledge with his head on the bag of doughnuts and his wide
eyes fixed upon the first pale stars and his mind clinging sturdily to his
mission and to this first real, man-sized adventure that had come into his
small life.</p>
<p>It was very big and very empty—that canyon. He lifted his yellow
head and looked to see if Silver were there, and was comforted at the
sight of his vague bulk close by, and by the steady KR-UP, KR-UP of bitten
grasses.</p>
<p>“I'm a rell ole cowpuncher, all right,” he told himself bravely; but he
had to blink his eyelashes pretty fast when he said it. A “rell ole
cowpuncher” wouldn't cry! He was afraid Doctor Dell would be AWFULLY
s'prised, though...</p>
<p>An unexpected sob broke loose, and another. He wasn't afraid—but...
Silver, cropping steadily at the grass which must be his only supper,
turned and came slowly toward the Kid in his search for sweeter
grass-tufts. The Kid choked off the third sob and sat up ashamed. He
tugged at the bag and made believe to Silver that his sole trouble was
with his pillow.</p>
<p>“By cripes, that damn' jelly glass digs right into my ear,” he complained
aloud, to help along the deception. “You go back, old-timer—I'm all
right. I'm a—rell—ole cowpuncher; ain't I, old-timer? We're
makin' a dry-camp, just like—Happy Jack. I'm a rell—ole—”
The Kid went to sleep before he finished saying it. There is nothing like
the open air to make one sleep from dusk till dawn. The rell ole
cowpuncher forgot his little white bed in the corner of the big bedroom.
He forgot that Doctor Dell would be awfully s'prised, and that Daddy Chip
would maybe be cross—Daddy Chip was cross, sometimes. The rell ole
cowpuncher lay with his yellow curls pillowed on the bag of doughnuts and
the gray blanket wrapped tightly around him, and slept soundly; and his
lips were curved in the half smile that came often to his sleeping place
and made him look ever so much like his Daddy Chip.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0017" id="link2HCH0017"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 17. “LOST CHILD” </h2>
<p>“Djuh find 'im?” The Old Man had limped down to the big gate and stood
there bare headed under the stars, waiting, hoping—fearing to hear
the answer.</p>
<p>“Hasn't he showed up yet?” Chip and the Little Doctor rode out of the
gloom and stopped before the gate. Chip did not wait for an answer. One
question answered the other and there was no need for more. “I brought
Dell home,” he said. “She's about all in—and he's just as likely to
come back himself as we are to run across him. Silver'll bring him home,
all right. He can't be—yuh can't lose a horse. You go up to the
house and lie down, Dell. I—the Kid's all right.”</p>
<p>His voice held all the tenderness of the lover, and all the protectiveness
of the husband and all the agony of a father—but Chip managed to
keep it firm and even for all that. He lifted the Little Doctor bodily
from the saddle, held her very close in his arms for a minute, kissed her
twice and pushed her gently through the gate.</p>
<p>“You better stay right here,” he said authoritatively, “and rest and look
after J.G. You can't do any good riding—and you don't want to be
gone when he comes.” He reached over the gate, got hold of her arm and
pulled her towards him. “Buck up, old girl,” he whispered, and kissed her
lingeringly. “Now's the time to show the stuff you're made of. You needn't
worry one minute about that kid. He's the goods, all right. Yuh couldn't
lose him if you tried. Go up and go to bed.”</p>
<p>“Go to bed!” echoed the Little Doctor and sardonically. “J.G., are you
sure he didn't say anything about going anywhere?”</p>
<p>“No. He was settin' there on the porch tormenting the cat.” The Old Man
swallowed a lump. “I told him to quit. He set there a while after that—I
was talkin'' to Blake. I dunno where he went to. I was—”</p>
<p>“'S that you, Dell? Did yuh find 'im?” The Countess came flapping down the
path in a faded, red kimono. “What under the shinin' sun's went with him,
do yuh s'pose? Yuh never know what a day's got up its sleeve—'n I
always said it. Man plans and God displans—the poor little tad'll be
scairt plumb to death, out all alone in the dark—”</p>
<p>“Oh, for heaven's sake shut up!” cried the tortured Little Doctor, and
fled past her up the path as though she had some hope of running away from
the tormenting thoughts also. “Poor little tad, all alone in the dark,”—the
words followed her and were like sword thrusts through the mother heart of
her. Then Chip overtook her, knowing too well the hurt which the Countess
had given with her blundering anxiety. Just at the porch he caught up with
her, and she clung to him, sobbing wildly.</p>
<p>“You don't want to mind what that old hen says,” he told her brusquely.
“She's got to do just so much cackling or she'd choke, I reckon. The Kid's
all right. Some of the boys have run across him by this time, most likely,
and are bringing him in. He'll be good and hungry, and the scare will do
him good.” He forced himself to speak as though the Kid had merely fallen
on the corral fence, or something like that. “You've got to make up your
mind to these things,” he argued, “if you tackle raising a boy, Dell. Why,
I'll bet I ran off and scared my folks into fits fifty times when I was a
kid.”</p>
<p>“But—he's—just a baby!” sobbed the Little Doctor with her face
pressed hard against Chip's strong, comforting shoulder.</p>
<p>“He's a little devil!” amended Chip fiercely. “He ought to be walloped for
scaring you like this. He's just as capable of looking after himself as
most kids twice his size. He'll get hungry and head for home—and if
he don't know the way, Silver does; so he can't—”</p>
<p>“But he may have fallen and—”</p>
<p>“Come, now! Haven't you got any more sense than the Countess? If you
insist of thinking up horrors to scare yourself with, I don't know as
anybody can stop you. Dell! Brace up and quit worrying. I tell you—he's—all
right!”</p>
<p>That did well enough—seeing the Little Doctor did not get a look at
Chip's face, which was white and drawn, with sunken, haggard eyes staring
into the dark over her head. He kissed her hastily and told her he must
go, and that he'd hurry back as soon as he could. So he went half running
down the path and passed the Countess and the Old Man without a word;
piled onto his horse and went off up the hill road again.</p>
<p>They could not get it out of their minds that the Kid must have ridden up
on the bluff to meet his mother, had been too early to meet her—for
the Little Doctor had come home rather later than she expected to do—and
had wandered off to visit the boys, perhaps, or to meet his Daddy Chip who
was over there some where on the bench trying to figure out a system of
ditches that might logically be expected to water the desert claims of the
Happy Family—if they could get the water.</p>
<p>They firmly believed that the kid had gone up on the hill, and so they
hunted for him up there. The Honorable Blake had gone to Dry Lake and
taken the train for Great Falls, before ever the Kid had been really
missed. The Old Man had not seen the Kid ride up the hill—but he had
been sitting with his chair turned away from the road, and he was worried
about other things and so might easily have missed seeing him. The
Countess had been taking a nap, and she was not expected to know anything
about his departure. And she had not looked into the doughnut jar—indeed,
she was so upset by supper time that, had she looked, she would not have
missed the doughnuts. For the same reason Ole did not miss his blanket.
Ole had not been near his bed; he was out riding and searching and calling
through the coulee and up toward the old Denson place.</p>
<p>No one dreamed that the Kid had started out with a camp-outfit—if
one might call it that—and with the intention of joining the Happy
Family in the breaks, and of helping them gather their cattle. How could
they dream that? How could they realize that a child who still liked to be
told bedtime stories and to be rocked to sleep, should harbor such
man-size thoughts and ambitions? How could they know that the Kid was
being “a rell ole cowpuncher”?</p>
<p>That night the whole Happy Family, just returned from the Badlands and
warned by Chip at dusk that the Kid was missing, hunted the coulees that
bordered the benchland. A few of the nesters who had horses and could ride
them hunted also. The men who worked at the Flying U hunted, and Chip
hunted frantically. Chip just about worshipped that kid, and in spite of
his calmness and his optimism when he talked to the Little Doctor, you can
imagine the state of mind he was in.</p>
<p>At sunrise they straggled in to the ranch, caught up fresh horses,
swallowed a cup of coffee and what food they could choke down and started
out again. At nine o'clock a party came out from Dry Lake, learned that
the Kid was not yet found, and went out under a captain to comb
systematically through the hills and the coulees.</p>
<p>Before night all the able-bodied men in the country and some who were not—were
searching. It is astonishing how quickly a small army will volunteer in
such an emergency; and it doesn't seem to matter very much that the
country seems big and empty of people ordinarily. They come from
somewhere, when they're needed.</p>
<p>The Little Doctor—oh, let us not talk about the Little Doctor. Such
agonies as she suffered go too deep for words.</p>
<p>The next day after that, Chip saddled a horse and let her ride beside him.
Chip was afraid to leave her at the ranch—afraid that she would go
mad. So he let her ride—they rode together. They did not go far from
the ranch. There was always the fear that someone might bring him in while
they were gone. That fear drove them back, every hour or two. Then another
fear would drive them forth again.</p>
<p>Up in another county there is a creek called Lost Child Creek. A child was
lost—or was it two children?—and men hunted and hunted and
hunted, and it was months before anything was found. Then a cowboy riding
that way found—just bones. Chip knew about that creek which is
called Lost Child. He had been there and he had heard the story, and he
had seen the—father and had shuddered—and that was long before
he had known the feeling a father has for his child. What he was deadly
afraid of now was that the Little Doctor would hear about that creek, and
how it had gotten its name.</p>
<p>What he dreaded most for himself was to think of that creek. He kept the
Little Doctor beside him and away from that Job's comforter, the Countess,
and tried to keep her hope alive while the hours dragged their leaden feet
over the hearts of them all.</p>
<p>A camp was hastily organized in One Man Coulee and another out beyond
Denson's place, and men went there to the camps for a little food and a
little rest, when they could hold out no longer. Chip and the Little
Doctor rode from camp to camp, intercepted every party of searchers they
glimpsed on the horizon, and came back to the ranch, hollow-eyed and
silent for the most part. They would rest an hour, perhaps. Then they
would ride out again.</p>
<p>The Happy Family seemed never to think of eating, never to want sleep. Two
days—three days—four days—the days became a nightmare.
Irish, with a warrant out for his arrest, rode with the constable, perhaps—if
the search chanced to lead them together. Or with Big Medicine, whom he
had left in hot anger. H. J. Owens and these other claim-jumpers hunted
with the Happy Family and apparently gave not a thought to claims.</p>
<p>Miss Allen started out on the second day and hunted through all the
coulees and gulches in the neighborhood of her claim—coulees and
gulches that had been searched frantically two or three times before. She
had no time to make whimsical speeches to Andy Green, nor he to listen.
When they met, each asked the other for news, and separated without a
thought for each other. The Kid—they must find him—they must.</p>
<p>The third day, Miss Allen put up a lunch, told her three claim partners
that she should not come back until night unless that poor child was
found, and that they need not look for her before dark and set out with
the twinkle all gone from her humorous brown eyes and her mouth very
determined.</p>
<p>She met Pink and the Native Son and was struck with the change which two
days of killing anxiety had made in them. True, they had not slept for
forty-eight hours, except an hour or two after they had been forced to
stop and eat. True, they had not eaten except in snatches. But it was not
that alone which made their faces look haggard and old and haunted. They,
too, were thinking of Lost Child Creek and How it had gotten its name.</p>
<p>Miss Allen gleaned a little information from them regarding the general
whereabouts of the various searching parties. And then, having learned
that the foothills of the mountains were being searched minutely because
the Kid might have taken a notion to visit Meeker's; and that the country
around Wolf Butte was being searched, because he had once told Big
Medicine that when he got bigger and his dad would let him, he was going
over there and kill wolves to make Doctor Dell some rugs: and that the
country toward the river was being searched because the Kid always wanted
to see where the Happy Family drove the sheep to, that time when Happy
Jack got shot under the arm; that all the places the Kid had seemed most
interested in were being searched minutely—if it could be possible
to; search minutely a country the size of that! Having learned all that,
Miss Allen struck off by herself, straight down into the Badlands where
nobody seemed to have done much searching.</p>
<p>The reason for that was, that the Happy Family had come out of the breaks
on the day that the Kid was lost. They had not ridden together, but in
twos and threes because they drove out several small bunches of cattle
that they had gleaned, to a common centre in One Man Coulee. They had
traveled by the most feasible routes through that rough country, and they
had seen no sign of the Kid or any other rider.</p>
<p>They did not believe that he had come over that far, or even in that
direction; because a horseman would almost certainly have been sighted by
some of them in crossing a ridge somewhere.</p>
<p>It never occurred to anyone that the Kid might go down Flying U Creek and
so into the breaks and the Badlands. Flying U Creek was fenced, and the
wire gate was in its place—Chip had looked down along there, the
first night, and had found the gate up just as it always was kept. Why
should he suspect that the Kid had managed to open that gate and to close
it after him? A little fellow like that?</p>
<p>So the searching parties, having no clue to that one incident which would
at least have sent them in the right direction, kept to the outlying
fringe of gulches which led into the broken edge of the benchland, and to
the country west and north and south of these gulches. At that, there was
enough broken country to keep them busy for several days, even when you
consider the number of searchers.</p>
<p>Miss Allen did not want to go tagging along with some party. She did not
feel as if she could do any good that way, and she wanted to do some good.
She wanted to find that poor little fellow and take him to his mother. She
had met his mother, just the day before, and had ridden with her for
several miles. The look in the Little Doctor's eyes haunted Miss Allen
until she felt sometimes as if she must scream curses to the heavens for
so torturing a mother. And that was not all; she had looked into Chip's
face, last night—and she had gone home and cried until she could cry
no more, just with the pity of it.</p>
<p>She left the more open valley and rode down a long, twisting canyon that
was lined with cliffs so that it was impossible to climb out with a horse.
She was sure she could not get lost or turned around, in a place like
that, and it seemed to her as hopeful a place to search as any. When you
came to that, they all had to ride at random and trust to luck, for there
was not the faintest clue to guide them. So Miss Allen considered that she
could do no better than search all the patches of brush in the canyon, and
keep on going.</p>
<p>The canyon ended abruptly in a little flat, which she crossed. She had not
seen the tracks of any horse going down, but when she was almost across
the flat she discovered tracks of cattle, and now and then the print of a
shod hoof. Miss Allen began to pride herself on her astuteness in reading
these signs. They meant that some of the Happy Family had driven cattle
this way; which meant that they would have seen little Claude Bennett—that
was the Kid's real name, which no one except perfect strangers ever used—they
would have seen the Kid or his tracks, if he had ridden down here.</p>
<p>Miss Allen, then, must look farther than this. She hesitated before three
or four feasible outlets to the little flat, and chose the one farthest to
the right. That carried her farther south, and deeper into a maze of
gulches and gorges and small, hidden valleys. She did not stop, but she
began to see that it was going to be pure chance, or the guiding hand of a
tender Providence, if one ever did find anybody in this horrible jumble.
She had never seen such a mess. She believed that poor little tot had come
down in here, after all; she could not see why, but then you seldom did
know why children took a notion to do certain unbelievable things. Miss
Allen had taught the primary grade in a city school, and she knew a little
about small boys and girls and the big ideas they sometimes harbored.</p>
<p>She rode and rode, trying to put herself mentally in the Kid's place.
Trying to pick up the thread of logical thought—children were
logical sometimes—startlingly so.</p>
<p>“I wonder,” she thought suddenly, “if he started out with the idea of
hunting cattle! I wouldn't be a bit surprised if he did—living on a
cattle ranch, and probably knowing that the men were down here somewhere.”
Miss Allen, you see, came pretty close to the truth with her guess.</p>
<p>Still, that did not help her find the Kid. She saw a high, bald peak
standing up at the mouth of the gorge down which she was at that time
picking her way, and she made up her mind to climb that peak and see if
she might not find him by looking from that point of vantage. So she rode
to the foot of the pinnacle, tied her horse to a bush and began to climb.</p>
<p>Peaks like that are very deceptive in their height Miss Allen was slim and
her lungs were perfect, and she climbed steadily and as fast as she dared.
For all that it took her a long while to reach the top—much longer
than she expected. When she reached the black rock that looked, from the
bottom, like the highest point of the hill, she found that she had not
gone much more than two-thirds of the way up, and that the real peak
sloped back so that it could not be seen from below at all.</p>
<p>Miss Allen was a persistent young woman. She kept climbing until she did
finally reach the highest point, and could look down into gorges and flats
and tiny basins and canyons and upon peaks and ridges and worm-like
windings, and patches of timber and patches of grass and patches of barren
earth and patches of rocks all jumbled up together—. Miss Allen
gasped from something more than the climb, and sat down upon a rock,
stricken with a sudden, overpowering weakness. “God in heaven!” she
whispered, appalled. “What a place to get lost in!”</p>
<p>She sat there a while and stared dejectedly down upon that wild orgy of
the earth's upheaval which is the Badlands. She felt as though it was
sheer madness even to think of finding anybody in there. It was worse than
a mountain country, because in the mountains there is a certain semblance
of some system in the canyons and high ridges and peaks. Here every thing—peaks,
gorges, tiny valleys and all—seemed to be just dumped down together.
Peaks rose from the middle of canyons; canyons were half the time blind
pockets that ended abruptly against a cliff.</p>
<p>“Oh!” she cried aloud, jumpin up and gesticulating wildly. “Baby! Little
Claude! Here! Look up this way!” She saw him, down below, on the opposite
side from where she had left her horse.</p>
<p>The Kid was riding slowly up a gorge. Silver was picking his way carefully
over the rocks—they looked tiny, down there! And they were not going
toward home, by any means. They were headed directly away from home.</p>
<p>The cheeks of Miss Allen were wet while she shouted and called and waved
her hands. He was alive, anyway. Oh, if his mother could only be told that
he was alive! Oh, why weren't there telephones or something where they
were needed! If his poor mother could see him!</p>
<p>Miss Allen called again, and the Kid heard her. She was sure that he heard
her, because he stopped—that pitiful, tiny speck down there on the
horse!—and she thought he looked up at her. Yes, she was sure he
heard her, and that finally he saw her; because he took off his hat and
waved it over his head—just like a man, the poor baby!</p>
<p>Miss Allen considered going straight down to him, and then walking around
to where her horse was tied. She was afraid to leave him while she went
for the horse and rode around to where he was. She was afraid she might
miss him somehow the Badlands had stamped that fear deep into her soul.</p>
<p>“Wait!” she shouted, her hands cupped around her trembling lips, tears
rolling down her cheeks “Wait baby! I'm coming for you.” She hoped that
the Kid heard what she said, but she could not be sure, for she did not
hear him reply. But he did not go on at once, and she thought he would
wait.</p>
<p>Miss Allen picked up her skirts away from her ankles and started running
down the steep slope. The Kid, away down below, stared up at her. She went
down a third of the way, and stopped just in time to save herself from
going over a sheer wall of rocks—stopped because a rock which she
dislodged with her foot rolled down the slope a few feet, gave a leap into
space and disappeared.</p>
<p>A step at a time Miss Allen crept down to where the rock had bounced off
into nothingness, and gave one look and crouched close to the earth. A
hundred feet, it must be, straight down. After the first shock she looked
to the right and the left and saw that she must go back, and down upon the
other side.</p>
<p>Away down there at the bottom, the Kid sat still on his horse and stared
up at her. And Miss Allen calling to him that she would come, started back
up to the peak.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0018" id="link2HCH0018"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 18. THE LONG WAY ROUND </h2>
<p>Miss Allen turned to yell encouragingly to the Kid, and she saw that he
was going on slowly, his head turned to watch her. She told him to wait
where he was, and she would come around the mountain and get him and take
him home. “Do you hear me, baby?” she asked imploringly after she had told
him just what she meant to do. “Answer me, baby!”</p>
<p>“I ain't a baby!” his voice came faintly shrill after a minute. “I'm a
rell ole cowpuncher.”</p>
<p>Miss Allen thought that was what he said, but at the time she did not
quite understand, except his denial of being a baby; that was clear
enough. She turned to the climb, feeling that she must hurry if she
expected to get him and take him home before dark. She knew that every
minute was precious and must not be wasted. It was well after noon—she
had forgotten to eat her lunch, but her watch said it was nearly one
o'clock already. She had no idea how far she had ridden, but she thought
it must be twelve miles at least.</p>
<p>She had no idea, either, how far she had run down the butte to the cliff—until
she began to climb back. Every rod or so she stopped to rest and to look
back and to call to the Kid who seemed such a tiny mite of humanity among
these huge peaks and fearsome gorges. He seemed to be watching her very
closely always when she looked she could see the pink blur of his little
upturned face. She must hurry. Oh, if she could only send a wireless to
his mother! Human inventions fell far short of the big needs, after all,
she thought as she toiled upward.</p>
<p>From the top of the peak she could see the hazy outline of the Bear Paws,
and she knew just about where the Flying U Coulee lay. She imagined that
she could distinguish the line of its bluff in the far distance. It was
not so very far—but she could not get any word of cheer across the
quivering air lanes. She turned and looked wishfully down at the Kid, a
tinier speck now than before—for she had climbed quite a distance
She waved her hand to him, and her warm brown eyes held a maternal
tenderness. He waved his hat—just like a man; he must be brave! she
thought. She turned reluctantly and went hurrying down the other side, her
blood racing with the joy of having found him, and of knowing that he was
safe.</p>
<p>It seemed to take a long time to climb down that peak; much longer than
she thought it would take. She looked at her watch nervously—two
o'clock, almost! She must hurry, or they would be in the dark getting
home. That did not worry her very much, However, for there would be
searching parties—she would be sure to strike one somewhere in the
hills before dark.</p>
<p>She came finally down to the level—except that it was not level at
all, but a trough-shaped gulch that looked unfamiliar. Still, it was the
same one she had used as a starting point when she began to climb—of
course it was the same one. How in the world could a person get turned
around going straight up the side of a hill and straight down again in the
very same place. This was the gorge where her horse was tied, only it
might be that she was a little below the exact spot; that could happen, of
course. So Miss Allen went up the gorge until it petered out against the
face of the mountain—one might as well call it a mountain and be
done with it, for it certainly was more than a mere hill.</p>
<p>It was some time before Miss Allen would admit to herself that she had
missed the gorge where she had left her horse, and that she did not know
where the gorge was, and that she did not know where she was herself. She
had gone down the mouth of the gulch before she made any admissions, and
she had seen not one solitary thing that she could remember having ever
seen before.</p>
<p>Not even the peak she had climbed looked familiar from where she was. She
was not perfectly sure that it was the same peak when she looked at it.</p>
<p>Were you ever lost? It is a very peculiar sensation—the feeling that
you are adrift in a world that is strange. Miss Allen had never been lost
before in her life. If she had been, she would have been more careful, and
would have made sure that she was descending that peak by the exact route
she had followed up it, instead of just taking it for granted that all she
need do was get to the bottom.</p>
<p>After an hour or two she decided to climb the peak again, get her bearings
from the top and come down more carefully. She was wild with apprehension—though
I must say it was not for her own plight but on account of the Kid. So she
climbed. And then everything looked so different that she believed she had
climbed another hill entirely. So she went down again and turned into a
gorge which seemed to lead in the direction where she had seen the little
lost boy. She followed that quite a long way—and that one petered
out like the first.</p>
<p>Miss Allen found the gorges filling up with shadow, and she looked up and
saw the sky crimson and gold, and she knew then without any doubts that
she was lost. Miss Allen was a brave young woman, or she would not have
been down in that country in the first place; but just the same she sat
down with her back against a clay bank and cried because of the eeriness
and the silence, and because she was hungry and she knew she was going to
be cold before morning—but mostly because she could not find that
poor, brave little baby boy who had waved his hat when she left him, and
shouted that he was not a baby.</p>
<p>In a few minutes she pulled herself together and went on; there was
nothing to be gained by sitting in one place and worrying. She walked
until it was too dark to see, and then, because she had come upon a
little, level canyon bottom—though one that was perfectly strange—she
stopped there where a high bank sheltered her from the wind that was too
cool for comfort. She called, a few times, until she was sure that the
child was not within hearing. After that she repeated poetry to keep her
mind off the loneliness and the pity of that poor baby alone like herself.
She would not think of him if she could help it.</p>
<p>When she began to shiver so that her teeth chattered, she would walk up
and down before the bank until she felt warm again; then she would sit
with her back against the clay and close her eyes and try to sleep. It was
not a pleasant way in which to pass a whole night, but Miss Allen endured
it as best she could. When the sun tinged the hill-tops she got up stiffly
and dragged herself out of the canyon where she could get the direction
straight in her mind, and then set off resolutely to find the Kid. She no
longer had much thought of finding her horse, though she missed him
terribly, and wished she had the lunch that was tied to the saddle.</p>
<p>This, remember, was the fourth day since the Kid rode down through the
little pasture and stood on a piece of fence-post so that he could fasten
the gate. Men had given up hope of finding him alive and unharmed. They
searched now for his body. And then the three women who lived with Miss
Allen began to inquire about the girl, and so the warning went out that
Miss Allen was lost; and they began looking for her also.</p>
<p>Miss Allen, along towards noon of that fourth day, found a small stream of
water that was fit to drink. Beside the stream she found the footprints of
a child, and they looked quite fresh—as if they had been made that
day. She whipped up her flagging energy and went on hopefully.</p>
<p>It was a long while afterwards that she met him coming down a canyon on
his horse. It must have been past three o'clock, and Miss Allen could
scarcely drag herself along. When she saw him she turned faint, and sat
down heavily on the steep-sloping bank.</p>
<p>The Kid rode up and stopped beside her. His face was terribly dirty and
streaked with the marks of tears he would never acknowledge afterwards. He
seemed to be all right, though, and because of his ignorance of the danger
he had been in he did not seem to have suffered half as much as had Miss
Allen.</p>
<p>“Howdy do,” he greeted her, and smiled his adorable little smile that was
like the Little Doctor's. “Are you the lady up on the hill? Do you know
where the bunch is? I'm—lookin' for the bunch.”</p>
<p>Miss Allen found strength enough to stand up and put her arms around him
as he sat very straight in his little stock saddle; she hugged him tight.</p>
<p>“You poor baby!” she cried, and her eyes were blurred with tears. “You
poor little lost baby!”</p>
<p>“I ain't a baby!” The Kid pulled himself free. “I'm six years old goin' on
thirty. I'm a rell ole cowpuncher. I can slap a saddle on my string and
ride like a son-a-gun. And I can put the bridle on him my own self and
everything. I—I was lookin' for the bunch. I had to make a dry-camp
and my doughnuts is smashed up and the jelly glass broke but I never cried
when a skink came. I shooed him away and I never cried once. I'm a rell
ole cowpuncher, ain't I? I ain't afraid of skinks. I frowed a rock at him
and I said, git outa here, you damn old skink or I'll knock your block
off!' You oughter seen him go! I—I sure made him hard to ketch, by
cripes!”</p>
<p>Miss Allen stepped back and the twinkle came into her eyes and the
whimsical twist to her lips. She knew children. Not for the world would
she offend this manchild.</p>
<p>“Well, I should say you are a real old cowpuncher!” she exclaimed
admiringly. “Now I'm afraid of skinks. I never would dare knock his block
off! And last night when I was lost and hungry and it got dark, I—cried!”</p>
<p>“Hunh!” The Kid studied her with a condescending pity. “Oh, well—you're
just a woman. Us fellers have to take care of women. Daddy Chip takes care
of Doctor Dell—I guess she'd cry if she couldn't find the bunch and
had to make dry-camp and skinks come around—but I never.”</p>
<p>“Of course you never!” Miss Allen agreed emphatically, trying not to look
conscious of any tear-marks on the Kid's sunburned cheeks. “Women are
regular cry babies, aren't they? I suppose,” she added guilefully: “I'd
cry again if you rode off to find the bunch an left me down here all
alone. I've lost my horse, an I've lost my lunch, and I've lost myself,
and I'm awful afraid of skunks—skinks.”</p>
<p>“Oh, I'll take care of you,” the Kid comforted. “I'll give you a doughnut
if you're hungry. I've got some left, but you'll have to pick out the
glass where the jelly broke on it.” He reined closer to the bank and slid
off and began untying the sadly depleted bag from behind the cantle. Miss
Allen offered to do it for him, and was beautifully snubbed. The Kid may
have been just a frightened, lost little boy before he met her—but
that was a secret hidden in the silences of the deep canyons. Now he was a
real old cowpuncher, and he was going to take care of Miss Allen because
men always had to take care of women.</p>
<p>Miss Allen offended him deeply when she called him Claude. She was told
bluntly that he was Buck, and that he belonged to the Flying U outfit, and
was riding down here to help the bunch gather some cattle. “But I can't
find the brakes,” he admitted grudgingly. “That's where the bunch is—down
in the brakes; I can't seem to locate them brakes.”</p>
<p>“Don't you think you ought to go home to your mother?” Miss Allen asked
him while he was struggling with the knot he had tied in the bag.</p>
<p>“I've got to find the bunch. The bunch needs me,” said the Kid. “I—I
guess Doctor Dell is s'prised—”</p>
<p>“Who's Doctor Dell? Your mother? Your mother has just about cried herself
sick, she's so lonesome without you.”</p>
<p>The Kid looked at her wide-eyed. “Aw, gwan!” he retorted after a minute,
imitating Happy Jack's disbelief of any unpleasant news. “I guess you're
jest loadin' me. Daddy Chip is takin' care of her. He wouldn't let her be
lonesome.”</p>
<p>The Kid got the sack open and reached an arm in to the shoulder. He groped
there for a minute and drew out a battered doughnut smeared liberally with
wild currant jelly, and gave it to Miss Allen with an air of princely
generosity and all the chivalry of all the Happy Family rolled into one
baby gesture. Miss Allen took the doughnut meekly and did not spoil the
Kid's pleasure by hugging him as she would have liked to do. Instead she
said: “Thank you, Buck of the Flying U,” quite humbly. Then something
choked Miss Allen and she turned her back upon him abruptly.</p>
<p>“I've got one, two, free, fourteen left,” said the Kid, counting them
gravely. “If I had 'membered to bring matches,” he added regretfully, “I
could have a fire and toast rabbit legs. I guess you got some glass,
didn't you? I got some and it cutted my tongue so the bleed came—but
I never cried,” he made haste to deny stoutly. “I'm a rell ole cowpuncher
now. I just cussed.” He looked at her gravely. “You can't cuss where women
can hear,” he told Miss Allen reassuringly. “Bud says—”</p>
<p>“Let me see the doughnuts,” said miss Allen abruptly. “I think you ought
to let me keep the lunch. That's the woman's part. Men can't bother with
lunch—”</p>
<p>“It ain't lunch, it's grub,” corrected the Kid. But he let her have the
bag, and Miss Allen looked inside. There were some dried prunes that
looked like lumps of dirty dough, and six dilapidated doughnuts in a mess
of jelly, and a small glass jar of honey.</p>
<p>“I couldn't get the cover off,” the Kid explained, “'theut I busted it,
and then it would all spill like the jelly. Gee I-I wish I had a beefsteak
under my belt!”</p>
<p>Miss Allen leaned over with her elbows on the bank and laughed and
laughed. Miss Allen was closer to hysterics than she had ever been in her
life. The Kid looked at her in astonishment and turned to Silver, standing
with drooping head beside the bank. Miss Allen pulled herself together and
asked him what he was going to do.</p>
<p>“I'm going to LOCATE your horse,” he said, “and then I'm going to take you
home.” He looked at her disapprovingly. “I don't like you so very much,”
he added. “It ain't p'lite to laugh at a feller all the time.”</p>
<p>“I won't laugh any more. I think we had better go home right away,” said
Miss Allen contritely. “You see, Buck, the bunch came home. They—they
aren't hunting cattle now. They want to find you and tell you. And your
father and mother need you awfully bad, Buck. They've been looking all
over for you, everywhere, and wishing you'd come home.”</p>
<p>Buck looked wistfully up and down the canyon. His face at that moment was
not the face of a real old cowpuncher, but the sweet, dirty, mother-hungry
face of a child. “It's a far ways,” he said plaintively. “It's a million
miles, I guess I wanted to go home, but I couldn't des' 'zactly 'member—and
I thought I could find the bunch, and they'd know the trail better. Do you
know the trail?”</p>
<p>Miss Allen evaded that question and the Kid's wide, wistful eyes. “I think
if we start out, Buck, we can find it. We must go toward the sun, now.
That will be towards home. Shall I put you on your horse?”</p>
<p>The Kid gave her a withering glance and squirmed up into the saddle with
the help of both horn and cantle and by the grace of good luck. Miss Allen
gasped while she watched him.</p>
<p>The Kid looked down at her triumphantly. He frowned a little and flushed
guiltily when he remembered something. “'Scuse me,” he said. “I guess you
better ride my horse. I guess I better walk. It ain't p'lite for ladies to
walk and men ride.”</p>
<p>“No, no!” Miss Allen reached up with both hands and held the Kid from
dismounting. “I'll walk, Buck. I'd rather. I—why, I wouldn't dare
ride that horse of yours. I'd be afraid he might buck me off.” She pinched
her eyebrows together and pursed up her lips in a most convincing manner.</p>
<p>“Hunh!” Scorn of her cowardice was in his tone. “Well, a course I ain't
scared to ride him.”</p>
<p>So with Miss Allen walking close to the Kid's stirrup and trying her best
to keep up and to be cheerful and to remember that she must not treat him
like a little, lost boy but like a real old cowpuncher, they started up
the canyon toward the sun which hung low above a dark, pine-covered hill.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0019" id="link2HCH0019"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 19. HER NAME WAS ROSEMARY </h2>
<p>Andy Green came in from a twenty-hour ride through the Wolf Butte country
and learned that another disaster had followed on the heels of the first;
that miss Allen had been missing for thirty-six hours. While he bolted
what food was handiest in the camp where old Patsy cooked for the
searchers, and the horse wrangler brought up the saddle-bunch just as
though it was a roundup that held here its headquarters, he heard all that
Slim and Cal Emmett could tell him about the disappearance of Miss Allen.</p>
<p>One fact stood significantly in the foreground, and that was that Pink and
the Native Son had been the last to speak with her, so far as anyone knew.
That was it—so far as anyone knew. Andy's lips tightened. There were
many strangers riding through the country, and where there are many
strangers there is also a certain element of danger. That Miss Allen was
lost was not the greatest fear that drove Andy Green forth without sleep
and with food enough to last him a day or two.</p>
<p>First he meant to hunt up Pink and Miguel—which was easy enough,
since they rode into camp exhausted and disheartened while he was saddling
a fresh horse. From them he learned the direction which Miss Allen had
taken when she left them, and he rode that way and never stopped until he
had gone down off the benchland and had left the fringe of coulees and
canyons behind. Pink and the Native Son had just come from down in here,
and they had seen no sign of either her or the Kid. Andy intended to begin
where they had left off, and comb the breaks as carefully as it is
possible for one man to do. He was beginning to think that the Badlands
held the secret of the Kid disappearance, even though they had seen
nothing of him when they came out four days ago. Had he seen Chip he would
have urged him to send all the searchers—and there were two or three
hundred by now—into the Badlands and keep them there until the Kid
was found. But he did not see Chip and had no time to hunt him up. And
having managed to evade the supervision of any captain, and to keep clear
of all parties, he meant to go alone and see if he could find a clue, at
least.</p>
<p>It was down in the long canyon which Miss Allen had followed, that Andy
found hoof-prints which he recognized. The horse Miss Allen had ridden
whenever he saw her—one which she had bought somewhere north of town—had
one front foot which turned in toward the other. “Pigeon-toed,” he would
have called it. The track it left in soft soil was unmistakable. Andy's
face brightened when he saw it and knew that he was on her trail. The rest
of the way down the canyon he rode alertly, for though he knew she might
be miles from there by now, to find the route she had taken into the
Badlands was something gained.</p>
<p>The flat, which Andy knew very well—having driven the bunch of
cattle whose footprints had so elated Miss Allen—he crossed
uneasily. There were so many outlets to this rich little valley. He tried
several of them, which took time; and always when he came to soft earth
and saw no track of the hoof that turned in toward the other, he would go
back and ride into another gulch. And when you are told that these were
many, and that much of the ground was rocky, and some was covered with a
thick mat of grass, you will not be surprised that when Andy finally took
up her trail in the canyon farthest to the right, it was well towards
noon. He followed her easily enough until he came to the next valley,
which he examined over and over before he found where she had left it to
push deeper into the Badlands. And it was the same experience repeated
when he came out of that gulch into another open space.</p>
<p>He came into a network of gorges that would puzzle almost anyone, and
stopped to water his horse and let him feed for an hour or so. A man's
horse meant a good deal to him, down here on such a mission, and even his
anxiety could not betray him into letting his mount become too fagged.</p>
<p>After a while he mounted and rode on without having any clue to follow;
one must trust to chance, to a certain extent, in a place like this. He
had not seen any sign of the Kid, either, and the gorges were filling with
shadows that told How low the sun was sliding down the sky. At that time
he was not more than a mile or so from the canyon up which Miss Allen was
toiling afoot toward the sun; but Andy had no means of knowing that. He
went on with drooping head and eyes that stared achingly here and there.
That was the worst of his discomfort—his eyes. Lack of sleep and the
strain of looking, looking, against wind and sun, had made them red-rimmed
and bloodshot. Miss Allen's eyes were like that, and so were the eyes of
all the searchers.</p>
<p>In spite of himself Andy's eyes closed now. He had not slept for two
nights, and he had been riding all that time. Before he realized it he was
asleep in the saddle, and his horse was carrying him into a gulch that had
no outlet—there were so many such!—but came up against a hill
and stopped there. The shadows deepened, and the sky above was red and
gold.</p>
<p>Andy woke with a jerk, his horse having stopped because he could go no
farther. But it was not that which woke him. He listened. He would have
sworn that he had heard the shrill, anxious whinney of a horse not far
away. He turned and examined the gulch, but it was narrow and grassy and
had no possible place of concealment, and save himself and his own horse
it was empty. And it was not his own horse that whinnied—he was sure
of that. Also, he was sure that he had-not dreamed it. A horse had called
insistently. Andy knew horses too well not to know that there was anxiety
and rebellion in that call.</p>
<p>He waited a minute, his heart beating heavily. He turned and started back
down the gulch, and then stopped suddenly. He heard it again—shrill,
prolonged, a call from somewhere; where, he could not determine because of
the piled masses of earth and rock that flung the sound riotously here and
there and confused him as to direction.</p>
<p>Then his own horse turned his head and looked toward the left, and
answered the call. From far off the strange horse made shrill reply. Andy
got down and began climbing the left-hand ridge on the run, tired as he
was. Not many horses ranged down in here—and he did not believe,
anyway, that this was any range horse. It did not sound like Silver, but
it might be the pigeon-toed horse of Miss Allen. And if it was, then Miss
Allen would be there. He took a deep breath and went up the last steep
pitch in a spurt of speed that surprised himself.</p>
<p>At the top he stood panting and searched the canyon below him. Just across
the canyon was the high peak which Miss Allen had climbed afoot. But down
below him he saw her horse circling about in a trampled place under a
young cottonwood.</p>
<p>You would never accuse Andy Green of being weak, or of having unsteady
nerves, I hope.</p>
<p>But it is the truth that he felt his knees give way while he looked; and
it was a minute or two before he had any voice with which to call to her.
Then he shouted, and the great hill opposite flung back the echoes
maddeningly.</p>
<p>He started running down the ridge, and brought up in the canyon's bottom
near the horse. It was growing shadowy now to the top of the lower ridges,
although the sun shone faintly on the crest of the peak. The horse
whinnied and circled restively when Andy came near. Andy needed no more
than a glance to tell him that the horse had stood tied there for
twenty-four hours, at the very least. That meant....</p>
<p>Andy turned pale. He shouted, and the canyon mocked him with echoes. He
looked for her tracks. At the base of the peak he saw the print of her
riding boots; farther along, up the slope he saw the track again. Miss
Allen, then, must have climbed the peak, and he knew why she had done so.
But why had she not come down again?</p>
<p>There was only one way to find out, and he took the method in the face of
his weariness. He climbed the peak also, with now and then a footprint to
guide him. He was not one of these geniuses at trailing who could tell, by
a mere footprint, what had been in Miss Allen's mind when she had passed
that way; but for all that it seemed logical that she had gone up there to
see if she could not glimpse the kid—or possibly the way home.</p>
<p>At the top he did not loiter. He saw, before he reached the height, where
Miss Allen had come down again—and he saw where she had, to avoid a
clump of boulders and a broken ledge, gone too far to one side. He
followed that way. She had descended at an angle, after that, which took
her away from the canyon.</p>
<p>In Montana there is more of daylight after the sun has gone than there is
in some other places. Andy, by hurrying, managed to trail Miss Allen to
the bottom of the peak before it grew really dusky. He knew that she had
been completely lost when she reached the bottom, and had probably
wandered about at random since then. At any rate, there were no tracks
anywhere save her own, so that he felt less anxiety over her safety than,
when he had started out looking for her.</p>
<p>Andy knew these breaks pretty well. He went over a rocky ridge, which Miss
Allen had not tried to cross because to her it seemed exactly in the
opposite direction from where she had started, and so he came to her horse
again. He untied the poor beast and searched for a possible trail over the
ridge to where his own horse waited; and by the time he had found one and
had forced the horse to climb to the top and then descend into the gulch,
the darkness lay heavy upon the hills.</p>
<p>He picketed Miss Allen's horse with his rope', and fashioned a hobble for
his own mount. Then he ate a little of the food he carried and sat down to
rest and smoke and consider how best he could find Miss Allen or the Kid—or
both. He believed Miss Allen to be somewhere not far away—since she
was afoot, and had left her lunch tied to the saddle. She could not travel
far without food.</p>
<p>After a little he climbed back up the ridge to where he had noticed a
patch of brush, and there he started a fire. Not a very large one, but
large enough to be seen for a long distance where the vision was not
blocked by intervening hills. Then he sat down beside it and waited and
listened and tended the fire. It was all that he could do for the present,
and it seemed pitifully little. If she saw the fire, he believed that she
would come; if she did not see it, there was no hope of his finding her in
the dark. Had there been fuel on the high peak, he might have gone up
there to start his fire; but that was out of the question, since the peak
was barren.</p>
<p>Heavy-eyed, tired in every fibre of his being, Andy dragged up a dead
buck-bush and laid the butt of it across his blaze. Then he lay down near
it—and went to sleep as quickly as if he had been chloroformed.</p>
<p>It may have been an hour after that—it may have been more. He sat up
suddenly and listened. Through the stupor of his sleep he had heard Miss
Allen call. At least, he believed he had heard her call, though he knew he
might easily have dreamed it. He knew he had been asleep, because the fire
had eaten part of the way to the branches of the bush and had died down to
smoking embers. He kicked the branch upon the coals and a blaze shot up
into the night. He stood up and walked a little distance away from the
fire so that he could see better, and stood staring down into the canyon.</p>
<p>From below he heard a faint call—he was sure of it. The wonder to
him was that he had heard it at all in his sleep. His anxiety must have
been strong enough even then to send the signal to his brain and rouse
him.</p>
<p>He shouted, and again he heard a faint call. It seemed to be far down the
canyon. He started running that way.</p>
<p>The next time he shouted, she answered him more clearly. And farther along
he distinctly heard and recognized her voice. You may be sure he ran,
after that!</p>
<p>After all, it was not so very far, to a man who is running recklessly down
hill. Before he realized how close he was he saw her standing before him
in the starlight. Andy did not stop. He kept right on running until he
could catch her in his arms; and when he had her there he held her close
and then he kissed her. That was not proper, of course—but a man
does sometimes do terribly improper things under the stress of big
emotions; Andy had been haunted by the fear that she was dead.</p>
<p>Well, Miss Allen was just as improper as he was, for that matter. She did
say “Oh!” in a breathless kind of way, and then she must have known who he
was. There surely could be no other excuse for the way she clung to him
and without the faintest resistance let him kiss her.</p>
<p>“Oh, I've found him!” she whispered after the first terribly
unconventional greetings were over. “I've found him, Mr. Green. I couldn't
come up to the fire, because he's asleep and I couldn't carry him, and I
wouldn't wake him unless I had to. He's just down here—I was afraid
to go very far, for fear of losing him again. Oh, Mr. Green! I—”</p>
<p>“My name is Andy,” he told her. “What's your name?”</p>
<p>“Mine? It's—well, it's Rosemary. Never mind now. I should think
you'd be just wild to see that poor little fellow—he's a brick,
though.”</p>
<p>“I've been wild,” said Andy, “over a good many things—you, for one.
Where's the Kid?”</p>
<p>They went together, hand in hand—terribly silly, wasn't it?—to
where the Kid lay wrapped in the gray blanket in the shelter of a bank.
Andy struck a match and held it so that he could see the Kid face—and
Miss Allen, looking at the man whose wooing had been so abrupt, saw his
mouth tremble and his lashes glisten as he stared down while the
match-blaze lasted.</p>
<p>“Poor little tad—he's sure a great Kid,” he said huskily when the
match went out. He stood up and put his arm around Miss Allen just as
though that was his habit. “And it was you that found him!” he murmured
with his face against hers. “And I've found you both, thank God.”</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0020" id="link2HCH0020"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 20. THE RELL OLE COWPUNCHER GOES HOME </h2>
<p>I don't suppose anything can equal the aplomb of a child that has always
had his own way and has developed normally. The Kid, for instance, had
been wandering in the wild places—this was the morning of the sixth
day. The whole of Northern Montana waited anxiously for news of him. The
ranch had been turned into a rendezvous for searchers. Men rode as long as
they could sit in the saddle. Women were hysterical in the affection they
lavished upon their own young. And yet, the Kid himself opened his eyes to
the sun and his mind was untroubled save where his immediate needs were
concerned. He sat up thinking of breakfast, and he spied Andy Green humped
on his knees over a heap of camp-fire coals, toasting rabbit-hams—the
joy of it—on a forked stick. Opposite him Miss Allen crouched and
held another rabbit-leg on a forked stick. The Kid sat up as if a spring
had been suddenly released, and threw off the gray blanket.</p>
<p>“Say, I want to do that too!” he cried. “Get me a stick, Andy, so I can do
it. I never did and I want to!”</p>
<p>Andy grabbed him as he came up and kissed him—and the Kid wondered
at the tremble of Andy's arms. He wondered also at the unusual caress; but
it was very nice to have Andy's arms around him and Andy's cheek against
his, and of a sudden the baby of him came to the surface.</p>
<p>“I want my Daddy Chip!” he whimpered, and laid his head down on Andy's
shoulder. “And I want my Doctor Dell and my—cat! She's lonesome for
me. And I forgot to take the string off her tail and maybe it ain't
comfortable any more!”</p>
<p>“We're going to hit the trail, old-timer, just as soon as we get outside
of a little grub.” Andy's voice was so tender that Miss Allen gulped back
a sob of sympathy. “You take this stick and finish roasting the meat, and
then see what you think of rabbit-hams. I hear you've been a real old
cowpuncher, Buck. The way you took care of Miss Allen proves you're the
goods, all right. Not quite so close, or you'll burn it, Buck. That's
better. I'll go get another stick and roast the back.”</p>
<p>The Kid, squatting on his heels by the fire, watched gravely the
rabbit-leg on the two prongs of the willow stick he held. He glanced
across at Miss Allen and smiled his Little Doctor smile.</p>
<p>“He's my pal,” he announced. “I bet if I stayed we could round up all them
cattle our own selves. And I bet he can find your horse, too. He—he's
'customed to this country. I'd a found your horse today, all right—but
I guess Andy could find him quicker. Us punchers'll take care of you, all
right.” The rabbit-leg sagged to the coals and began to scorch, and the
Kid lifted it startled and was grateful when Miss Allen did not seem to
have seen the accident.</p>
<p>“I'd a killed a rabbit for you,” he explained, “only I didn't have no gun
or no matches so I couldn't. When I'm ten my Daddy Chip is going to give
me a gun. And then if you get lost I can take care of you like Andy can.
I'll be ten next week, I guess.” He turned as Andy came back slicing off
the branches of a willow the size of his thumb.</p>
<p>“Say, old-timer, where's the rest of the bunch?” he inquired casually.
“Did you git your cattle rounded up?”</p>
<p>“Not yet.” Andy sharpened the prongs of his stick and carefully impaled
the back of the rabbit.</p>
<p>“Well, I'll help you out. But I guess I better go home first—I guess
Doctor Dell might need me, maybe.”</p>
<p>“I know she does, Buck.” Andy's voice had a peculiar, shaky sound that the
Kid did not understand. “She needs you right bad. We'll hit the high
places right away quick.”</p>
<p>Since Andy had gone at daybreak and brought the horses over into this
canyon, his statement was a literal one. They ate hurriedly and started—and
Miss Allen insisted that Andy was all turned around, and that they were
going in exactly the wrong direction, and blushed and was silent when
Andy, turning his face full toward her, made a kissing motion with his
lips.</p>
<p>“You quit that!” the Kid commanded him sharply. “She's my girl I guess I
found her first 'fore you did, and you ain't goin' to kiss her.”</p>
<p>After that there was no lovemaking but the most decorous conversation
between these two.</p>
<p>Flying U Coulee lay deserted under the warm sunlight of early forenoon.
Deserted, and silent with the silence that tells where Death has stopped
with his sickle. Even the Kid seemed to feel a strangeness in the
atmosphere—a stillness that made his face sober while he looked
around the little pasture and up at the hill trail. In all the way home
they had not met anyone—but that may have been because Andy chose
the way up Flying U Creek as being shorter and therefore more desirable.</p>
<p>At the lower line fence of the little pasture Andy refused to believe the
Kid's assertion of having opened and shut the gate, until the Kid got down
and proved that he could open it—the shutting process being too slow
for Andy's raw nerves. He lifted the Kid into the saddle and shut the gate
himself, and led the way up the creek at a fast trot.</p>
<p>“I guess Doctor Dell will be glad to see me,” the Kid observed wistfully.
“I've been gone most a year, I guess.”</p>
<p>Neither Andy nor Miss Allen made any reply to this. Their eyes were
searching the hilltop for riders, that they might signal. But there was no
one in sight anywhere.</p>
<p>“Hadn't you better shout?” suggested Miss Allen. “Or would it be better to
go quietly—”</p>
<p>Andy did not reply; nor did he shout. Andy, at that moment, was fighting a
dryness in his throat. He could not have called out if he had wanted to.
They rode to the stable and stopped. Andy lifted the Kid down and set him
on his two feet by the stable door while he turned to Miss Allen. For once
in his life he was at a loss. He did not know how best to bring the Kid to
the Little Doctor; How best to lighten the shock of seeing safe and well
the manchild who she thought was dead. He hesitated. Perhaps he should
have ridden on to the house with him. Perhaps he should have fired the
signal when first he came into the coulee. Perhaps...</p>
<p>The Kid himself swept aside Andy's uncertainties. Adeline, the cat, came
out of the stable and looked at them contemplatively. Adeline still had
the string tied to her tail, and a wisp of paper tied to the string. The
Kid pounced and caught her by the middle.</p>
<p>“I guess I can tie knots so they stay, by cripes!” he shouted
vaingloriously. “I guess Happy Jack can't tie strings any better 'n me,
can he? Nice kitty—c'm back here, you son-a-gun!”</p>
<p>Adeline had not worried over the absence of the Kid, but his hilarious
arrival seemed to worry her considerably. She went bounding up the path to
the house, and after her went the Kid, yelling epithets which were a bit
shocking for one of his age.</p>
<p>So he came to the porch just when Chip and the Little Doctor reached it,
white-faced and trembling. Adeline paused to squeeze under the steps, and
the Kid catching her by the tail, dragged her back yowling. While his
astounded parents watched him unbelievingly, the Kid gripped Adeline
firmly and started up the steps.</p>
<p>“I ketched the son-a-gun!” he cried jubilantly.</p>
<p>“Say, I seen a skink, Daddy Chip, and I frowed a rock and knocked his
block off 'cause he was going to swipe my grub. Was you s'prised, Doctor
Dell?”</p>
<p>Doctor Dell did not say. Doctor Dell was kneeling on the porch floor with
the Kid held closer in her arms than ever he held the cat, and she was
crying and laughing and kissing him all at once—though nobody except
a mother can perform that feat.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0021" id="link2HCH0021"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 21. THE FIGHT GOES ON </h2>
<p>It is amazing how quickly life swings back to the normal after even so
harrowing an experience as had come to the Flying U. Tragedy had hovered
there a while and had turned away with a smile, and the smile was
reflected upon the faces and in the eyes of everyone upon whose souls had
fallen her shadow. The Kid was safe, and he was well, and he had not
suffered from the experience; on the contrary he spent most of his waking
hours in recounting his adventures to an admiring audience. He was a real
old cowpuncher. He had gone into the wilderness and he had proven the
stuff that was in him. He had made “dry-camp” just exactly as well as any
of the Happy Family could have done. He had slept out under the stars
rolled in a blanket—and do you think for one minute that he would
ever submit to lace-trimmed nighties again? If you do, ask the little
Doctor what the Kid said on the first night after his return, when she
essayed to robe him in spotless white and rock him, held tight in her
starved arms. Or you might ask his Daddy Chip, who hovered pretty close to
them both, his eyes betraying how his soul gave thanks. Or—never
mind, I'll tell you myself.</p>
<p>The Little Doctor brought the nightie, and reached out her two eager arms
to take the kid off Chip's knees where he was perched contentedly relating
his adventures with sundry hair-raising additions born of his imagination.
The Kid was telling Daddy Chip about the skunk he saw, and he hated to be
interrupted. He looked at his Doctor Dell and at the familiar, white
garment with lace at the neck and wristbands, and he waved his hand with a
gesture of dismissal.</p>
<p>“Aw, take that damn' thing away!” he told her in the tone of the real old
cowpuncher. “When I get ready to hit the bed-ground, a blanket is all I'll
need.”</p>
<p>Lest you should think him less lovable than he really was, I must add
that, when Chip set him down hastily so that he himself could rush off
somewhere and laugh in secret, the Kid spread his arms with a little
chuckle and rushed straight at his Doctor Dell and gave her a real bear
hug.</p>
<p>“I want to be rocked,” he told her—and was her own baby man again,
except that he absolutely refused to reconsider the nightgown. “And I want
you to tell me a story—about when Silver breaked his leg. Silver's a
good ole scout, you bet. I don't know what I'd a done 'theut Silver. And
tell about the bunch makin' a man outa straw to scare you, and the horses
runned away. I was such a far ways, Doctor Dell, and I couldn't get back
to hear them stories and I've most forgot about 'em. And tell about
Whizzer, Doctor Dell.”</p>
<p>The Little Doctor rocked him and told him of the old days, and she never
again brought him his lace-trimmed nightie at bedtime. She never mentioned
his language upon the subject, either. The Little Doctor was learning some
things about her man-child, and one of them was this: When he rode away
into the Badlands and was lost, other things were lost, and lost
permanently; he was no longer her baby, for all he liked to be rocked. He
had come back to her changed, so that she studied him amazedly while she
worshipped. He had entered boldly into the life which men live, and he
would never come back entirely to the old order of things. He would never
be her baby; there would be a difference, even while she held him in her
arms and him rocked him to sleep.</p>
<p>She knew that it was so, when the Kid insisted, next day, upon going home
with the bunch; with Andy, rather, who was just now the Kid's particular
hero. He had to help the bunch he said; they needed him, and Andy needed
him and Miss Allen needed him.</p>
<p>“Aw, you needn't be scared, Doctor Dell,” he told her shrewdly. “I ain't
going to find them brakes any more. I'll stick with the bunch, cross my
heart, and I'll come back tonight if you're scared 'theut me. Honest to
gran'ma, I've got to go and help the bunch lick the stuffen' outa them
nesters, Doctor Dell.”</p>
<p>The Little Doctor looked at him strangely, hugged him tight—and let
him go. Chip would be with them, and he would bring the Kid home safely,
and—the limitations of dooryard play no longer sufficed; her
fledgling had found what his wings were for, and the nest was too little,
now.</p>
<p>“We'll take care of him,” Andy promised her understandingly. “If Chip
don't come up, this afternoon, I'll bring him home myself. Don't you worry
a minute about him.”</p>
<p>“I'd tell a man she needn't!” added the Kid patronizingly.</p>
<p>“I suppose he's a lot safer with you boys than he is here at the ranch—unless
one of us stood over him all the time, or we tied him up,” she told Andy
gamely. “I feel like a hen trying to raise a duck! Go on, Buck—but
give mother a kiss first.”</p>
<p>The Kid kissed her violently and with a haste that betrayed where his
thoughts were, in spite of the fact that never before had his mother
called him Buck.</p>
<p>To her it was a supreme surrender of his babyhood—to him it was
merely his due. The Little Doctor sighed and watched him ride away beside
Andy. “Children are such self-centred little beasts!” she told J. G.
rue-fully. “I almost wish he was a girl.”</p>
<p>“Ay? If he was a girl he wouldn't git lost, maybe, but some feller'd take
him away from yuh just the same. The Kid's all right. He's just the kind
you expect him to be and want him to be. You're tickled to death because
he's like he is. Doggone it, Dell, that Kid's got the real stuff in him!
He's a dead ringer fer his dad—that ought to do yuh.”</p>
<p>“It does,” the Little Doctor declared. “But it does seem as if he might be
contented here with me for a little while—after such a horrible time—”</p>
<p>“It wasn't horrible to him, yuh want to recollect. Doggone it, I wish that
Blake would come back. You write to him, Dell, and tell him how things is
stacking up. He oughta be here on the ground. No tellin' what them
nesters'll build up next.”</p>
<p>So the Old Man slipped back into the old channels of worry and thought,
just as life itself slips back after a stressful period. The little Doctor
sighed again and sat down to write the letter and to discuss with the Old
Man what she should say.</p>
<p>There was a good deal to say. For one thing, more contests had been filed
and more shacks built upon claims belonging to the Happy Family. She must
tell Blake that. Also, Blake must help make some arrangement whereby the
Happy Family could hire an outfit to gather their stock and the alien
stock which they meant to drive back out of the Badlands. And there was
Irish, who had quietly taken to the hills again as soon as the Kid
returned. Blake was needed to look into that particular bit of trouble and
try and discover just how serious it was. The man whom Irish had floored
with a chair was apparently hovering close to death—and there were
these who emphasized the adverb and asserted that the hurt was only
apparent, but could prove nothing.</p>
<p>“And you tell 'im,” directed the Old Man querulously, “that I'll stand
good for his time while he's lookin' after things for the boys. And tell
'im if he's so doggoned scared I'll buy into the game, he needn't to show
up here at the ranch at all; tell him to stay in Dry Lake if he wants to—serve
him right to stop at that hotel fer a while. But tell him for the Lord's
sake git a move on. The way it looks to me, things is piling up on them
boys till they can't hardly see over the top, and something's got to be
done. Tell 'im—here! Give me a sheet of paper and a pencil and I'll
tell him a few things myself. Chances are you'd smooth 'em out too much,
gitting 'em on paper. And the things I've got to say to Blake don't want
any smoothing.”</p>
<p>The things he wrote painfully with his rheumatic hand were not smoothed
for politeness' sake, and it made the Old Man feel better to get them off
his mind. He read the letter over three times, and lingered over the most
scathing sentences relishfully. He sent one of his new men to town for the
express purpose of mailing that letter, and he felt a glow of satisfaction
at actually speaking his mind upon the subject.</p>
<p>Perhaps it was just as well he did not know that Blake was in Dry Lake
when the letter reached his office in Helena, and that it was forwarded to
the place whence it had started. Blake was already “getting a move on,”
and he needed no such spur as the Old Man's letter. But the letter did the
Old Man a lot of good, so that it served its purpose.</p>
<p>Blake had no intention of handling the case from the Flying U porch, for
instance. He had laid his plans quite independently of the Flying U
outfit. He had no intention of letting Irish be arrested upon a trumped up
charge, and he managed to send a word of warning to that hot-headed young
man not to put himself in the way of any groping arm of the law; it was so
much simpler than arrest and preliminary trial and bail, and all that. He
had sent word to Weary to come and see him, before ever he received the
Old Man's letter, and he had placed at Weary's disposal what funds would
be needed for the immediate plans of the Happy Family. He had attended in
person to the hauling of the fence material to their boundary line on the
day he arrived and discovered by sheer accident that the stuff was still
in the warehouse of the general store.</p>
<p>After he did all that, the Honorable Blake received the Old Man's letter,
read it through slowly and afterwards stroked down his Vandyke beard and
laughed quietly to himself. The letter itself was both peremptory and
profane, and commanded the Honorable Blake to do exactly what he had
already done, and what he intended to do when the time came for the doing.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0022" id="link2HCH0022"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 22. LAWFUL IMPROVEMENTS </h2>
<p>Florence Grace Hallman must not be counted a woman without principle or
kindness of heart or these qualities which make women beloved of men. She
was a pretty nice young woman, unless one roused her antagonism. Had Andy
Green, for instance, accepted in good faith her offer of a position with
the Syndicate, he would have found her generous and humorous and loyal and
kind. He would probably have fallen in love with her before the summer was
over, and he would never have discovered in her nature that hardness and
that ability for spiteful scheming which came to the surface and made the
whole Happy Family look upon her as an enemy.</p>
<p>Florence Grace Hillman was intensely human, as well as intensely loyal to
her firm. She had liked Andy Green better than anyone—herself
included—realized. It was not altogether her vanity that was hurt
when she discovered how he had worked against her—how little her
personality had counted with him. She felt chagrined and humiliated and as
though nothing save the complete subjugation of Andy Green and the
complete thwarting of his plans could ease her own hurt.</p>
<p>Deep in her heart she hoped that he would eventually want her to forgive
him his treachery. She would give him a good, hard fight—she would
show him that she was mistress of the situation. She would force him to
respect her as a foe; after that—Andy Green was human, certainly.
She trusted to her feminine intuition to say just what should transpire
after the fight; trusted to her feminine charm also to bring her whatever
she might desire.</p>
<p>That was the personal side of the situation. There was also the
professional side, which urged her to do battle for the interests of her
firm. And since both the personal and the professional aspects of the case
pointed to the same general goal, it may be assumed that Florence Grace
was prepared to make a stiff fight.</p>
<p>Then Andy Green proceeded to fall in love with that sharp-tongued Rosemary
Allen; and Rosemary Allen had no better taste than to let herself be lost
and finally found by Andy, and had the nerve to show very plainly that she
not only approved of his love but returned it. After that, Florence Grace
was in a condition to stop at nothing—short of murder—that
would defeat the Happy Family in their latest project.</p>
<p>While all the Bear Paw country was stirred up over the lost child,
Florence Grace Hillman said it was too bad, and had they found him yet?
and went right along planting contestants upon the claims of the Happy
Family. She encouraged the building of claim-shacks and urged firmness in
holding possession of them. She visited the man whom Irish had knocked
down with a bottle of whisky, and she had a long talk with him and with
the doctor who attended him. She saw to it that the contest notices were
served promptly upon the Happy Family, and she hurried in shipments of
stock. Oh, she was very busy indeed, during the week that was spent in
hunting the Kid. When he was found, and the rumor of an engagement between
Rosemary Allen and that treacherous Andy Green reached her, she was busier
still; but since she had changed her methods and was careful to mask her
real purpose behind an air of passive resentment, her industry became less
apparent.</p>
<p>The Happy Family did not pay much attention to Florence Grace Hallman and
her studied opposition. They were pretty busy attending to their own
affairs; Andy Green was not only busy but very much in love, so that he
almost forgot the existence of Florence Grace except on the rare occasions
when he met her riding over the prairie trails.</p>
<p>First of all they rounded up the stock that had been scattered, and they
did not stop when they crossed Antelope Coulee with the settlers' cattle.
They bedded them there until after dark. Then they drove them on to the
valley of Dry Lake, crossed that valley on the train traveled road and
pushed the herd up on Lonesome Prairie and out as far upon the benchland
as they had time to drive them.</p>
<p>They did not make much effort toward keeping it a secret. Indeed Weary
told three or four of the most indignant settlers, next day, where they
would find their cattle. But he added that the feed was pretty good back
there, and advised them to leave the stock out there for the present.</p>
<p>“It isn't going to do you fellows any good to rear up on your hind legs
and make a holler,” he said calmly. “We haven't hurt your cattle. We don't
want to have trouble with anybody. But we're pretty sure to have a fine,
large row with our neighbors if they don't keep on their own side the
fence.”</p>
<p>That fence was growing to be more than a mere figure of speech The Happy
Family did not love the digging of post-holes and the stretching of barbed
wire; on the contrary they hated it so deeply that you could not get a
civil word out of one of them while the work went on; yet they put in long
hours at the fence-building.</p>
<p>They had to take the work in shifts on account of having their own cattle
to watch day and night. Sometimes it happened that a man tamped posts or
helped stretch wire all day, and then stood guard two or three hours on
the herd at night; which was wearing on the temper. Sometimes, because
they were tired, they quarreled over small things.</p>
<p>New shipments of cattle, too, kept coming to Dry Lake. Invariably these
would be driven out towards Antelope Coulee—farther if the drivers
could manage it—and would have to be driven back again with what
patience the Happy Family could muster. No one helped them among the
settlers. There was every attitude among the claim-dwellers, from open
opposition to latent antagonism. None were quite neutral—and yet the
Happy Family did not bother any save these who had filed contests to their
claims, or who took active part in the cattle driving.</p>
<p>The Happy Family were not half as brutal as they might have been. In spite
of their no-trespassing signs they permitted settlers to drive across
their claims with wagons and water-barrels, to haul water from One Man
Creek when the springs and the creek in Antelope Coulee went dry.</p>
<p>They did not attempt to move the shacks of the later contestants off their
claims. Though they hated the sight of them and of the owners who bore
themselves with such provocative assurance, they grudged the time the
moving would take. Besides that the Honorable Blake had told them that
moving the shacks would accomplish no real, permanent good. Within thirty
days they must appear before the register and receiver and file answer to
the contest, and he assured them that forbearance upon their part would
serve to strengthen their case with the Commissioner.</p>
<p>It goes to prove how deeply in earnest they were, that they immediately
began to practice assiduously the virtues of mildness and forbearance.
They could, he told them, postpone the filing of their answers until close
to the end of the thirty days; which would serve also to delay the date of
actual trial of the contests, and give the Happy Family more time for
their work.</p>
<p>Their plans had enlarged somewhat. They talked now of fencing the whole
tract on all four sides, and of building a dam across the mouth of a
certain coulee in the foothills which drained several miles of rough
country, thereby converting the coulee into a reservoir that would furnish
water for their desert claims. It would take work, of course; but the
Happy Family; were beginning to see prosperity on the trail ahead and
nothing in the shape of hard work could stop them from coming to
hang-grips with fortune.</p>
<p>Chip helped them all he could, but he had the Flying U to look after, and
that without the good team-work of the Happy Family which had kept things
moving along so smoothly. The team-work now was being used in a different
game; a losing game, one would say at first glance.</p>
<p>So far the summer had been favorable to dry-farming. The more enterprising
of the settlers had some grain and planted potatoes upon freshly broken
soil, and these were growing apace. They did not know about these
scorching August winds, that might shrivel crops in a day. They did not
realize that early frosts might kill what the hot winds spared. They
became enthusiastic over dry-farming, and their resentment toward the
Happy family increased as their enthusiasm waxed strong. The Happy Family
complained to one another that you couldn't pry a nester loose from his
claim with a crowbar.</p>
<p>In this manner did civilization march out and take possession of the high
prairies that lay close to the Flying U. They had a Sunday School
organized, with the meetings held in a double shack near the trail to Dry
Lake. The Happy family, riding that way, sometimes heard voices mingled in
the shrill singing of some hymn where, a year before, they had listened to
the hunting song of the coyote.</p>
<p>Eighty acres to the man—with that climate and that soil they never
could make it pay; with that soil especially since it was mostly barren.
The Happy Family knew it, and could find it in their hearts to pity the
men who were putting in dollars and time and hard work there. But for
obvious reasons they did not put their pity into speech.</p>
<p>They fenced their west line in record time. There was only one gate in the
whole length of it, and that was on the trail to Dry Lake. Not content
with trusting to the warning of four strands of barbed wire stretched so
tight that they hummed to the touch, they took turns in watching it—“riding
fence,” in range parlance—and in watching the settlers' cattle.</p>
<p>To H. J. Owens and his fellow contestants they paid not the slightest
attention, because the Honorable Blake had urged them personally to ignore
any and all claimants. To Florence Grace Hallman they gave no heed,
believing that she had done her worst, and that her worst was after all
pretty weak, since the contests she had caused to be filed could not
possibly be approved by the government so long as the Happy Family
continued to abide by every law and by-law and condition and requirement
in their present through-going and exemplary manner.</p>
<p>You should have seen how mild-mannered and how industrious the Happy
Family were, during these three weeks which followed the excitement of the
Kid's adventuring into the wild. You would have been astonished, and you
would have made the mistake of thinking that they had changed permanently
and might be expected now to settle down with wives and raise families and
hay and cattle and potatoes, and grow beards, perhaps, and become
well-to-do ranchers.</p>
<p>The Happy Family were almost convinced that they were actually leaving
excitement behind them for good and all. They might hold back the
encroaching tide of immigration from the rough land along the river—that
sounded like something exciting, to be sure. But they must hold back the
tide with legal proceedings and by pastoral pursuits, and that promised
little in the way of brisk, decisive action and strong nerves and all
these qualities which set the Happy Family somewhat apart from their
fellows.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0023" id="link2HCH0023"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 23. THE WATER QUESTION AND SOME GOSSIP </h2>
<p>Miss Rosemary Allen rode down into One Man Coulee and boldly up to the
cabin of Andy Green, and shouted musically for him to come forth. Andy
made a hasty pass at his hair with a brush, jerked his tie straight and
came out eagerly. There was no hesitation in his manner. He went straight
up to her and reached up to pull her from the saddle, that he might hold
her in his arms and kiss her—after the manner of bold young men who
are very much in love. But Miss Rosemary Allen stopped him with a push
that was not altogether playful, and scowled at him viciously.</p>
<p>“I am in a most furious mood today,” she said. “I want to scratch
somebody's eyes out! I want to say WORDS. Don't come close, or I might
pull your hair or something, James.” She called him James because that was
not his name, and because she had learned a good deal about his past
misdeeds and liked to take a sly whack at his notorious tendency to forget
the truth, by calling him Truthful James.</p>
<p>“All right; that suits me fine. It's worth a lot to have you close enough
to pull hair. Where have you been all this long while?” Being a bold young
man and very much in love, he kissed her in spite of her professed
viciousness.</p>
<p>“Oh, I've been to town—it hasn't been more than three days since we
met and had that terrible quarrel James. What was it about?” She frowned
down at him thoughtfully. “I'm still furious about it—whatever it
is. Do you know, Mr. Man, that I am an outlaw amongst my neighbors, and
that our happy little household, up there on the hill, is a house divided
against itself? I've put up a green burlap curtain on my southwest corner,
and bought me a smelly oil stove and I pos-i-tively refuse to look at my
neighbors or speak to them. I'm going to get some lumber and board up that
side of my house.</p>
<p>“Those three cats—they get together on the other side of my curtain
and say the meanest things!”</p>
<p>Andy Green had the temerity to laugh. “That sounds good to me,” he told
her unsympathetically. “Now maybe you'll come down and keep house for me
and let that pinnacle go to thunder. It's no good anyway, and I told you
so long ago. That whole eighty acres of yours wouldn't support a family of
jackrabbits month. What—”</p>
<p>“And let those old hens say they drove me off? That Kate Price is the
limit. The things she said to me you wouldn't believe. And it all started
over my going with little Buck a few times to ride along your fence when
you boys were busy. I consider that I had a perfect right to ride where I
pleased. Of course they're furious anyway, because I don't side against
you boys and—and all that. When—when they found out about—you
and me, James, they said some pretty sarcastic things, but I didn't pay
any attention to that. Poor old freaks, I expected them to be jealous,
because nobody ever pays any attention to THEM. Kate Price is the worst—she's
an old maid. The others have had husbands and can act superior.</p>
<p>“Well, I didn't mind the things they said then; I took that for granted.
But a week or so ago Florence Hallman came, and she did stir things up in
great style! Since then the girls have hardly spoken to me except to say
something insulting. And Florence Grace came right out and called me a
traitor; that was before little Buck and I took to 'riding fence' as you
call it, for you boys. You imagine what they've been saying since then!”</p>
<p>“Well, what do you care? You don't have to stay with them, and you know
it. I'm just waiting—”</p>
<p>“Well, but I'm no quitter, James. I'm going to hold down that claim now if
I have to wear a sixshooter!” Her eyes twinkled at that idea. “Besides, I
can stir them up now and then and get them to say things that are useful.
For instance, Florence Hallman told Kate Price about that last trainload
of cattle coming, and that they were going to cut your fence and drive
them through in the night—and I stirred dear little Katie up so she
couldn't keep still about that. And therefore—” She reached out and
gave Andy Green's ear a small tweek—“somebody found out about it,
and a lot of somebodys happened around that way and just quietly managed
to give folks a hint that there was fine grass somewhere else. That saved
a lot of horseflesh and words and work, didn't it?”</p>
<p>“It sure did.” Andy smiled up at her worshipfully. “Just the same—”</p>
<p>“But listen here, nice, level-headed Katiegirl has lost her temper since
then, and let out a little more that is useful knowledge to somebody.
There's one great weak point in the character of Florence Hallman; maybe
you have noticed it. She's just simply GOT to have somebody to tell things
to, and she doesn't always show the best judgment in her choice of a
confessional—”</p>
<p>“I've noticed that before,” Andy Green admitted, and smiled reminiscently.
“She sure does talk too much—for a lady that has so much up her
sleeve.”</p>
<p>“Yes—and she's been making a chum of Katie Price since she
discovered what an untrustworthy creature I am. I did a little favor for
Irish Mallory, James. I overheard Florence Grace talking to Kate about
that man who is supposed to be at death's door. So I made a trip to Great
Falls, if you please, and I scouted around and located the gentleman—well,
anyway, I gave that nice, sleek little lawyer of yours a few facts that
will let Irish come back to his claim.”</p>
<p>“Irish has been coming back to his claim pretty regular as it is,” Andy
informed her quietly. “Did you think he was hiding out, all this time?
Why”—he laughed at her—“you talked to him yourself, one day,
and thought it was Weary. Remember when you came over with the mail? That
was Irish helping me string wire. He's been wearing Weary's hat and
clothes and cultivating a twinkle to his eyes—that's all.”</p>
<p>“Why, I—well, anyway, that man they've been making a fuss over is
just as well as you are, James. They only wanted to get Irish in jail and
make a little trouble—pretty cheap warfare at that, if you want my
opinion.”</p>
<p>“Oh, well—what's the odds? While they're wasting time and energy
that way, we're going right along doing what we've laid out to do. Say, do
you know I'm kinda getting stuck on this ranch proposition. If I just had
a housekeeper—”</p>
<p>Miss Rosemary Allen seldom let him get beyond that point, and she
interrupted him now by wrinkling her nose at him in a manner that made
Andy Green forget altogether that he had begun a sentence upon a subject
forbidden. Later she went back to her worries; she was a very persistent
young woman.</p>
<p>“I hope you boys are going to attend to that contest business right away,”
she said, with a pucker between her eyes and not much twinkle in them.
“There's something about that which I don't quite understand. I heard
Florence Hallman and Kate talking yesterday about it going by default. Are
you sure it's wise to put off filing your answers so long? When are you
supposed to appear, James?”</p>
<p>“Me? On or before the twenty-oneth day of July, my dear girl. They lumped
us up and served us all on the same day—I reckon to save
shoe-leather; therefore, inasmuch as said adverse parties have got over a
week left—”</p>
<p>“You'd better not take a chance, waiting till the last day in the
afternoon,” she warned him vaguely. “Maybe they think you've forgotten the
date or something—but whatever they think, I believe they're
counting on your not answering in time. I think Florence Hallman knows
they haven't any real proof against you. I know she knows it. She's
perfectly wild over the way you boys have stuck here and worked. And from
what I can gather, she hasn't been able to scrape up the weentiest bit of
evidence that the Flying U is backing you—and of course that is the
only ground they could contest your claims on. So if it comes to trial,
you'll all win; you're bound to. I told Kate Price so—and those
other old hens, yesterday, and that's what we had the row over.”</p>
<p>“My money's on you, girl,” Andy told her, grinning. “How are the wounded?”</p>
<p>“The wounded? Oh, they've clubbed together this morning and are washing
hankies and collars and things, and talking about me. And they have
snouged every speck of water from the barrel—I paid my share for the
hauling, too—and the man won't come again till day after tomorrow
with more. Fifty cents a barrel, straight, he's charging now, James. And
you, boys with a great, big, long creekful of it that you can get right in
and swim in! I've come over to borrow two water-bags of it, if you please,
James I never dreamed water was so precious. Florence Hallman ought to be
made to lie on one of these dry claims she's fooled us into taking. I
really don't know, James, what's going to become of some of these poor
farmers. You knew, didn't you, that Mr. Murphy spent nearly two hundred
dollars boring a well—and now it's so strong of alkali they daren't
use a drop of it? Mr. Murphy is living right up to his name and
nationality, since then. He's away back there beyond the Sands place, you
know. He has to haul water about six miles. Believe me, James, Florence
Hallman had better keep away from Murphy! I met him as I was coming out
from town, and he called her a Jezebel!”</p>
<p>“That's mild!” Andy commented dryly. “Get down, why don't you? I want you
to take a look at the inside of my shack and see how bad I need a
housekeeper—since you won't take my word for it. I hope every drop
of water leaks outa these bags before you get home. I hope old Mister
falls down and spills it. I've a good mind not to let you have any,
anyway. Maybe you could be starved and tortured into coming down here
where you belong.”</p>
<p>“Maybe I couldn't. I'll get me a barrel of my own, and hire Simpson to
fill it four times a week, if you please! And I'll put a lid with a
padlock on it, so Katie dear can't rob me in the night—and I'll use
a whole quart at a time to wash dishes, and two quarts when I take a bath!
I shall,” she asserted with much emphasis, “lie in luxury, James!”</p>
<p>Andy laughed and waved his hand toward One Man Creek. “That's all right—but
how would you like to have that running past your house, so you could wake
up in the night and hear it go gurgle-gurgle? Wouldn't that be all right?”</p>
<p>Rosemary Allen clasped her two gloved hands together and drew a long
breath. “I should want to run out and stop it,” she declared. “To think of
water actually running around loose in this world!! And think of us up on
that dry prairie, paying fifty cents a barrel for it—and a lot
slopped out of the barrel on the road!” She glanced down into Andy's
love-lighted eyes, and her own softened. She placed her hand on his
shoulder and shook her head at him with a tender remonstrance.</p>
<p>“I know, boy—but it isn't in me to give up anything I set out to do,
any more than it is in you. You wouldn't like me half so well if I could
just drop that claim and think no more about it. I've got enough money to
commute, when the time comes, and I'll feel a lot better if I go through
with it now I've started. And—James!” She smiled at him wistfully.
“Even if it is only eighty acres, it will make good pasture, and—it
will help some, won't it?”</p>
<p>After that you could not expect Andy Green to do any more badgering or to
discourage the girl. He did like her better for having grit and a mental
backbone—and he found a way of telling her so and of making the
assurance convincing enough.</p>
<p>He filled her canvas water-bags and went with her to carry them, and he
cheered her much with his air-castles. Afterwards he took the team and
rustled a water-barrel and hauled her a barrel of water and gave Kate
Price a stony-eyed stare when she was caught watching him superciliously;
and in divers ways managed to make Miss Rosemary Allen feel that she was
fighting a good fight and that the odds were all in her favor and in the
favor of the Happy Family—and of Andy Green in particular. She felt
that the spite of her three very near neighbors was really a matter to
laugh over, and the spleen of Florence Hallman a joke.</p>
<p>But for all that she gave Andy Green one last warning when he climbed up
to the spring seat of the wagon and unwound the lines from the
brake-handle, ready to drive back to his own work. She went close to the
front wheel, so that eavesdroppers could not hear, and held her front hair
from blowing across her earnest, wind-tanned face while she looked up at
him.</p>
<p>“Now remember, boy, do go and file your answer to those contests—all
of you!” she urged. “I don't know why—but I've a feeling some kind
of a scheme is being hatched to make you trouble on that one point. And if
you see Buck, tell him I'll ride fence with him tomorrow again. If you
realized how much I like that old cowpuncher, you'd be horribly jealous,
James.”</p>
<p>“I'm jealous right now, without realizing a thing except that I've got to
go off and leave you here with a bunch of lemons,” he retorted—and
he spoke loud enough so that any eavesdroppers might hear.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0024" id="link2HCH0024"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 24. THE KID IS USED FOR A PAWN IN THE GAME </h2>
<p>Did you ever stop to think of the tremendous moral lesson in the Bible
tale of David and Goliath? And how great, human issues are often decided
one way or the other by little things? Not all crises are passed in the
clashing of swords and the boom of cannon. It was a pebble the size of
your thumbend, remember, that slew the giant.</p>
<p>In the struggle which the Happy Family was making to preserve the shrunken
range of the Flying U, and to hold back the sweeping tide of immigration,
one might logically look for some big, overwhelming element to turn the
tide one way or the other. With the Homeseekers' Syndicate backing the
natural animosity of the settlers, who had filed upon semiarid land
because the Happy Family had taken all of the tract that was tillable, a
big, open clash might be considered inevitable.</p>
<p>And yet the struggle was resolving itself into the question of whether the
contest filings should be approved by the land-office, or the filings of
the Happy Family be allowed to stand as having been made in good faith.
Florence Hallman therefore, having taken upon herself the leadership in
the contest fight, must do one of two things if she would have victory to
salve the hurt to her self-esteem and to vindicate the firm's policy in
the eyes of the settlers.</p>
<p>She must produce evidence of the collusion of the Flying U outfit with the
Happy Family, in the taking of the claims. Or she must connive to prevent
the filing of answers to the contest notices within the time-limit fixed
by law, so that the cases would go by default. That, of course, was the
simplest—since she had not been able to gather any evidence of
collusion that would stand in court.</p>
<p>There was another element in the land struggle—that was the soil and
climate that would fight inexorably against the settlers; but with them we
have little to do, since the Happy Family had nothing to do with them save
in a purely negative way.</p>
<p>A four-wire fence and a systematic patrol along the line was having its
effect upon the stock question. If the settlers drove their cattle south
until they passed the farthest corner of Flying U fence, they came plump
against Bert Rogers' barbed boundary line. West of that was his father's
place—and that stretched to the railroad right-of-way, fenced on
either side with a stock-proof barrier and hugging the Missouri all the
way to the Marias—where were other settlers. If they went north
until they passed the fence of the Happy Family, there were the Meeker
holdings to bar the way to the very foot of Old Centennial, and as far up
its sides as cattle would go.</p>
<p>The Happy Family had planned wisely when they took their claims in a long
chain that stretched across the benchland north of the Flying U. Florence
Grace knew this perfectly well—but what could she prove? The Happy
Family had bought cattle of their own, and were grazing them lawfully upon
their own claims. A lawyer had assured her that there was no evidence to
be gained there. They never went near J. G. Whitmore, nor did they make
use of his wagons, his teams or his tools or his money; instead they hired
what they needed, openly and from Bert Rogers. They had bought their
cattle from the Flying U, and that was the extent of their business
relations—on the surface. And since collusion had been the ground
given for the contests, it will be easily seen what slight hope Florence
Grace and her clients must have of winning any contest suit. Still, there
was that alternative—the Happy Family had been so eager to build
that fence and gather their cattle and put them back on the claims, and so
anxious lest in their absence the settlers should slip cattle across the
dead line and into the breaks, that they had postponed their trip to Great
Falls as long as possible. The Honorable Blake had tacitly advised them to
do so; and the Happy Family never gave a thought to their being hindered
when they did get ready to attend to it.</p>
<p>But—a pebble killed Goliath.</p>
<p>H. J. Owens, whose eyes were the wrong shade of blue, sat upon a rocky
hilltop which overlooked the trail from Flying U Coulee and a greater
portion of the shack-dotted benchland as well, and swept the far horizons
with his field glasses. Just down the eastern slope, where the jutting
sandstone cast a shadow, his horse stood tied to a dejected wild-currant
bush. He laid the glasses across his knees while he refilled his pipe, and
tilted his hatbrim to shield his pale blue eyes from the sun that was
sliding past midday.</p>
<p>H. J. Owens looked at his watch, nevertheless, as though the position of
the sun meant nothing to him. He scowled a little, stretched a leg
straight out before him to ease it of cramp, and afterwards moved farther
along in the shade. The wind swept past with a faint whistle, and laid the
ripening grasses flat where it passed. A cloud shadow moved slowly along
the slope beneath him, and he watched the darkening of the earth where it
touched, and the sharp contrast of the sun-yellowed sea of grass all
around it. H. J. Owens looked bored and sleepy; yet he did not leave the
hilltop—nor did he go to sleep.</p>
<p>Instead, he lifted the glasses, turned them toward Flying U Coulee a half
mile to the south of him, and stared long at the trail. After a few
minutes he made a gesture to lower the glasses, and then abruptly fixed
them steadily upon one spot, where the trail wound up over the crest of
the bluff. He looked for a minute, and laid the glasses down upon a rock.</p>
<p>H. J. Owens fumbled in the pocket of his coat, which he had folded and
laid beside him on the yellow gravel of the hill. He found something he
wanted, stood up, and with his back against a boulder he faced to the
southwest. He was careful about the direction. He glanced up at the sun,
squinting his eyes at the glare; he looked at what he held in his hand.</p>
<p>A glitter of sun on glass showed briefly. H. J. Owens laid his palm over
it, waited while he could count ten, and took his palm away. Replaced it,
waited, and revealed the glass again with the sun glare upon it full. He
held it so for a full minute, and slid the glass back into his pocket.</p>
<p>He glanced down toward Flying U Coulee again—toward where the trail
stretched like a brown ribbon through the grass. He seemed to be in
something of a hurry now—if impatient movement meant anything—yet
he did not leave the place at once. He kept looking off there toward the
southwest—off beyond Antelope Coulee and the sparsely dotted shacks
of the settlers.</p>
<p>A smudge of smoke rose thinly there, behind a hill. Unless one had been
watching the place, one would scarcely have noticed it, but H. J. Owens
saw it at once and smiled his twisted smile and went running down the hill
to where his horse was tied. He mounted and rode down to the level,
skirted the knoll and came out on the trail, down which he rode at an easy
lope until he met the Kid.</p>
<p>The Kid was going to see Rosemary Allen and take a ride with her along the
new fence; but he pulled up with the air of condescension which was his
usual attitude toward “nesters,” and in response to the twisted smile of
H. J. Owens he grinned amiably.</p>
<p>“Want to go on a bear-hunt with me, Buck?” began H. J. Owens with just the
right tone of comradeship, to win the undivided attention of the Kid.</p>
<p>“I was goin' to ride fence with Miss Allen,” the Kid declined regretfully.
“There ain't any bears got very close, there ain't. I guess you musta
swallered something Andy told you.” He looked at H. J. Owens tolerantly.</p>
<p>“No sir. I never talked to Andy about this.” Had he been perfectly
truthful he would have added that he had not talked with Andy about
anything whatever, but he let it go. “This is a bear den I found myself;
There's two little baby cubs, Buck, and I was wondering if you wouldn't
like to go along and get one for a pet. You could learn it to dance and
play soldier, and all kinds of stunts.”</p>
<p>The Kid's eyes shone, but he was wary. This man was a nester, so it would
be just at well to be careful “Where 'bouts is it?” he therefore demanded
in a tone of doubt that would have done credit to Happy Jack.</p>
<p>“Oh, down over there in the hills. It's a secret, though, till we get them
out. Some fellows are after them for themselves, Buck. They want to—skin
'em.”</p>
<p>“The mean devils!” condemned the Kid promptly. “I'd take a fall outa them
if I ketched 'em skinning any baby bear cubs while I was around.”</p>
<p>H. J. Owens glanced behind him with an uneasiness not altogether assumed.</p>
<p>“Let's go down into this next gully to talk it over, Buck,” he suggested
with an air of secretiveness that fired the Kid's imagination. “They
started out to follow me, and I don't want 'em to see me talking to you,
you know.”</p>
<p>The Kid went with him unsuspectingly. In all the six years of his life, no
man had ever offered him injury. Fear had not yet become associated with
those who spoke him fair. Nesters he did not consider friends because they
were not friends with his bunch. Personally he did not know anything about
enemies. This man was a nester—but he called him Buck, and he talked
very nice and friendly, and he said he knew where there were some little
baby bear cubs. The Kid had never before realized how much he wanted a
bear cub for a pet. So do our wants grow to meet our opportunities.</p>
<p>H. J. Owens led the way into a shallow draw between two low hills,
glancing often behind him and around him until they were shielded by the
higher ground. He was careful to keep where the grass was thickest and
would hold no hoofprints to betray them, but the Kid never noticed. He was
thinking how nice it would be to have a bear cub for a pet. But it was
funny that the Happy Family had never found him one, if there were any in
the country.</p>
<p>He turned to put the question direct to H. J. Owens, I but that gentleman
forestalled him.</p>
<p>“You wait here a minute, Buck, while I ride back on this hill a little
ways to see if those fellows are on our trail,” he said, and rode off
before the Kid could ask him the question.</p>
<p>The Kid waited obediently. He saw H. J. Owens get off his horse and go
sneaking up to the brow of the hill, and take some field glasses out of
his pocket and look all around over the prairie with them. The sight
tingled the Kid's blood so that he almost forgot about the bear cub. It
was almost exactly like fighting Injuns, like Uncle Gee-gee told about
when he wasn't cross.</p>
<p>In a few minutes Owens came back to the Kid, and they went on slowly,
keeping always in the low, grassy places where there would be no tracks
left to tell of their passing that way. Behind them a yellow-brown cloud
drifted sullenly with the wind. Now and then a black flake settled past
them to the ground. A peculiar, tangy smell was in the air—the smell
of burning grass.</p>
<p>H. J. Owens related a long, full-detailed account of how he had been down
in the hills along the river, and had seen the old mother bear digging
ants out of a sand-hill for her cubs.</p>
<p>“I know—that's jes' 'zactly the way they do!” the Kid interrupted
excitedly. “Daddy Chip seen one doing it on the Musselshell one time. He
told me 'bout it.”</p>
<p>H. J. Owens glanced sidelong at the Kid's flushed face, smiled his twisted
smile and went on with his story. He had not bothered them, he said,
because he did not have any way of carrying both cubs, and he hated to
kill them. He had thought of Buck, and how he would like a pet cub, so he
had followed the bear to her den and had come away to get a sack to carry
them in, and to tell Buck about it.</p>
<p>The Kid never once doubted that it was so. Whenever any of the Happy
Family found anything in the hills that was nice, they always thought of
Buck, and they always brought it to him. You would be amazed at the number
of rattlesnake rattles, and eagle's claws, and elk teeth, and things like
that, which the Kid possessed and kept carefully stowed away in a closet
kept sacred to his uses.</p>
<p>“'Course you'd 'member I wanted a baby bear cub; for a pet,” he assented
gravely and with a certain satisfaction. “Is it a far ways to that mother
bear's home?”</p>
<p>“Why?” H. J. Owens turned from staring at the rolling smoke cloud, and
looked at the Kid curiously. “Ain't you big enough to ride far?”</p>
<p>“'Course I'm big enough” The Kid's pride was touched. “I can ride as far
as a horse can travel I bet I can ride farther and faster 'n you can, you
pilgrims” He eyed the other disdainfully. “Huh! You can't ride. When you
trot you go this way!” The Kid kicked Silver into a trot and went bouncing
along with his elbows flapping loosely in imitation of H. J. Owens'
ungraceful riding.</p>
<p>“I don't want to go a far ways,” he explained when the other was again
Riding alongside, “'cause Doctor Dell would cry if I didn't come back to
supper. She cried when I was out huntin' the bunch. Doctor Dell gets
lonesome awful easy.” He looked over his shoulder uneasily. “I guess I
better go back and tell her I'm goin' to git a baby bear cub for a pet,”
he said, and reined Silver around to act upon the impulse.</p>
<p>“No—don't do that, Buck.” H. J. Owens pulled his horse in front of
Silver. “It isn't far—just a little ways. And it would be fun to
surprise them at the ranch Gee! When they saw you ride up with a pet bear
cub in your arms—” H. J. Owens shook his head as though he could not
find words to express the surprise of the Kid's family.</p>
<p>The Kid smiled his Little Doctor smile. “I'd tell a man!” he assented
enthusiastically. “I bet the Countess would holler when she seen it. She
scares awful easy. She's scared of a mice, even! Huh! My kitty ketched a
mice and she carried it right in her mouth and brought it into the kitchen
and let it set down on the floor a minute, and it started to run away—the
mice did. And it runned right up to the Countess, and she jes' hollered
and yelled And she got right up and stood on a chair and hollered for
Daddy Chip to come and ketch that mice. He didn't do it though. Adeline
ketched it herself. And I took it away from her and put it in a box for a
pet. I wasn't scared.”</p>
<p>“She'll be scared when she sees the bear cub,” H. J. Owens declared
absent-mindedly. “I know you won't be, though. If we hurry maybe we can
watch how he digs ants for his supper. That's lots of fun, Buck.”</p>
<p>“Yes—I 'member it's fun to watch baby bear cubs dig ants,” the Kid
assented earnestly, and followed willingly where H. J. Owens led the way.</p>
<p>That the way was far did not impress itself upon the Kid, beguiled with
wonderful stories of how baby bear cubs might be taught to do tricks. He
listened and believed, and invented some very wonderful tricks that he
meant to teach his baby bear cub. Not until the shadows began to fill the
gullies through which they rode did the Kid awake to the fact that night
was coming close and that they were still traveling away from home and in
a direction which was strange to him. Never in his life had he been
tricked by any one with unfriendly intent. He did not guess that he was
being tricked now. He rode away into the wild places in search of a baby
bear cub for a pet.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0025" id="link2HCH0025"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 25. “LITTLE BLACK SHACK'S ALL BURNT UP” </h2>
<p>It is a penitentiary offense for anyone to set fire to prairie grass or
timber; and if you know the havoc which one blazing match may work upon
dry grassland when the wind is blowing free, you will not wonder at the
penalty for lighting that match with deliberate intent to set the prairie
afire.</p>
<p>Within five minutes after H. J. Owens slipped the bit of mirror back into
his pocket after flashing a signal that the Kid was riding alone upon the
trail, a line of fire several rods long was creeping up out of a grassy
hollow to the hilltop beyond, whence it would go racing away to the east
and the north, growing bigger and harder to fight with every grass tuft it
fed on.</p>
<p>The Happy Family were working hard that day upon the system of irrigation
by which they meant to reclaim and make really valuable their desert
claims. They happened to be, at the time when the fire was started, six or
seven miles away, wrangling over the best means of getting their main
ditch around a certain coulee without building a lot of expensive flume. A
surveyor would have been a blessing, at this point in the undertaking; but
a surveyor charged good money for his services, and the Happy Family were
trying to be very economical with money; with time, and effort, and with
words they were not so frugal.</p>
<p>The fire had been burning for an hour and had spread so alarmingly before
the gusty breeze that it threatened several claim-shacks before they
noticed the telltale, brownish tint to the sunlight and smelled other
smoke than the smoke of the word-battle then waging fiercely among them.
They dropped stakes, flags and ditch-level and ran to where their horses
waited sleepily the pleasure of their masters.</p>
<p>They reached the level of the benchland to see disaster swooping down upon
them like a race-horse. They did not stop then to wonder how the fire had
started, or why it had gained such headway. They raced their horses after
sacks, and after the wagon and team and water barrels with which to fight
the flames. For it was not the claim-shacks in its path which alone were
threatened. The grass that was burning meant a great deal to the stock,
and therefore to the general welfare of every settler upon that bench, be
he native or newcomer.</p>
<p>Florence Grace Hallman had, upon one of her periodical visits among her
“clients,” warned them of the danger of prairie fires and urged them to
plow and burn guards around all their buildings. A few of the settlers had
done so and were comparatively safe in the face of that leaping, red line.
But there were some who had delayed—and these must fight now if they
would escape.</p>
<p>The Happy Family, to a man, had delayed; rather they had not considered
that there was any immediate danger from fire; it was too early in the
season for the grass to be tinder dry, as it would become a month or six
weeks later. They were wholly unprepared for the catastrophe, so far as
any expectation of it went. But for all that they knew exactly what to do
and how to go about doing it, and they did not waste a single minute in
meeting the emergency.</p>
<p>While the Kid was riding with H. J. Owens into the hills, his friends, the
bunch, were riding furiously in the opposite direction. And that was
exactly what had been planned beforehand. There was an absolute certainty
in the minds of those who planned that it would be so, Florence Grace
Hallman, for instance, knew just what would furnish complete occupation
for the minds and the hands of the Happy Family and of every other man in
that neighborhood, that afternoon. Perhaps a claim-shack or two would go
up in smoke and some grass would burn. But when one has a stubborn
disposition and is fighting for prestige and revenge and the success of
ones business, a shack or two and a few acres of prairie grass do not
count for very much.</p>
<p>For the rest of that afternoon the boys of the Flying U fought side by
side with hated nesters and told the inexperienced how best to fight. For
the rest of that afternoon no one remembered the Kid, or wondered why H.
J. Owens was not there in the grimy line of fire-fighters who slapped
doggedly at the leaping flames with sacks kept wet from the barrels of
water hauled here and there as they were needed. No one had time to call
the roll and see who was missing among the settlers. No one dreamed that
this mysterious fire that had crept up out of a coulee and spread a black,
smoking blanket over the hills where it passed, was nothing more nor lees
than a diversion while a greater crime was being committed behind their
backs.</p>
<p>In spite of them the fire, beaten out of existence at one point, gained
unexpected fury elsewhere and raced on. In spite of them women and
children were in actual danger of being burned to death, and rushed
weeping from flimsy shelter to find safety in the nearest barren coulee.
The sick lady whom the Little Doctor had been tending was carried out on
her bed and laid upon the blackened prairie, hysterical from the fright
she had received. The shack she had lately occupied smoked while the
tarred paper on the roof crisped and curled; and then the whole structure
burst into flames and sent blazing bits of paper and boards to spread the
fire faster.</p>
<p>Fire guards which the inexperienced settlers thought safe were jumped
without any perceptible check upon the flames. The wind was just right for
the fanning of the fire. It shifted now and then erratically and sent the
yellow line leaping in new directions. Florence Grace Hallman was in Dry
Lake that day, and she did not hear until after dark how completely her
little diversion had been a success; how more than half of her colony had
been left homeless and hungry upon the charred prairie. Florence Grace
Hallman would not have relished her supper, I fear, had the news reached
her earlier in the evening.</p>
<p>At Antelope Coulee the Happy Family and such of the settlers as they could
muster hastily for the fight, made a desperate stand against the common
enemy. Flying U Coulee was safe, thanks to the permanent fire-guards which
the Old Man maintained year after year as a matter of course. But there
were the claims of the Happy Family and all the grassland east of there
which must be saved.</p>
<p>Men drove their work horses at a gallop after plows, and when they had
brought them they lashed the horses into a trot while they plowed crooked
furrows in the sun-baked prairie sod, just over the eastern rim of
Antelope Coulee. The Happy Family knelt here and there along the
fresh-turned sod, and started a line of fire that must beat up against the
wind until it met the flames, rushing before it. Backfiring is always a
more or less, ticklish proceeding, and they would not trust the work to
stranger.</p>
<p>Every man of them took a certain stretch of furrow to watch, and ran
backward and forward with blackened, frayed sacks to beat out the wayward
flames that licked treacherously through the smallest break in the line of
fresh soil. They knew too well the danger of those little, licking flame
tongues; not one was left to live and grow and race leaping away through
the grass.</p>
<p>They worked—heavens, how they worked!—and they stopped the
fire there on the rim of Antelope Coulee. Florence Grace Hallman would
have been sick with fury, had she seen that dogged line of fighters, and
the ragged hem of charred black ashes against the yellow-brown, which
showed how well those men whom she hated had fought.</p>
<p>So the fire was stopped well outside the fence which marked the boundary
of the Happy Family's claims. All west of there and far to the north the
hills and the coulees lay black as far as one could see—which was to
the rim of the hills which bordered Dry Lake valley on the east. Here and
there a claim-shack stood forlorn amid the blackness. Here and there a
heap of embers still smoked and sent forth an occasional spitting of
sparks when a gust fanned the heap. Men, women and children stood about
blankly or wandered disconsolately here and there, coughing in the acrid
clouds of warm grass cinders kicked up by their own lagging feet.</p>
<p>No one missed the Kid. No one dreamed that he was lost again. Chip was
with the Happy Family and did not know that the Kid had left the ranch
that afternoon. The Little Doctor had taken it for granted that he had
gone with his daddy, as he so frequently did; and with his daddy and the
whole Happy Family to look after him, she never once doubted that he was
perfectly safe, even among the fire-fighters. She supposed he would be up
on the seat beside Patsy, probably, proudly riding on the wagon that
hauled the water barrels.</p>
<p>The Little Doctor had troubles of her own to occupy her mind She had
ridden hurriedly up the hill and straight to the shack of the sick woman,
when first she discovered that the prairie was afire. And she had found
the sick woman lying on a makeshift bed on the smoking, black area that
was pathetically safe now from fire because there was nothing more to
burn.</p>
<p>“Little black shack's all burnt up! Everything's black now. Black hills,
black hollows, black future, black world, black hearts—everything
matches—everything's black. Sky's black, I'm black—you're
black—little black shack won't have to stand all alone any more—little
black shack's just black ashes—little black shack's all burnt up!”
And then the woman laughed shrilly, with that terrible, meaningless
laughter of hysteria.</p>
<p>She was a pretty woman, and young. Her hair was that bright shade of red
that goes with a skin like thin, rose-tinted ivory. Her eyes were big and
so dark a blue that they sometimes looked black, and her mouth was sweet
and had a tired droop to match the mute pathos of her eyes. Her husband
was a coarse lout of a man who seldom spoke to her when they were
together. The Little Doctor had felt that all the tragedy of womanhood and
poverty and loneliness was synthesized in this woman with the unusual hair
and skin and eyes and expression. She had been coming every day to see
her; the woman was rather seriously ill, and needed better care than she
could get out there on the bald prairie, even with the Little Doctor to
watch over her. If she died her face would haunt the Little Doctor always.
Even if she did not die she would remain a vivid memory. Just now even the
Little Doctor's mother instinct was submerged under her professional
instincts and her woman sympathy. She did not stop to wonder whether she
was perfectly sure that the Kid was with Chip. She took it for granted and
dismissed the Kid from her mind, and worked to save the woman.</p>
<p>Yes, the little diversion of a prairie fire that would call all hands to
the westward so that the Kid might be lured away in another direction
without the mishap of being seen, proved a startling success. As a
diversion it could scarcely be improved upon—unless Florence Grace
Hallman had ordered a wholesale massacre or something like that.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0026" id="link2HCH0026"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 26. ROSEMARY ALLEN DOES A SMALL SUM IN ADDITION </h2>
<p>Miss Rosemary Allen, having wielded a wet gunny sack until her eyes were
red and smarting and her lungs choked with cinders and her arms so tired
she could scarcely lift them, was permitted by fate to be almost the first
person who discovered that her quarter of the four-room shack built upon
the four contiguous corners of four claims, was afire in the very middle
of its roof. Miss Rosemary Allen stood still and watched it burn, and was
a trifle surprised because she felt so little regret.</p>
<p>Other shacks had caught fire and burned hotly, and she had wept with
sympathy for the owners. But she did not weep when her own shack began to
crackle and show yellow, licking tongues of flame. Those three old cats—I
am using her own term, which was spiteful—would probably give up
now, and go back where they belonged. She hoped so. And for herself—</p>
<p>“By gracious, I'm glad to see that one go, anyhow!” Andy Green paused long
enough in his headlong gallop to shout to her. “I was going to sneak up
and touch it off myself, if it wouldn't start any other way. Now you and
me'll get down to cases, girl, and have a settlement. And say!” He had
started on, but he pulled up again. “The Little Doctor's back here,
somewhere. You go home with her when she goes, and stay till I come and
get you.”</p>
<p>“I like your nerve!” Rosemary retorted ambiguously.</p>
<p>“Sure—folks generally do. I'll tell her to stop for you. You know
she'll be glad enough to have you—and so will the Kid.”</p>
<p>“Where is Buck?” Rosemary was the first person who asked that question. “I
saw him ride up on the bench just before the fire started. I was watching
for him, through the glasses—”</p>
<p>“Dunno—haven't seen him. With his mother, I guess.” Andy rode on to
find Patsy and send him back down the line with the water wagon. He did
not think anything more about the Kid, though he thought a good deal about
Miss Allen.</p>
<p>Now that her shack was burned, she would be easier to persuade into giving
up that practically worthless eighty. That was what filled the mind of
Andy Green to the exclusion of everything else except the fire. He was in
a hurry to deliver his message to Patsy, so that he could hunt up the
Little Doctor and speak her hospitality for the girl he meant to marry
just as soon as he could persuade her to stand with him before a preacher.</p>
<p>He found the Little Doctor still fighting a dogged battle with death for
the life of the woman who laughed wildly because her home was a heap of
smoking embers. The Little Doctor told him to send Rosemary Allen on down
to the ranch, or take her himself, and to tell the Countess to send up her
biggest medicine case immediately. She could not leave, she said, for some
time yet. She might have to stay all night—or she would if there was
any place to stay. She was half decided, she said, to have someone take
the woman in to Dry Lake right away, and up to the hospital in Great
Falls. She supposed she would have to go along. Would Andy tell J. G. to
send up some money? Clothes didn't matter—she would go the way she
was; there were plenty of clothes in the stores, she declared. And would
Andy rustle a team, right away, so they could start? If they went at all
they ought to catch the evening train. The Little Doctor was making her
decisions and her plans while she talked, as is the way with those strong
natures who can act promptly and surely in the face of an emergency.</p>
<p>By the time she had thought of having a team come right away, she had
decided that she would not wait for her medicine-case or for money. She
could get all the money she needed in Dry Lake; and she had her little
emergency case with her. Since she was going to take the woman to a
hospital, she said, there was no great need of more than she had with her.
She was a thoughtful Little Doctor. At the last minute she detained Andy
long enough to urge him to see that Miss Allen helped herself to clothes
or anything she needed; and to send a goodbye message to Chip—in
case he did not show up before she left—and a kiss to her manchild.</p>
<p>Andy was lucky. He met a man driving a good team and spring wagon, with a
barrel of water in the back. He promptly dismounted and helped the man
unload the water-barrel where it was, and sent him bumping swiftly over
the burned sod to where the Little Doctor waited. So Fate was kinder to
the Little Doctor than were those who would wring anew the mother heart of
her that their own petty schemes might succeed. She went away with the
sick woman laughing crazily because all the little black shacks were
burned and now everything was black so everything matched nicely—nicely,
thank you. She was terribly worried over the woman's condition, and she
gave herself wholly to her professional zeal and never dreamed that her
manchild was at that moment riding deeper and deeper into the Badlands
with a tricky devil of a man, looking for a baby bear cub for a pet.</p>
<p>Neither did Chip dream it, nor any of the Happy Family, nor even Miss
Rosemary Allen, until they rode down into Flying U Coulee at supper-time
and were met squarely by the fact that the Kid was not there. The Old Man
threw the bomb that exploded tragedy in the midst of the little group. He
heard that “Dell” had gone to take a sick woman to the hospital in Great
Falls, and would not be back for a day or so, probably.</p>
<p>“What'd she do with the Kid?” he demanded. “Take him with her?”</p>
<p>Chip stared blankly at him, and turned his eyes finally to Andy's face.
Andy had not mentioned the Kid to him.</p>
<p>“He wasn't with her,” Andy replied to the look. “She sent him a kiss and
word that he was to take care of Miss Allen. He must be somewhere around
here.”</p>
<p>“Well, he ain't. I was looking fer him myself,” put in the Countess
sharply. “Somebody shut the cat up in the flour chest and I didn't study
much on what it was done it! If I'd a got my hands on 'im—”</p>
<p>“I saw him ride up on the hill trail just before the fire started,”
volunteered Rosemary Allen. “I had my opera glasses and was looking for
him, because I like to meet him and hear him talk. He said yesterday that
he was coming to see me today. And he rode up on the hill in sight of my
claim. I saw him.” She stopped and looked from one to the other with her
eyebrows pinched together and her lips pursed.</p>
<p>“Listen,” she went on hastily. “Maybe it has nothing to do with Buck—but
I saw something else that was very puzzling. I was going to investigate,
but the fire broke out immediately and put everything else out of my mind.
A man was up on that sharp-pointed knoll off east of the trail where it
leaves this coulee, and he had field glasses and was looking for something
over this way. I thought he was watching the trail. I just caught him with
the glasses by accident as I swung them over the edge of the benchland to
get the trail focused. He was watching something—because I kept
turning the glasses on him to see what he was doing.</p>
<p>“Then Buck came into sight, and I started to ride out and meet him. I hate
to leave the little mite riding alone anywhere—I'm always afraid
something may happen. But before I got on my horse I took another look at
this man on the hill. He had a mirror or something bright in his hands. I
saw it flash, just exactly as though he was signaling to someone—over
that way.” She pointed to the west. “He kept looking that way, and then
back this way; and he covered up the piece of mirror with his hand and
then took it off and let it shine a minute, and put it in his pocket. I
know he was making signals.</p>
<p>“I got my horse and started to meet little Buck. He was coming along the
trail and rode into a little hollow out of sight. I kept looking and
looking toward Dry Lake—because the man looked that way, I guess.
And in a few minutes I saw the smoke of the fire—”</p>
<p>“Who was that man?” Andy took a step toward her, his eyes hard and bright
in their inflamed lids.</p>
<p>“The man? That Mr. Owens who jumped your south eighty.”</p>
<p>“Good Lord, what fools!” He brushed past her without a look or another
word, so intent was he upon this fresh disaster. “I'm going after the
boys, Chip. You better come along and see if you can pick up the Kid's
trail where he left the road. It's too bad Florence Grace Hallman ain't a
man! I'd know better what to do if she was.”</p>
<p>“Oh, do you think—?” Miss Rosemary looked at him wide-eyed.</p>
<p>“Doggone it, if she's tried any of her schemes with fire and—why,
doggone it, being a woman ain't going to help her none!” The Old Man,
also, seemed to grasp the meaning of it almost as quickly as had Andy.
“Chip, you have Ole hitch up the team. I'm going to town myself, by
thunder, and see if she's going to play any of her tricks on this outfit
and git away with it! Burnt out half her doggoned colony tryin' to git a
whack at you boys! Where's my shoes? Doggone it, what yuh all standin'
round with your jaws hangin' down for? We'll see about this fire-settin'
and this—where's them shoes?”</p>
<p>The Countess found his shoes, and his hat, and his second-best coat and
his driving gloves which he had not worn for more months than anyone cared
to reckon. Miss Rosemary Allen did what she could to help, and wondered at
the dominant note struck by this bald old man from the moment when he rose
stiffly from his big chair and took the initiative so long left to others.</p>
<p>While the team was being made ready the Old Man limped here and there,
collecting things he did not need and trying to remember what he must
have, and keeping the Countess moving at a flurried trot. Chip and Andy
were not yet up the bluff when the Old Man climbed painfully into the
covered buggy, took the lines and the whip and cut a circle with the
wheels on the hard-packed earth as clean and as small as Chip himself
could have done, and went whirling through the big gate and across the
creek and up the long slope beyond. He shouted to the boys and they rode
slowly until he overtook them—though their nerves were all on edge
and haste seemed to them the most important thing in the world. But habit
is strong—it was their Old Man who called to them to wait.</p>
<p>“You boys wait to git out after that Owens,” he shouted when he passed
them. “If they've got the Kid, killing's too good for 'em!” The brown team
went trotting up the grade with back straightened to the pull of the
lurching buggy, and nostrils flaring wide with excitement. The Old Man
leaned sidewise and called back to the two loping after him in the
obscuring dust-cloud he left behind.</p>
<p>“I'll have that woman arrested on suspicion uh setting prairie fires!” he
called. “I'll git Blake after her. You git that Owens if you have-to haze
him to hell and back! Yuh don't want to worry about the Kid, Chip—they
ain't goin' to hurt him. All they want is to keep you boys huntin' high
and low and combin' the breaks to find 'im. I see their scheme, all
right.”</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0027" id="link2HCH0027"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 27. “ITS AWFUL EASY TO GET LOST” </h2>
<p>The Kid wriggled uncomfortably in the saddle and glanced at the
narrow-browed face of H. J. Owens, who was looking this way and that at
the enfolding hills and scowling abstractedly. The Kid was only six, but
he was fairly good at reading moods and glances, having lived all his life
amongst grown-ups.</p>
<p>“It's a pretty far ways to them baby bear cubs,” he remarked. “I bet
you're lost, old-timer. It's awful easy to get lost. I bet you don't know
where that mother-bear lives.”</p>
<p>“You shut up!” snarled H. J. Owens. The Kid had hit uncomfortably close to
the truth.</p>
<p>“You shut up your own self, you darned pilgrim.” the Kid flung back
instantly. That was the way he learned to say rude things; they were said
to him and he remembered and gave them back in full measure.</p>
<p>“Say, I'll slap you if you call me that again.” H. J. Owens, because he
did not relish the task he had undertaken, and because he had lost his
bearing here in the confusion of hills and hollows and deep gullies, was
in a very bad humor.</p>
<p>“You darn pilgrim, you dassent slap me. If you do the bunch'll fix you,
all right. I guess they'd just about kill you. Daddy Chip would just knock
the stuffin' outa you.” He considered something very briefly, and then
tilted his small chin so that he looked more than ever like the Little
Doctor. “I bet you was just lying all the time,” he accused. “I bet there
ain't any baby bear cubs.”</p>
<p>H. J. Owens laughed disagreeably, but he did not say whether or not the
Kid was right in his conjecture. The Kid pinched his lips together and
winked very fast for a minute. Never, never in all the six years of his
life had anyone played him so shabby a trick. He knew what the laugh
meant; it meant that this man had lied to him and led him away down here
in the hills where he had promised his Doctor Dell, cross-his-heart, that
he would never go again. He eyed the man resentfully.</p>
<p>“What made you lie about them baby bear cubs?” he demanded. “I didn't want
to come such a far ways.”</p>
<p>“You keep quiet. I've heard about enough from you, young man. A little
more of that and you'll get something you ain't looking for.”</p>
<p>“I'm a going home!” The Kid pulled Silver half around in the grassy gulch
they were following. “And I'm going to tell the bunch what you said. I bet
the bunch'll make you hard to ketch, you—you son-agun!”</p>
<p>“Here! You come back here, young man!” H. J. Owens reached over and caught
Silver's bridle. “You don't go home till I let you go; see. You're going
right along with me, if anybody should ask you. And you ain't going to
talk like that either, now mind!” He turned his pale blue eyes
threateningly upon the Kid. “Not another word out of you if you don't want
a good thrashing. You come along and behave yourself or I'll cut your ears
off.”</p>
<p>The Kid's eyes blazed with anger. He did not flinch while he glared back
at the man, and he did not seem to care, just at that moment, whether he
lost his ears or kept them. “You let go my horse!” he gritted. “You wait.
The bunch'll fix YOU, and fix you right. You wait!”</p>
<p>H. J. Owens hesitated, tempted to lay violent hands upon the small rebel.
But he did not. He led Silver a rod or two, found it awkward, since the
way was rough and he was not much of a horseman, and in a few minutes let
the rein drop from his fingers.</p>
<p>“You come on, Buck, and be a good boy—and maybe we'll find them cubs
yet,” he conciliated. “You'd die a-laughing at the way they set up and
scratch their ears when a big, black ant bites 'em, Buck. I'll show you in
a little while. And there's a funny camp down here, too, where we can get
some supper.”</p>
<p>The Kid made no reply, but he rode along docilely beside H. J. Owens and
listened to the new story he told of the bears. That is, he appeared to be
listening; in reality he was struggling to solve the biggest problem he
had ever known—the problem of danger and of treachery. Poor little
tad, he did not even know the names of his troubles. He only knew that
this man had told him a lie about those baby bear cubs, and had brought
him away down here where he had been lost, and that it was getting dark
and he wanted to go home and the man was mean and would not let him go. He
did not understand why the man should be so mean—but the man was
mean to him, and he did not intend to “stand for it.” He wanted to go
home. And when the Kid really wanted to do a certain thing, he nearly
always did it, as you may have observed.</p>
<p>H. J. Owens would not let him go home; therefore the Kid meant to go
anyway. Only he would have to sneak off, or run off, or something, and
hide where the man could not find him, and then go home to his Doctor Dell
and Daddy Chip, and tell them how mean this pilgrim had been to him. And
he would tell the bunch The bunch would fix him all right! The thought
cheered the Kid so that he smiled and made the man think he was listening
to his darned old bear story that was just a big lie. Think he would
listen to any story that pilgrim could tell? Huh!</p>
<p>The gulches wore growing dusky now The Kid was tired, and he was hungry
and could hardly keep from crying, he was so miserable. But he was the son
of his father—he was Chip's kid; it would take a great deal more
misery and unkindness to make him cry before this pilgrim who had been so
mean to him. He rode along without saying a word. H. J. Owens did not say
anything, either. He kept scanning each jagged peak and each gloomy canyon
as they passed, and he seemed uneasy about something. The Kid knew what it
was, all right; H. J. Owens was lost.</p>
<p>They came to a wide, flat-bottomed coulee with high ragged bluffs shutting
it in upon every side. The Kid dimly remembered that coulee, because that
was where Andy got down to tighten the cinch on Miss Allen's horse, and
looked up at her the way Daddy Chip looked at Doctor Dell sometimes, and
made a kiss with his lips—and got called down for it, too. The Kid
remembered.</p>
<p>He looked at the man, shut his mouth tight and wheeled Silver suddenly to
the left. He leaned forward as he had always seen the Happy Family do when
they started a race, and struck Silver smartly down the rump with the
braided romal on his bridle-reins. H. J. Owens was taken off his guard and
did nothing but stare open-mouthed until the Kid was well under way; then
he shouted and galloped after him, up the little flat.</p>
<p>He might as well have saved his horse's wind and his own energy. He was no
match for little Buck Bennett, who had the whole Flying U outfit to teach
him how to ride, and the spirit of his Daddy Chip and the little Doctor
combined to give him grit and initiative. H. J. Owens pounded along to the
head of the coulee, where he had seen the Kid galloping dimly in the dusk.
He turned up into the canyon that sloped invitingly up from the level, and
went on at the top speed of his horse—which was not fast enough to
boast about.</p>
<p>When he had left the coulee well behind him, the Kid rode out from behind
a clump of bushes that was a mere black shadow against the coulee wall,
and turned back whence he had come. The Kid giggled a little over the way
he had fooled the pilgrim, and wished that the bunch had been there to see
him do it. He kept Silver galloping until he had reached the other end of
the level, and then he pulled him down to a walk and let the reins drop
loosely upon Silver's neck. That was what Daddy Chip and the boys had told
him he must do, next time he got lost and did not know the way home. He
must just let Silver go wherever he wanted to go, and not try to guide him
at all. Silver would go straight home; he had the word of the whole bunch
for that, and he believed it implicitly.</p>
<p>Silver looked back inquiringly at his small rider, hesitated and then
swung back up the coulee. The Kid was afraid that H. J. Owens would come
back and see him and cut off his ears if he went that way—but he did
not pull Silver back and make him go some other way, for all that. If he
left him alone, Silver would take him right straight home. Daddy Chip and
the boys said so. And he would tell them how mean that man was. They would
fix him, all right!</p>
<p>Halfway up the coulee Silver turned into a narrow gulch that seemed to
lead nowhere at all except into the side of a big, black-shadowed bluff.
Up on the hillside a coyote began to yap with a shrill staccato of sounds
that trailed off into a disconsolate whimper. The Kid looked that way
interestedly. He was not afraid of coyotes. They would not hurt anyone;
they were more scared than you were—the bunch had told him so. He
wished he could get a sight of him, though. He liked to see their ears
stick up and their noses stick out in a sharp point, and see them drop
their tails and go sliding away out of sight. When he was ten and Daddy
Chip gave him a gun, he would shoot coyotes and skin them his own self.</p>
<p>The coyote yapped shrilly again, and the Kid wondered what his Doctor Dell
would say when he got home. He was terribly hungry, and he was tired and
wanted to go to bed. He wished the bunch would happen along and fix that
man. His heart swelled in his chest with rage and disappointment when he
thought of those baby bear cubs that were not anywhere at all—because
the man was just lying all the time. In spite of himself the Kid cried
whimperingly to himself while he rode slowly up the gorge which Silver had
chosen to follow because the reins were drooping low alongside his neck
and he might go where he pleased.</p>
<p>By and by the moon rose and lightened the hills so that they glowed
softly; and the Kid, looking sleepily around him, saw a coyote slinking
along a barren slope. He was going to shout at it and see it run, but he
thought of the man who was looking for him and glanced fearfully over his
shoulder. The moon shone full in his face and showed the tear-streaks and
the tired droop to his lips.</p>
<p>The Kid thought he must be going wrong, because at the ranch the moon came
up in another place altogether. He knew about the moon. Doctor Dell had
explained to him how it just kept going round and round the world and you
saw it when it came up over the edge. That was how Santa Claus found out
if kids were good; he lived in the moon, and it went round and round so he
could look down and see if you were bad. The Kid rubbed the tears off his
cheeks with his palm, so that Santa Claus could not see that he had been
crying. After that he rode bravely, with a consciously straight spine,
because Santa Claus was looking at him all the time and he must be a rell
ole cowpuncher.</p>
<p>After a long while the way grew less rough, and Silver trotted down the
easier slopes. The Kid was pretty tired now. He held on by the horn of his
saddle so Silver would not jolt him so much. He was terribly hungry, too,
and his eyes kept going shut. But Santa Claus kept looking at him to see
if he were a dead game sport, so he did not cry any more. He wished he had
some grub in a sack, but he thought he must be nearly home now. He had
come a terribly far ways since he ran away from that pilgrim who was going
to cut off his ears.</p>
<p>The Kid was so sleepy, and so tired that he almost fell out of the saddle
once when Silver, who had been loping easily across a fairly level stretch
of ground, slowed abruptly to negotiate a washout crossing. He had been
thinking about those baby bear cubs digging ants and eating them. He had
almost seen them doing it; but he remembered now that he was going home to
tell the bunch how the man had lied to him and tried to make him stay down
here. The bunch would sure fix him when they heard about that.</p>
<p>He was still thinking vengefully of the punishment which the Happy Family
would surely mete out to H. J. Owens when Silver lifted his head, looked
off to the right and gave a shrill whinny. Somebody shouted, and
immediately a couple of horsemen emerged from the shadow of a hill and
galloped toward him.</p>
<p>The Kid gave a cry and then laughed. It was his Daddy Chip and somebody.
He thought the other was Andy Green. He was too tired to kick Silver in
the ribs and race toward them. He waited until they came up, their horses
pounding over the uneven sod urged by the jubilance of their riders.</p>
<p>Chip rode up and lifted the Kid bodily from the saddle and held him so
tight in his arms that the Kid kicked half-heartedly with both feet, to
free himself. But he had a message for his Daddy Chip, and as soon as he
could get his breath he delivered it.</p>
<p>“Daddy Chip, I just want you to kill that damn' pilgrim!” he commanded.
“There wasn't any baby bear cubs at all. He was just a-stringin' me. And
he was going to cut off my ears. He said it wasn't a far ways to where the
baby bear cubs lived with the old mother bear, and it was. I wish you'd
lick the stuffin' outa him. I'm awful hungry, Daddy Chip.”</p>
<p>“We'll be home pretty quick,” Chip said in a queer, choked voice. “Who was
the man, Buck? Where is he now?”</p>
<p>The Kid lifted his head sleepily from his Daddy Chip's shoulder and
pointed vaguely toward the moon. “He's the man that jumped Andy's ranch
right on the edge of One Man,” he explained. “He's back there ridin' the
rim-rocks a lookin' for me. I'd a come home before, only he wouldn't let
me come. He said he'd cut my ears off. I runned away from him, Daddy Chip.
And I cussed him a plenty for lying to me—but you needn't tell
Doctor Dell.”</p>
<p>“I won't, Buck.” Chip lifted him into a more comfortable position and held
him so. While the Kid slept he talked with Andy about getting the Happy
Family on the trail of H. J. Owens. Then he rode thankfully home with the
Kid in his arms and Silver following docilely after.</p>
<p><SPAN name="link2HCH0028" id="link2HCH0028"></SPAN></p>
<br/>
<h2> CHAPTER 28. AS IT TURNED OUT </h2>
<p>They found H. J. Owens the next forenoon wandering hopelessly lost in the
hills. Since killing him was barred, they tied his arms behind him and
turned him toward the Flying U. He was sullen, like an animal that is
trapped and will do nothing but lie flattened to the ground and glare
red-eyed at its captors. For that matter, the Happy Family themselves were
pretty sullen. They had fought fire for hours—and that is killing
work; and they had been in the saddle ever since, looking for the Kid and
for this man who rode bound in their midst.</p>
<p>Weary and Irish and Pink, who had run across him in a narrow canyon, fired
pistol-shot signals to bring the others to the spot. But when the others
emerged from various points upon the scene, there was very little said
about the capture.</p>
<p>In town, the Old man had been quite as eager to come close to Florence
Grace Hallman—but he was not so lucky. Florence Grace had heard the
news of the fire a good half hour before the train left for Great Falls.</p>
<p>She would have preferred a train going the other way, but she decided not
to wait. She watched the sick woman put aboard the one Pullman coach, and
then she herself went into the stuffy day-coach. Florence Grace Hallman
was not in the habit of riding in day-coaches in the night-time when there
was a Pullman sleeper attached to the train. She did not stop at Great
Falls; she went on to Butte—and from there I do not know where she
went. Certainly she never came back.</p>
<p>That, of course, simplified matters considerably for Florence Grace—and
for the Happy Family as well. For at the preliminary hearing of H. J.
Owens for the high crime of kidnapping, that gentleman proceeded to
unburden his soul in a way that would have horrified Florence Grace, had
she been there to hear. Remember, I told you that his eyes were the wrong
shade of blue.</p>
<p>A man of whom you have never heard tried to slip out of the court room
during the unburdening process, and was stopped by Andy Green, who had
been keeping an eye on him for the simple reason that the fellow had been
much in the company of H. J. Owens during the week preceding the fire and
the luring away of the Kid. The sheriff led him off somewhere—and so
they had the man who had set the prairie afire.</p>
<p>As is the habit of those who confess easily the crimes of others, H. J.
Owens professed himself as innocent as he consistently could in the face
of the Happy Family and of the Kid's loud-whispered remarks when he saw
him there. He knew absolutely nothing about the fire, he said, and had
nothing to do with the setting of it. He was two miles away at the time it
started.</p>
<p>And then Miss Rosemary Allen took the witness stand and told about the man
on the hilltop and the bit of mirror that had flashed sun-signals toward
the west.</p>
<p>H.J. Owens crimpled down visibly in his chair. Imagine for yourself the
trouble he would have in convincing men of his innocence after that.</p>
<p>Just to satisfy your curiosity, at the trial a month later he failed
absolutely to convince the jury that he was anything but what he was—a
criminal without the strength to stand by his own friends. He was
sentenced to ten years in Deer Lodge, and the judge informed him that he
had been dealt with leniently at that, because after all he was only a
tool in the hands of the real instigator of the crime. That real
instigator, by the way, was never apprehended.</p>
<p>The other man—he who had set fire to the prairie—got six
years, and cursed the judge and threatened the whole Happy Family with
death when the sentence was passed upon him—as so many guilty men
do.</p>
<p>To go back to that preliminary, trial: The Happy Family, when H. J. Owens
was committed safely to the county jail, along with the fire-bug, took the
next train to Great Falls with witnesses and the Honorable Blake. They
filed their answers to the contests two days before the time-limit had
expired. You may call that shaving too close the margin of safety. But the
Happy family did not worry over that—seeing there was a margin of
safety. Nor did they worry over the outcome of the matter. With the
Homeseekers' Syndicate in extremely bad repute, and with fully half of the
colonists homeless and disgusted, why should they worry over their own
ultimate success?</p>
<p>They planned great things with their irrigation scheme.... I am not going
to tell any more about them just now. Some of you will complain, and want
to know a good many things that have not been told in detail. But if I
should try to satisfy you, there would be no more meetings between you and
the Happy Family—since there would be no more to tell.</p>
<p>So I am not even going to tell you whether Andy succeeded in persuading
Miss Rosemary Allen to go with him to the parson. Nor whether the Happy
Family really did settle down to raise families and alfalfa and beards.
Not another thing shall you know about them now.</p>
<p>You may take a look at them as they go trailing contentedly away from the
land-office, with their hats tilted at various characteristic angles and
their well-known voices mingled in more or less joyful converse, and their
toes pointed toward Central Avenue and certain liquid refreshments. You
need not worry over that bunch, surely. You may safely leave them to meet
future problems and emergencies as they have always met them in the past—on
their feet, with eyes that do not wave or flinch, shoulder to shoulder,
ready alike far grin fate or a frolic.</p>
<p><br/><br/><br/><br/></p>
<SPAN name="endofbook"></SPAN>
<div style="break-after:column;"></div><br />